* gdb.texinfo (GDB/MI Stack Manipulation): Make
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
167 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
168 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
169 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
170 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
171 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
172 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
173 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
174 @value{GDBN}
175 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
176 the operating system
177 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
178 how you can copy and share GDB
179 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
180 * Index:: Index
181 @end menu
182
183 @end ifnottex
184
185 @contents
186
187 @node Summary
188 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
189
190 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
191 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
192 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
193
194 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
195 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
196
197 @itemize @bullet
198 @item
199 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
200
201 @item
202 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
203
204 @item
205 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
206
207 @item
208 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
209 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
210 @end itemize
211
212 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
213 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
214 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
215
216 @cindex Modula-2
217 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
218 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
219
220 @cindex Pascal
221 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
222 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
223 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
224 syntax.
225
226 @cindex Fortran
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
228 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
229 underscore.
230
231 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
232 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
233
234 @menu
235 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
236 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
237 @end menu
238
239 @node Free Software
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software
241
242 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
243 General Public License
244 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
245 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
246 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
247 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
248 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
249 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
250
251 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
252 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
253 from anyone else.
254
255 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256
257 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
258 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
259 include with the free software. Many of our most important
260 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
261 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
262 when an important free software package does not come with a free
263 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
264 gaps today.
265
266 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
267 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
268 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
269 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
270 them from the free software world.
271
272 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
273 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
274 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
275 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
276 contract to make it non-free.
277
278 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
279 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
280 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
281 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
282 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
283 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
284 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
285
286 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
287 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
288 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
289 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
290
291 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
292 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
293 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
294 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
295 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
296 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
297 community.
298
299 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
300 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
301 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
302 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
303 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
304 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
305 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
306 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
307 of the manual.
308
309 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
310 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
311 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
312 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
313 manual to replace it.
314
315 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
316 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
317 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
318 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
319 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
320 the free software community.
321
322 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
323 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
324 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
325 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
326 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
327 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
328 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
329 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
330 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
331
332 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
333 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
334 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
335 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
336 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
337 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
338 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
339 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
340
341 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
342 published by other publishers, at
343 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
344
345 @node Contributors
346 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
347
348 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
349 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
350 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
351 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
352 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
353 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
354 blow-by-blow account.
355
356 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
357
358 @quotation
359 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
360 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
361 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
362 @end quotation
363
364 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
365 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
366 releases:
367 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
368 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
369 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
370 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
371 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
372 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
373 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
374 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
375 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
376
377 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
378 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
379
380 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
381 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
382 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
383 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
384 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
385
386 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
387 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
388 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
389
390 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
391 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
392
393 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
394
395 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
396 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
397 support.
398 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
399 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
400 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
401 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
402 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
403 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
404 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
405 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
406 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
407 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
408 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
409 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
410 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
411 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
412 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
413 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
414
415 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
416
417 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
418 libraries.
419
420 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
421 about several machine instruction sets.
422
423 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
424 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
425 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
426 and RDI targets, respectively.
427
428 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
429 command-line editing and command history.
430
431 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
432 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
433
434 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
435 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
436 symbols.
437
438 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
439 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
440
441 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
442
443 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
444 processors.
445
446 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
447
448 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
449
450 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
451
452 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
453 watchpoints.
454
455 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
456
457 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
458
459 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
460 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
461
462 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
463 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
464 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
465 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
466 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
467 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
468 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
469
470 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
471 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
472
473 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
474 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
475 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
476 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
477 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
478 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
479 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
480 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
481 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
482 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
483 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
484 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
485 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
486 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
487 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
488
489 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
490 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
491
492 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
493 Hat.
494
495 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
496 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
497 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
498 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
499 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
500 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
501
502 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
503 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
504 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
505 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
506 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
507 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
508 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
509 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
510 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
511 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
512 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
513 Weigand.
514
515 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
516 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
517 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
518 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
519
520 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
521 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
522
523 @node Sample Session
524 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
525
526 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
527 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
528 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
529
530 @iftex
531 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
532 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
533 @end iftex
534
535 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
536 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
537
538 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
539 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
540 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
541 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
542 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
543 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
544 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
545 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
546 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
547
548 @smallexample
549 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
550 $ @b{./m4}
551 @b{define(foo,0000)}
552
553 @b{foo}
554 0000
555 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
556
557 @b{bar}
558 0000
559 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
560
561 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
562 @b{baz}
563 @b{Ctrl-d}
564 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
565 @end smallexample
566
567 @noindent
568 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
569
570 @smallexample
571 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
572 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
573 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
574 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
575 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
576 the conditions.
577 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
578 for details.
579
580 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
581 (@value{GDBP})
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
586 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
587 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
588 that examples fit in this manual.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
592 @end smallexample
593
594 @noindent
595 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
596 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
597 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
598 @code{break} command.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
602 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
607 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
608 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
609
610 @smallexample
611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
612 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
613 @b{define(foo,0000)}
614
615 @b{foo}
616 0000
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
621 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
622 context where it stops.
623
624 @smallexample
625 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
626
627 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
628 at builtin.c:879
629 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
634 the next line of the current function.
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
639 : nil,
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
644 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
645 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
646 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
650 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
651 at input.c:530
652 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
657 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
658 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
659 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
660 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
661 stack frame for each active subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
665 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
666 at input.c:530
667 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
668 at builtin.c:882
669 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
670 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
671 at macro.c:71
672 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
673 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
678 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
679 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
680
681 @smallexample
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
683 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
685 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
686 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
689 : xstrdup(rq);
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
691 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
696 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
697 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
698 (@code{print}) to see their values.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
702 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
704 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
709 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
710 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
714 533 xfree(rquote);
715 534
716 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
717 : xstrdup (lq);
718 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
719 : xstrdup (rq);
720 537
721 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
722 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
723 540 @}
724 541
725 542 void
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
730 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
731
732 @smallexample
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
734 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
736 540 @}
737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
738 $3 = 9
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
740 $4 = 7
741 @end smallexample
742
743 @noindent
744 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
745 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
746 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
747 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
748 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
749 assignments.
750
751 @smallexample
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
753 $5 = 7
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
755 $6 = 9
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
760 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
761 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
762 example that caused trouble initially:
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
766 Continuing.
767
768 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
769
770 baz
771 0000
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
776 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
777 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @b{Ctrl-d}
781 Program exited normally.
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
786 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
787 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
788
789 @smallexample
790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
791 @end smallexample
792
793 @node Invocation
794 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
795
796 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
797 The essentials are:
798 @itemize @bullet
799 @item
800 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
801 @item
802 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
803 @end itemize
804
805 @menu
806 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
807 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
808 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
809 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
810 @end menu
811
812 @node Invoking GDB
813 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
814
815 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
816 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
817
818 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
819 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
820
821 The command-line options described here are designed
822 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
823 options may effectively be unavailable.
824
825 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
826 specifying an executable program:
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
830 @end smallexample
831
832 @noindent
833 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
834 specified:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
838 @end smallexample
839
840 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
841 to debug a running process:
842
843 @smallexample
844 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
845 @end smallexample
846
847 @noindent
848 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
849 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
850
851 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
852 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
853 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
854 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
855 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
856
857 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
858 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
859 option processing.
860 @smallexample
861 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
862 @end smallexample
863 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
864 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
865
866 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
867 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} -silent
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
875 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
876
877 @noindent
878 Type
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -help
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
886 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
887
888 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
889 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
890 @samp{-x} option is used.
891
892
893 @menu
894 * File Options:: Choosing files
895 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
896 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
897 @end menu
898
899 @node File Options
900 @subsection Choosing Files
901
902 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
903 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
904 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
905 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
906 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
907 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
908 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
909 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
910 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
911 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
912 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
913 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
914 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
915
916 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
917 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
918 argument and ignore it.
919
920 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
921 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
922 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
923 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
924 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
925
926 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
927 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
928 @c it.
929
930 @table @code
931 @item -symbols @var{file}
932 @itemx -s @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--symbols}
934 @cindex @code{-s}
935 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
936
937 @item -exec @var{file}
938 @itemx -e @var{file}
939 @cindex @code{--exec}
940 @cindex @code{-e}
941 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
942 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
943
944 @item -se @var{file}
945 @cindex @code{--se}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
947 file.
948
949 @item -core @var{file}
950 @itemx -c @var{file}
951 @cindex @code{--core}
952 @cindex @code{-c}
953 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
954
955 @item -pid @var{number}
956 @itemx -p @var{number}
957 @cindex @code{--pid}
958 @cindex @code{-p}
959 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
960
961 @item -command @var{file}
962 @itemx -x @var{file}
963 @cindex @code{--command}
964 @cindex @code{-x}
965 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
966 Files,, Command files}.
967
968 @item -eval-command @var{command}
969 @itemx -ex @var{command}
970 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
971 @cindex @code{-ex}
972 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
973
974 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
975 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
976
977 @smallexample
978 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
979 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
980 @end smallexample
981
982 @item -directory @var{directory}
983 @itemx -d @var{directory}
984 @cindex @code{--directory}
985 @cindex @code{-d}
986 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
987
988 @item -r
989 @itemx -readnow
990 @cindex @code{--readnow}
991 @cindex @code{-r}
992 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
993 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
994 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
995
996 @end table
997
998 @node Mode Options
999 @subsection Choosing Modes
1000
1001 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1002 batch mode or quiet mode.
1003
1004 @table @code
1005 @item -nx
1006 @itemx -n
1007 @cindex @code{--nx}
1008 @cindex @code{-n}
1009 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1010 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1011 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1012 Files}.
1013
1014 @item -quiet
1015 @itemx -silent
1016 @itemx -q
1017 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1018 @cindex @code{--silent}
1019 @cindex @code{-q}
1020 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1021 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1022
1023 @item -batch
1024 @cindex @code{--batch}
1025 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1026 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1027 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1028 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1029 in the command files.
1030
1031 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1032 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1033 make this more useful, the message
1034
1035 @smallexample
1036 Program exited normally.
1037 @end smallexample
1038
1039 @noindent
1040 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1041 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1042 mode.
1043
1044 @item -batch-silent
1045 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1046 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1047 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1048 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1049 for an interactive session.
1050
1051 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1052 messages, for example.
1053
1054 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1055 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1056
1057 @item -return-child-result
1058 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1059 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1060 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1061
1062 @itemize @bullet
1063 @item
1064 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1065 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1066 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1067 @item
1068 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1069 @item
1070 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1071 the exit code will be -1.
1072 @end itemize
1073
1074 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1075 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1076 interface.
1077
1078 @item -nowindows
1079 @itemx -nw
1080 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1081 @cindex @code{-nw}
1082 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1083 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1084 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1085
1086 @item -windows
1087 @itemx -w
1088 @cindex @code{--windows}
1089 @cindex @code{-w}
1090 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1091 used if possible.
1092
1093 @item -cd @var{directory}
1094 @cindex @code{--cd}
1095 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1096 instead of the current directory.
1097
1098 @item -fullname
1099 @itemx -f
1100 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1101 @cindex @code{-f}
1102 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1103 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1104 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1105 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1106 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1107 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1108 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1109 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1110 frame.
1111
1112 @item -epoch
1113 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1114 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1115 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1116 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1117 separate window.
1118
1119 @item -annotate @var{level}
1120 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1121 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1122 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1123 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1124 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1125 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1126 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1127 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1128 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1129
1130 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1131 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1132
1133 @item --args
1134 @cindex @code{--args}
1135 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1136 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1137 This option stops option processing.
1138
1139 @item -baud @var{bps}
1140 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1141 @cindex @code{--baud}
1142 @cindex @code{-b}
1143 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1144 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -l @var{timeout}
1147 @cindex @code{-l}
1148 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1149 for remote debugging.
1150
1151 @item -tty @var{device}
1152 @itemx -t @var{device}
1153 @cindex @code{--tty}
1154 @cindex @code{-t}
1155 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1156 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1157
1158 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1159 @item -tui
1160 @cindex @code{--tui}
1161 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1162 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1163 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1164 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1165 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1166 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1167 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1168
1169 @c @item -xdb
1170 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1171 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1172 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1173 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1174 @c systems.
1175
1176 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1177 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1178 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1179 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1180 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1181 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1182
1183 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1184 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1185 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1186 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1187 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1188 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1189
1190 @item -write
1191 @cindex @code{--write}
1192 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1193 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1194 (@pxref{Patching}).
1195
1196 @item -statistics
1197 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1199 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1200
1201 @item -version
1202 @cindex @code{--version}
1203 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1204 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 @node Startup
1209 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1210 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1211
1212 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1213
1214 @enumerate
1215 @item
1216 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1217 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1218
1219 @item
1220 @cindex init file
1221 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1222 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1223 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1224 that file.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1228 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1229 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1230 that file.
1231
1232 @item
1233 Processes command line options and operands.
1234
1235 @item
1236 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1237 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1238 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1239 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1240 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1241 @value{GDBN}.
1242
1243 @item
1244 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1245 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1246
1247 @item
1248 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1249 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1250 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1251 @end enumerate
1252
1253 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1254 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1255 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1256 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1257 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1258 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1259
1260 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1261 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1262
1263 @cindex init file name
1264 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1265 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1266 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1267 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1268 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1269 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1270 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1271 the file to the standard name.
1272
1273
1274 @node Quitting GDB
1275 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1276 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1277 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1278
1279 @table @code
1280 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1281 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1282 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @itemx q
1284 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1285 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1286 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1287 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1288 error code.
1289 @end table
1290
1291 @cindex interrupt
1292 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1293 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1294 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1295 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1296 until a time when it is safe.
1297
1298 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1299 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1300 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1301
1302 @node Shell Commands
1303 @section Shell Commands
1304
1305 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1306 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1307 just use the @code{shell} command.
1308
1309 @table @code
1310 @kindex shell
1311 @cindex shell escape
1312 @item shell @var{command string}
1313 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1314 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1315 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1316 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1317 @end table
1318
1319 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1320 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1321 @value{GDBN}:
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex make
1325 @cindex calling make
1326 @item make @var{make-args}
1327 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1328 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1329 @end table
1330
1331 @node Logging Output
1332 @section Logging Output
1333 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1334 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1335
1336 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1337 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1338
1339 @table @code
1340 @kindex set logging
1341 @item set logging on
1342 Enable logging.
1343 @item set logging off
1344 Disable logging.
1345 @cindex logging file name
1346 @item set logging file @var{file}
1347 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1348 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1349 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1350 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1351 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1352 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1353 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1354 @kindex show logging
1355 @item show logging
1356 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1357 @end table
1358
1359 @node Commands
1360 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1361
1362 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1363 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1364 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1365 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1366 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1367
1368 @menu
1369 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1370 * Completion:: Command completion
1371 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1372 @end menu
1373
1374 @node Command Syntax
1375 @section Command Syntax
1376
1377 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1378 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1379 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1380 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1381 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1382 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1383
1384 @cindex abbreviation
1385 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1386 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1387 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1388 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1389 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1390 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1391 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1392
1393 @cindex repeating commands
1394 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1395 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1396 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1397 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1398 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1399 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1400 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1401
1402 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1403 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1404 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1405
1406 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1407 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1408 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1409 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1410 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1411
1412 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1413 @cindex comment
1414 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1415 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1416 Files,,Command Files}).
1417
1418 @cindex repeating command sequences
1419 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1420 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1421 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1422 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1423 for editing.
1424
1425 @node Completion
1426 @section Command Completion
1427
1428 @cindex completion
1429 @cindex word completion
1430 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1431 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1432 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1433 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1434
1435 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1436 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1437 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1438 enter it). For example, if you type
1439
1440 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1441 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1442 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1443 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1444 @smallexample
1445 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1446 @end smallexample
1447
1448 @noindent
1449 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1450 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1454 @end smallexample
1455
1456 @noindent
1457 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1458 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1459 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1460 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1461 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1462 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1463
1464 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1465 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1466 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1467 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1468 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1469 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1470 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1471 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1472 example:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1476 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1477 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1478 make_abs_section make_function_type
1479 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1480 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1481 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1482 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1483 @end smallexample
1484
1485 @noindent
1486 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1487 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1488 command.
1489
1490 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1491 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1492 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1493 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1494 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1495
1496 @cindex quotes in commands
1497 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1498 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1499 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1500 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1501 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1502 @value{GDBN} commands.
1503
1504 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1505 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1506 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1507 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1508 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1509 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1510 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1511 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1512 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1513 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1514 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1518 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1520 @end smallexample
1521
1522 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1523 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1524 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1525 place:
1526
1527 @smallexample
1528 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1529 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1531 @end smallexample
1532
1533 @noindent
1534 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1535 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1536 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1537
1538 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1539 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1540 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1541 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1542
1543 @cindex completion of structure field names
1544 @cindex structure field name completion
1545 @cindex completion of union field names
1546 @cindex union field name completion
1547 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1548 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1549 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1550 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1551 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1552 left-hand-side:
1553
1554 @smallexample
1555 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1556 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1557 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1558 @end smallexample
1559
1560 @noindent
1561 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1562 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1563 follows:
1564
1565 @smallexample
1566 struct ui_file
1567 @{
1568 int *magic;
1569 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1570 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1571 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1572 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1573 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1574 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1575 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1576 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1577 void *to_data;
1578 @}
1579 @end smallexample
1580
1581
1582 @node Help
1583 @section Getting Help
1584 @cindex online documentation
1585 @kindex help
1586
1587 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1588 using the command @code{help}.
1589
1590 @table @code
1591 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1592 @item help
1593 @itemx h
1594 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1595 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1596
1597 @smallexample
1598 (@value{GDBP}) help
1599 List of classes of commands:
1600
1601 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1602 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1603 data -- Examining data
1604 files -- Specifying and examining files
1605 internals -- Maintenance commands
1606 obscure -- Obscure features
1607 running -- Running the program
1608 stack -- Examining the stack
1609 status -- Status inquiries
1610 support -- Support facilities
1611 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1612 stopping the program
1613 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1614
1615 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1616 commands in that class.
1617 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1618 documentation.
1619 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1620 (@value{GDBP})
1621 @end smallexample
1622 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1623
1624 @item help @var{class}
1625 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1626 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1627 help display for the class @code{status}:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1631 Status inquiries.
1632
1633 List of commands:
1634
1635 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1636 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1637 info -- Generic command for showing things
1638 about the program being debugged
1639 show -- Generic command for showing things
1640 about the debugger
1641
1642 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1643 documentation.
1644 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1645 (@value{GDBP})
1646 @end smallexample
1647
1648 @item help @var{command}
1649 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1650 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1651
1652 @kindex apropos
1653 @item apropos @var{args}
1654 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1655 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1656 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 apropos reload
1660 @end smallexample
1661
1662 @noindent
1663 results in:
1664
1665 @smallexample
1666 @c @group
1667 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1668 multiple times in one run
1669 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1670 multiple times in one run
1671 @c @end group
1672 @end smallexample
1673
1674 @kindex complete
1675 @item complete @var{args}
1676 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1677 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1678 command you want completed. For example:
1679
1680 @smallexample
1681 complete i
1682 @end smallexample
1683
1684 @noindent results in:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 @group
1688 if
1689 ignore
1690 info
1691 inspect
1692 @end group
1693 @end smallexample
1694
1695 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1696 @end table
1697
1698 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1699 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1700 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1701 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1702 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1703 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1704
1705 @c @group
1706 @table @code
1707 @kindex info
1708 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1709 @item info
1710 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1711 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1712 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1713 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1714 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1715 @w{@code{help info}}.
1716
1717 @kindex set
1718 @item set
1719 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1720 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1721 @code{set prompt $}.
1722
1723 @kindex show
1724 @item show
1725 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1726 @value{GDBN} itself.
1727 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1728 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1729 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1730 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1731
1732 @kindex info set
1733 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1734 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1735 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1736 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1737 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1738 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1739 @end table
1740 @c @end group
1741
1742 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1743 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1744
1745 @table @code
1746 @kindex show version
1747 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1748 @item show version
1749 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1750 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1751 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1752 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1753 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1754 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1755 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1756 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1757 @value{GDBN}.
1758
1759 @kindex show copying
1760 @kindex info copying
1761 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1762 @item show copying
1763 @itemx info copying
1764 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1765
1766 @kindex show warranty
1767 @kindex info warranty
1768 @item show warranty
1769 @itemx info warranty
1770 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1771 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1772
1773 @end table
1774
1775 @node Running
1776 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1777
1778 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1779 debugging information when you compile it.
1780
1781 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1782 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1783 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1784 kill a child process.
1785
1786 @menu
1787 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1788 * Starting:: Starting your program
1789 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1790 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1791
1792 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1793 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1794 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1795 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1796
1797 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1798 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1799 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1800 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1801 @end menu
1802
1803 @node Compilation
1804 @section Compiling for Debugging
1805
1806 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1807 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1808 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1809 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1810 and addresses in the executable code.
1811
1812 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1813 the compiler.
1814
1815 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1816 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1817 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1818 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1819 executables containing debugging information.
1820
1821 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1822 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1823 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1824 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1825 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1826
1827 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1828 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1829 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1830
1831 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1832 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1833 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1834 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1835 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1836 provides macro information if you specify the options
1837 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1838 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1839 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1840 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1841 @option{-g} alone.
1842
1843 @need 2000
1844 @node Starting
1845 @section Starting your Program
1846 @cindex starting
1847 @cindex running
1848
1849 @table @code
1850 @kindex run
1851 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1852 @item run
1853 @itemx r
1854 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1855 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1856 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1857 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1858 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1859
1860 @end table
1861
1862 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1863 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1864 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1865 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1866 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1867 message like this one:
1868
1869 @smallexample
1870 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1871 Try "help target" or "continue".
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent
1875 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1876 first (@pxref{load}).
1877
1878 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1879 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1880 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1881 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1882 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1883 divided into four categories:
1884
1885 @table @asis
1886 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1887 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1888 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1889 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1890 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1891 the arguments.
1892 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1893 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1894 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1895
1896 @item The @emph{environment.}
1897 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1898 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1899 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1900 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1901
1902 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1903 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1904 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1905 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1906
1907 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1908 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1909 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1910 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1911 set a different device for your program.
1912 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1913
1914 @cindex pipes
1915 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1916 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1917 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1918 wrong program.
1919 @end table
1920
1921 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1922 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1923 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1924 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1925 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1926
1927 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1928 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1929 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1930 your current breakpoints.
1931
1932 @table @code
1933 @kindex start
1934 @item start
1935 @cindex run to main procedure
1936 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1937 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1938 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1939 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1940 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1941 procedure, depending on the language used.
1942
1943 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1944 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1945 the @samp{run} command.
1946
1947 @cindex elaboration phase
1948 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1949 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1950 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1951 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1952 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1953 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1954 will remain to halt execution.
1955
1956 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1957 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1958 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1959 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1960 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1961
1962 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1963 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1964 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1965 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1966 elaboration code before running your program.
1967
1968 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1969 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1970 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1971 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1972 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1973 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1974 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1975 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1976 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1977 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1978 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1979
1980 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1981 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1982 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1983 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1984
1985 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1986 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1987 environment:
1988
1989 @smallexample
1990 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1991 (@value{GDBP}) run
1992 @end smallexample
1993
1994 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1995 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1996
1997 @kindex set disable-randomization
1998 @item set disable-randomization
1999 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2000 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2001 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2002 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2003 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2004
2005 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2006 behavior using
2007
2008 @smallexample
2009 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2010 @end smallexample
2011
2012 @item set disable-randomization off
2013 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2014 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2015 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2016 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2017 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2018 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2019
2020 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2021 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2022 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2023 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2024 a code at its expected addresses.
2025
2026 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2027 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2028 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2029 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2030 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2031 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2032 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2033 a randomly chosen address.
2034
2035 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2036 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2037 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2038 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2039 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2040
2041 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2042 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2043
2044 @item show disable-randomization
2045 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2046 the virtual address space of the started program.
2047
2048 @end table
2049
2050 @node Arguments
2051 @section Your Program's Arguments
2052
2053 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2054 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2055 @code{run} command.
2056 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2057 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2058 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2059 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2060 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2061
2062 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2063 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2064 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2065 the program, not by the shell.
2066
2067 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2068 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2069
2070 @table @code
2071 @kindex set args
2072 @item set args
2073 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2074 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2075 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2076 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2077 it again without arguments.
2078
2079 @kindex show args
2080 @item show args
2081 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 @node Environment
2085 @section Your Program's Environment
2086
2087 @cindex environment (of your program)
2088 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2089 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2090 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2091 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2092 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2093 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2094 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2095
2096 @table @code
2097 @kindex path
2098 @item path @var{directory}
2099 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2100 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2101 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2102 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2103 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2104 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2105 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2106
2107 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2108 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2109 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2110 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2111 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2112 @var{directory} to the search path.
2113 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2114 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2115
2116 @kindex show paths
2117 @item show paths
2118 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2119 environment variable).
2120
2121 @kindex show environment
2122 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2123 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2124 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2125 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2126 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2127
2128 @kindex set environment
2129 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2130 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2131 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2132 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2133 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2134 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2135 null value.
2136 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2137 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2138
2139 For example, this command:
2140
2141 @smallexample
2142 set env USER = foo
2143 @end smallexample
2144
2145 @noindent
2146 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2147 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2148 are not actually required.)
2149
2150 @kindex unset environment
2151 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2152 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2153 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2154 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2155 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2156 @end table
2157
2158 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2159 the shell indicated
2160 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2161 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2162 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2163 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2164 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2165 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2166 @file{.profile}.
2167
2168 @node Working Directory
2169 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2170
2171 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2172 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2173 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2174 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2175 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2176 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2177
2178 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2179 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2180 Specify Files}.
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @kindex cd
2184 @cindex change working directory
2185 @item cd @var{directory}
2186 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2187
2188 @kindex pwd
2189 @item pwd
2190 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2191 @end table
2192
2193 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2194 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2195 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2196 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2197 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2198 current working directory of the debuggee.
2199
2200 @node Input/Output
2201 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2202
2203 @cindex redirection
2204 @cindex i/o
2205 @cindex terminal
2206 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2207 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2208 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2209 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2210 running your program.
2211
2212 @table @code
2213 @kindex info terminal
2214 @item info terminal
2215 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2216 program is using.
2217 @end table
2218
2219 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2220 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2221
2222 @smallexample
2223 run > outfile
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2228
2229 @kindex tty
2230 @cindex controlling terminal
2231 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2232 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2233 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2234 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2235 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2236
2237 @smallexample
2238 tty /dev/ttyb
2239 @end smallexample
2240
2241 @noindent
2242 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2243 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2244 that as their controlling terminal.
2245
2246 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2247 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2248 terminal.
2249
2250 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2251 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2252 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2253 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2254
2255 @cindex inferior tty
2256 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2257 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2258 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2259 program.
2260
2261 @table @code
2262 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2263 @kindex set inferior-tty
2264 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2265
2266 @item show inferior-tty
2267 @kindex show inferior-tty
2268 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2269 @end table
2270
2271 @node Attach
2272 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2273 @kindex attach
2274 @cindex attach
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @item attach @var{process-id}
2278 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2279 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2280 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2281 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2282 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2283
2284 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2285 executing the command.
2286 @end table
2287
2288 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2289 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2290 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2291 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2292
2293 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2294 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2295 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2296 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2297 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2298 Specify Files}.
2299
2300 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2301 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2302 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2303 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2304 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2305 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2306 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2307
2308 @table @code
2309 @kindex detach
2310 @item detach
2311 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2312 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2313 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2314 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2315 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2316 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2317 executing the command.
2318 @end table
2319
2320 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2321 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2322 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2323 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2324 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2325 Messages}).
2326
2327 @node Kill Process
2328 @section Killing the Child Process
2329
2330 @table @code
2331 @kindex kill
2332 @item kill
2333 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2334 @end table
2335
2336 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2337 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2338 is running.
2339
2340 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2341 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2342 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2343 outside the debugger.
2344
2345 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2346 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2347 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2348 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2349 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2350 breakpoint settings).
2351
2352 @node Inferiors and Programs
2353 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2354
2355 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2356 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2357 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2358 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2359 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2360 from multiple executables.
2361
2362 @cindex inferior
2363 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2364 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2365 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2366 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2367 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2368 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2369 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2370 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2371 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2372 threads running in it.
2373
2374 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2375 inferiors}}:
2376
2377 @table @code
2378 @kindex info inferiors
2379 @item info inferiors
2380 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2381
2382 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2383
2384 @enumerate
2385 @item
2386 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2387
2388 @item
2389 the target system's inferior identifier
2390
2391 @item
2392 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2393
2394 @end enumerate
2395
2396 @noindent
2397 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2398 indicates the current inferior.
2399
2400 For example,
2401 @end table
2402 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2403
2404 @smallexample
2405 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2406 Num Description Executable
2407 2 process 2307 hello
2408 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2409 @end smallexample
2410
2411 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2412
2413 @table @code
2414 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2415 @item inferior @var{infno}
2416 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2417 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2418 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2419 @end table
2420
2421
2422 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2423 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2424 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2425 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2426 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2427 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2428
2429 @table @code
2430 @kindex add-inferior
2431 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2432 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2433 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2434 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2435 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2436 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2437
2438 @kindex clone-inferior
2439 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2440 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2441 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2442 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2443 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2444
2445 @smallexample
2446 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2447 Num Description Executable
2448 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2449 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2450 Added inferior 2.
2451 1 inferiors added.
2452 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2453 Num Description Executable
2454 2 <null> helloworld
2455 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2456 @end smallexample
2457
2458 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2459
2460 @kindex remove-inferior
2461 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2462 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2463 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2464 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2465
2466 @end table
2467
2468 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2469 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2470 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2471 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2472
2473 @table @code
2474 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2475 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2476 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2477 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2478
2479 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2480 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2481 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2482 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2483 @end table
2484
2485 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2486 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2487 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2488 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2489
2490
2491 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2492 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2493
2494 @table @code
2495 @kindex set print inferior-events
2496 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2497 @item set print inferior-events
2498 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2499 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2500 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2501 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2502 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2503 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2504
2505 @kindex show print inferior-events
2506 @item show print inferior-events
2507 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2508 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2512 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2513 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2514
2515
2516 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2517 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2518 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2519 info program-spaces}} command.
2520
2521 @table @code
2522 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2523 @item maint info program-spaces
2524 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2525 @value{GDBN}.
2526
2527 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2528
2529 @enumerate
2530 @item
2531 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2532
2533 @item
2534 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2535 the @code{file} command.
2536
2537 @end enumerate
2538
2539 @noindent
2540 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2541 indicates the current program space.
2542
2543 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2544 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2545 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2546
2547 @smallexample
2548 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2549 Id Executable
2550 2 goodbye
2551 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2552 * 1 hello
2553 @end smallexample
2554
2555 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2556 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2557 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2558 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2559 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2560
2561 @smallexample
2562 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2563 Id Executable
2564 * 1 vfork-test
2565 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2566 @end smallexample
2567
2568 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2569 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2570 @end table
2571
2572 @node Threads
2573 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2574
2575 @cindex threads of execution
2576 @cindex multiple threads
2577 @cindex switching threads
2578 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2579 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2580 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2581 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2582 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2583 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2584 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2585
2586 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2587 programs:
2588
2589 @itemize @bullet
2590 @item automatic notification of new threads
2591 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2592 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2593 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2594 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2595 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2596 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2597 messages on thread start and exit.
2598 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2599 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2600 isn't compatible with the program.
2601 @end itemize
2602
2603 @quotation
2604 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2605 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2606 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2607 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2608 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2609 like this:
2610
2611 @smallexample
2612 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2613 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2614 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2615 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2616 @end smallexample
2617 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2618 @c doesn't support threads"?
2619 @end quotation
2620
2621 @cindex focus of debugging
2622 @cindex current thread
2623 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2624 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2625 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2626 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2627 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2628
2629 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2630 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2631 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2632 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2633 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2634 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2635 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2636 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2637 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2638 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2639
2640 @smallexample
2641 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2642 @end smallexample
2643
2644 @noindent
2645 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2646 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2647 further qualifier.
2648
2649 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2650 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2651 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2652 @c program?
2653 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2654 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2655 @c threads ab initio?
2656
2657 @cindex thread number
2658 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2659 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2660 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2661
2662 @table @code
2663 @kindex info threads
2664 @item info threads
2665 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2666 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2667
2668 @enumerate
2669 @item
2670 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2671
2672 @item
2673 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2674
2675 @item
2676 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2677 @end enumerate
2678
2679 @noindent
2680 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2681 indicates the current thread.
2682
2683 For example,
2684 @end table
2685 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2686
2687 @smallexample
2688 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2689 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2690 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2691 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2692 at threadtest.c:68
2693 @end smallexample
2694
2695 On HP-UX systems:
2696
2697 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2698 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2699 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2700 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2701 thread in your program.
2702
2703 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2704 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2705 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2706 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2707 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2708 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2709 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2710 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2711 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2712 HP-UX, you see
2713
2714 @smallexample
2715 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2716 @end smallexample
2717
2718 @noindent
2719 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2720
2721 @table @code
2722 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2723 @item info threads
2724 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2725 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2726
2727 @enumerate
2728 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2731
2732 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2733 @end enumerate
2734
2735 @noindent
2736 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2737 indicates the current thread.
2738
2739 For example,
2740 @end table
2741 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2742
2743 @smallexample
2744 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2745 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2746 at quicksort.c:137
2747 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2748 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2749 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2750 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2754 Solaris-specific command:
2755
2756 @table @code
2757 @item maint info sol-threads
2758 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2759 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2760 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @table @code
2764 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2765 @item thread @var{threadno}
2766 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2767 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2768 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2769 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2770 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2771
2772 @smallexample
2773 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2774 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2775 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2776 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2777 @end smallexample
2778
2779 @noindent
2780 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2781 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2782 threads.
2783
2784 @kindex thread apply
2785 @cindex apply command to several threads
2786 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2787 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2788 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2789 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2790 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2791 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2792 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2793 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2794
2795 @kindex set print thread-events
2796 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2797 @item set print thread-events
2798 @itemx set print thread-events on
2799 @itemx set print thread-events off
2800 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2801 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2802 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2803 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2804 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2805
2806 @kindex show print thread-events
2807 @item show print thread-events
2808 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2809 have started and exited.
2810 @end table
2811
2812 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2813 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2814 programs with multiple threads.
2815
2816 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2817 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2818
2819 @table @code
2820 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2821 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2822 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2823 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2824 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2825 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2826 an empty list.
2827
2828 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2829 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2830 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2831 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2832 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2833 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2834
2835 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2836 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2837 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2838 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2839 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2840 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2841 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2842
2843 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2844 only on some platforms.
2845
2846 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2847 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2848 Display current libthread_db search path.
2849 @end table
2850
2851 @node Forks
2852 @section Debugging Forks
2853
2854 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2855 @cindex multiple processes
2856 @cindex processes, multiple
2857 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2858 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2859 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2860 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2861 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2862 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2863 will cause it to terminate.
2864
2865 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2866 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2867 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2868 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2869 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2870 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2871 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2872 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2873 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2874 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2875
2876 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2877 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2878 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2879 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2880
2881 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2882 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2883
2884 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2885 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2886
2887 @table @code
2888 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2889 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2890 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2891 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2892 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2893
2894 @table @code
2895 @item parent
2896 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2897 unimpeded. This is the default.
2898
2899 @item child
2900 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2901 unimpeded.
2902
2903 @end table
2904
2905 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2906 @item show follow-fork-mode
2907 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2908 @end table
2909
2910 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2911 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2912 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2913
2914 @table @code
2915 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2916 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2917 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2918 retain debugger control over them both.
2919
2920 @table @code
2921 @item on
2922 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2923 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2924 independently. This is the default.
2925
2926 @item off
2927 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2928 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2929 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2930 is held suspended.
2931
2932 @end table
2933
2934 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2935 @item show detach-on-fork
2936 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2937 @end table
2938
2939 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2940 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2941 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2942 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2943 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2944 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2945
2946 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2947 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2948 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2949 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2950 and Programs}.
2951
2952 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2953 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2954 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2955 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2956 the child process's @code{main}.
2957
2958 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2959 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2960
2961 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2962 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2963 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2964 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
2965 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
2966 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
2967 command.
2968
2969 @table @code
2970 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
2971 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
2972
2973 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
2974 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
2975
2976 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
2977
2978 @table @code
2979 @item new
2980 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
2981 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
2982 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
2983 original inferior.
2984
2985 For example:
2986
2987 @smallexample
2988 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2989 (gdb) info inferior
2990 Id Description Executable
2991 * 1 <null> prog1
2992 (@value{GDBP}) run
2993 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
2994 Program exited normally.
2995 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2996 Id Description Executable
2997 * 2 <null> prog2
2998 1 <null> prog1
2999 @end smallexample
3000
3001 @item same
3002 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3003 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3004 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3005 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3006 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3007
3008 For example:
3009
3010 @smallexample
3011 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3012 Id Description Executable
3013 * 1 <null> prog1
3014 (@value{GDBP}) run
3015 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3016 Program exited normally.
3017 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3018 Id Description Executable
3019 * 1 <null> prog2
3020 @end smallexample
3021
3022 @end table
3023 @end table
3024
3025 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3026 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3027 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3028
3029 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3030 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3031
3032 @cindex checkpoint
3033 @cindex restart
3034 @cindex bookmark
3035 @cindex snapshot of a process
3036 @cindex rewind program state
3037
3038 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3039 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3040 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3041 later.
3042
3043 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3044 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3045 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3046 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3047 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3048
3049 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3050 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3051 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3052 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3053 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3054 start again from there.
3055
3056 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3057 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3058
3059 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3060
3061 @table @code
3062 @kindex checkpoint
3063 @item checkpoint
3064 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3065 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3066 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3067
3068 @kindex info checkpoints
3069 @item info checkpoints
3070 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3071 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3072 listed:
3073
3074 @table @code
3075 @item Checkpoint ID
3076 @item Process ID
3077 @item Code Address
3078 @item Source line, or label
3079 @end table
3080
3081 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3082 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3083 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3084 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3085 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3086 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3087 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3088
3089 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3090 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3091 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3092 the debugger.
3093
3094 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3095 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3096 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3097
3098 @end table
3099
3100 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3101 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3102 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3103 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3104 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3105 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3106 previously read data can be read again.
3107
3108 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3109 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3110 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3111 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3112 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3113 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3114
3115 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3116 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3117 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3118 different execution path this time.
3119
3120 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3121 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3122 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3123 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3124 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3125 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3126 potentially pose a problem.
3127
3128 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3129
3130 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3131 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3132 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3133 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3134 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3135 next.
3136
3137 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3138 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3139 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3140 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3141 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3142
3143 @node Stopping
3144 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3145
3146 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3147 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3148 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3149
3150 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3151 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3152 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3153 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3154 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3155 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3156 explicitly request this information at any time.
3157
3158 @table @code
3159 @kindex info program
3160 @item info program
3161 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3162 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3163 @end table
3164
3165 @menu
3166 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3167 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3168 * Signals:: Signals
3169 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3170 @end menu
3171
3172 @node Breakpoints
3173 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3174
3175 @cindex breakpoints
3176 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3177 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3178 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3179 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3180 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3181 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3182 program.
3183
3184 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3185 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3186 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3187 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3188 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3189 call).
3190
3191 @cindex watchpoints
3192 @cindex data breakpoints
3193 @cindex memory tracing
3194 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3195 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3196 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3197 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3198 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3199 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3200 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3201 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3202 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3203 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3204 same commands.
3205
3206 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3207 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3208 Automatic Display}.
3209
3210 @cindex catchpoints
3211 @cindex breakpoint on events
3212 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3213 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3214 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3215 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3216 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3217 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3218 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3219
3220 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3221 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3222 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3223 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3224 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3225 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3226 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3227 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3228 enable it again.
3229
3230 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3231 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3232 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3233 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3234 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3235 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3236 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3237
3238 @menu
3239 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3240 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3241 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3242 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3243 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3244 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3245 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3246 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3247 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3248 @end menu
3249
3250 @node Set Breaks
3251 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3252
3253 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3254 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3255 @c
3256 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3257
3258 @kindex break
3259 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3260 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3261 @cindex latest breakpoint
3262 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3263 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3264 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3265 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3266 convenience variables.
3267
3268 @table @code
3269 @item break @var{location}
3270 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3271 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3272 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3273 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3274 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3275
3276 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3277 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3278 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3279 that situation.
3280
3281 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3282 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3283 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3284
3285 @item break
3286 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3287 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3288 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3289 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3290 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3291 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3292 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3293 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3294 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3295 inside loops.
3296
3297 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3298 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3299 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3300 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3301 existed when your program stopped.
3302
3303 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3304 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3305 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3306 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3307 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3308 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3309 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3310
3311 @kindex tbreak
3312 @item tbreak @var{args}
3313 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3314 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3315 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3316 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3317
3318 @kindex hbreak
3319 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3320 @item hbreak @var{args}
3321 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3322 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3323 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3324 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3325 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3326 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3327 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3328 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3329 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3330 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3331 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3332 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3333 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3334 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3335 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3336 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3337 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3338 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3339
3340 @kindex thbreak
3341 @item thbreak @var{args}
3342 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3343 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3344 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3345 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3346 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3347 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3348 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3349 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3350
3351 @kindex rbreak
3352 @cindex regular expression
3353 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3354 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3355 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3356 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3357 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3358 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3359 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3360 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3361 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3362
3363 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3364 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3365 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3366 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3367 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3368 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3369
3370 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3371 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3372 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3373 classes.
3374
3375 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3376 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3377 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3378
3379 @smallexample
3380 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3381 @end smallexample
3382
3383 @kindex info breakpoints
3384 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3385 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3386 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3387 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3388 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3389 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3390 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3391 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3392
3393 @table @emph
3394 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3395 @item Type
3396 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3397 @item Disposition
3398 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3399 @item Enabled or Disabled
3400 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3401 that are not enabled.
3402 @item Address
3403 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3404 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3405 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3406 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3407 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3408 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3409 @item What
3410 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3411 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3412 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3413 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3414 @end table
3415
3416 @noindent
3417 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3418 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3419 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3420 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3421 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3422 valid location.
3423
3424 @noindent
3425 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3426 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3427 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3428 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3429 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3433 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3434 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3435 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3436 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3437 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3441 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3442 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3443 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3444
3445 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3446 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3447 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3448 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3449
3450 @itemize @bullet
3451 @item
3452 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3453 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3454
3455 @item
3456 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3457 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3458
3459 @item
3460 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3461 several places where that function is inlined.
3462 @end itemize
3463
3464 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3465 the relevant locations@footnote{
3466 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3467 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3468 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3469 info with line numbers for them.}.
3470
3471 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3472 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3473 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3474 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3475 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3476 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3477 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3478
3479 For example:
3480
3481 @smallexample
3482 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3483 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3484 stop only if i==1
3485 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3486 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3487 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3488 @end smallexample
3489
3490 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3491 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3492 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3493 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3494 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3495 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3496 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3497 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3498 that belong to that breakpoint.
3499
3500 @cindex pending breakpoints
3501 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3502 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3503 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3504 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3505 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3506 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3507 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3508 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3509 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3510 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3511 is not yet resolved.
3512
3513 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3514 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3515 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3516 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3517 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3518 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3519
3520 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3521 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3522 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3523 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3524
3525 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3526 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3527 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3528
3529 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3530 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3531 address specification to an address:
3532
3533 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3534 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3535 @table @code
3536 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3537 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3538 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3539
3540 @item set breakpoint pending on
3541 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3542 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3543
3544 @item set breakpoint pending off
3545 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3546 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3547 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3548
3549 @item show breakpoint pending
3550 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3551 @end table
3552
3553 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3554 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3555 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3556
3557 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3558 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3559 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3560 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3561 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3562 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3563 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3564 breakpoints.
3565
3566 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3567
3568 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3569 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3570 @table @code
3571 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3572 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3573 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3574 breakpoint must be used.
3575
3576 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3577 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3578 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3579 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3580 @end table
3581
3582 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3583 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3584 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3585 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3586 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3587 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3588 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3589 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3590 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3591
3592 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3593 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3594 @table @code
3595 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3596 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3597 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3598 removed from the target when it stops.
3599
3600 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3601 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3602 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3603 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3604 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3605
3606 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3607 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3608 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3609 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3610 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3611 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3612 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3613 @end table
3614
3615 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3616 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3617 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3618 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3619 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3620 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3621 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3622 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3623
3624
3625 @node Set Watchpoints
3626 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3627
3628 @cindex setting watchpoints
3629 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3630 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3631 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3632 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3633 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3634
3635 @itemize @bullet
3636 @item
3637 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3638
3639 @item
3640 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3641 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3642 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3643
3644 @item
3645 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3646 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3647 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3648 @end itemize
3649
3650 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3651 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3652 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3653 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3654 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3655 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3656 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3657 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3658 the expression changes.
3659
3660 @cindex software watchpoints
3661 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3662 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3663 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3664 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3665 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3666 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3667 culprit.)
3668
3669 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3670 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3671 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3672
3673 @table @code
3674 @kindex watch
3675 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3676 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3677 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3678 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3679 to watch the value of a single variable:
3680
3681 @smallexample
3682 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3683 @end smallexample
3684
3685 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3686 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3687 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3688 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3689 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3690 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3691
3692 @kindex rwatch
3693 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3694 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3695 by the program.
3696
3697 @kindex awatch
3698 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3699 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3700 or written into by the program.
3701
3702 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3703 @item info watchpoints
3704 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3705 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3706 @end table
3707
3708 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3709 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3710 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3711 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3712 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3713 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3714
3715 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3716 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3717 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3718 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3719 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3720 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3721 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3722 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3723
3724 @table @code
3725 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3726 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3727 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3728
3729 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3730 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3731 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3732 @end table
3733
3734 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3735 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3736 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3737
3738 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3739
3740 @smallexample
3741 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3742 @end smallexample
3743
3744 @noindent
3745 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3746
3747 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3748 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3749 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3750 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3751 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3752 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3753 will print a message like this:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3757 @end smallexample
3758
3759 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3760 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3761 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3762 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3763 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3764 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3765 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3766 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3767
3768 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3769 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3770 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3771 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3772 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3773 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3774
3775 @smallexample
3776 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3777 @end smallexample
3778
3779 @noindent
3780 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3781
3782 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3783 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3784 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3785 expression with separately allocated resources.
3786
3787 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3788 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3789 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3790
3791 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3792 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3793 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3794 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3795 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3796 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3797 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3798 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3799 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3800
3801 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3802 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3803 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3804 watched expression from every thread.
3805
3806 @quotation
3807 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3808 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3809 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3810 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3811 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3812 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3813 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3814 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3815 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3816 @end quotation
3817
3818 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3819
3820 @node Set Catchpoints
3821 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3822 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3823 @cindex exception handlers
3824 @cindex event handling
3825
3826 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3827 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3828 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3829
3830 @table @code
3831 @kindex catch
3832 @item catch @var{event}
3833 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3834 @table @code
3835 @item throw
3836 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3837 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3838
3839 @item catch
3840 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3841
3842 @item exception
3843 @cindex Ada exception catching
3844 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3845 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3846 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3847 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3848 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3849
3850 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3851 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3852 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3853 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3854 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3855 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3856 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3857 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3858
3859 @item exception unhandled
3860 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3861
3862 @item assert
3863 A failed Ada assertion.
3864
3865 @item exec
3866 @cindex break on fork/exec
3867 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3868 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3869
3870 @item syscall
3871 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @r{...}
3872 @cindex break on a system call.
3873 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3874 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3875 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3876 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3877 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3878 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3879 will be caught.
3880
3881 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3882 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3883 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3884 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3885
3886 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3887 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3888 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3889 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3890
3891 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3892 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3893 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3894 available choices.
3895
3896 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3897 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3898 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3899 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3900 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3901 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3902 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3903 behind the OS upgrades).
3904
3905 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3906 arguments to it:
3907
3908 @smallexample
3909 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3910 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3911 (@value{GDBP}) r
3912 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3913
3914 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3915 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3916 (@value{GDBP}) c
3917 Continuing.
3918
3919 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3920 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3921 (@value{GDBP})
3922 @end smallexample
3923
3924 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3925
3926 @smallexample
3927 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3928 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3929 (@value{GDBP}) r
3930 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3931
3932 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
3933 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3934 (@value{GDBP}) c
3935 Continuing.
3936
3937 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
3938 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3939 (@value{GDBP})
3940 @end smallexample
3941
3942 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
3943 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
3944 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
3945
3946 @smallexample
3947 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
3948 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
3949 (@value{GDBP}) r
3950 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3951
3952 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
3953 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3954 (@value{GDBP}) c
3955 Continuing.
3956
3957 Program exited normally.
3958 (@value{GDBP})
3959 @end smallexample
3960
3961 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
3962 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
3963 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
3964 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
3965
3966 @smallexample
3967 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
3968 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
3969 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
3970 (@value{GDBP})
3971 @end smallexample
3972
3973 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
3974 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
3975 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
3976 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
3977 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
3978 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
3979
3980 @smallexample
3981 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3982 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
3983 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
3984 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
3985 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3986 (@value{GDBP})
3987 @end smallexample
3988
3989 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
3990
3991 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
3992 number. In this case, you would see something like:
3993
3994 @smallexample
3995 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
3996 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
3997 @end smallexample
3998
3999 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4000
4001 @item fork
4002 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4003 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4004
4005 @item vfork
4006 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4007 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4008
4009 @end table
4010
4011 @item tcatch @var{event}
4012 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4013 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4014
4015 @end table
4016
4017 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4018
4019 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4020 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4021
4022 @itemize @bullet
4023 @item
4024 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4025 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4026 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4027 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4028 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4029 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4030 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4031 disabled within interactive calls.
4032
4033 @item
4034 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4035
4036 @item
4037 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4038 @end itemize
4039
4040 @cindex raise exceptions
4041 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4042 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4043 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4044 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4045 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4046 out where the exception was raised.
4047
4048 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4049 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4050 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4051 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4052
4053 @smallexample
4054 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4055 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4056 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4057 @end smallexample
4058
4059 @noindent
4060 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4061 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4062 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4063
4064 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4065 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4066 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4067 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4068 raised.
4069
4070
4071 @node Delete Breaks
4072 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4073
4074 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4075 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4076 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4077 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4078 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4079 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4080
4081 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4082 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4083 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4084 their breakpoint numbers.
4085
4086 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4087 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4088 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4089
4090 @table @code
4091 @kindex clear
4092 @item clear
4093 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4094 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4095 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4096 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4097
4098 @item clear @var{location}
4099 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4100 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4101 most useful ones are listed below:
4102
4103 @table @code
4104 @item clear @var{function}
4105 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4106 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4107
4108 @item clear @var{linenum}
4109 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4110 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4111 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4112 @end table
4113
4114 @cindex delete breakpoints
4115 @kindex delete
4116 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4117 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4118 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4119 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4120 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4121 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4122 @end table
4123
4124 @node Disabling
4125 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4126
4127 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4128 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4129 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4130 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4131 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4132
4133 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4134 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
4135 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
4136 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
4137 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
4138
4139 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4140 affects all of its locations.
4141
4142 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4143 states of enablement:
4144
4145 @itemize @bullet
4146 @item
4147 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4148 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4149 @item
4150 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4151 @item
4152 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4153 disabled.
4154 @item
4155 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4156 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4157 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4158 @end itemize
4159
4160 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4161 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4162
4163 @table @code
4164 @kindex disable
4165 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4166 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4167 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4168 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4169 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4170 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4171 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4172
4173 @kindex enable
4174 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4175 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4176 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4177
4178 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4179 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4180 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4181
4182 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4183 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4184 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4185 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4186 @end table
4187
4188 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4189 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4190 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4191 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4192 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4193 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4194 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4195 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4196 Stepping}.)
4197
4198 @node Conditions
4199 @subsection Break Conditions
4200 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4201 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4202
4203 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4204 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4205 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4206 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4207 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4208 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4209 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4210 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4211
4212 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4213 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4214 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4215 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4216 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4217
4218 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4219 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4220 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4221 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4222 one.
4223
4224 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4225 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4226 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4227 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4228 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4229 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4230 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4231 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4232 conditions for the
4233 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4234 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4235
4236 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4237 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4238 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4239 with the @code{condition} command.
4240
4241 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4242 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4243 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4244 catchpoint.
4245
4246 @table @code
4247 @kindex condition
4248 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4249 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4250 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4251 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4252 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4253 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4254 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4255 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4256 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4257 prints an error message:
4258
4259 @smallexample
4260 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4261 @end smallexample
4262
4263 @noindent
4264 @value{GDBN} does
4265 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4266 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4267 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4268
4269 @item condition @var{bnum}
4270 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4271 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4275 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4276 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4277 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4278 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4279 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4280 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4281 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4282 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4283 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4284 your program reaches it.
4285
4286 @table @code
4287 @kindex ignore
4288 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4289 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4290 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4291 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4292 takes no action.
4293
4294 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4295 a count of zero.
4296
4297 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4298 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4299 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4300 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4301
4302 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4303 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4304 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4305
4306 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4307 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4308 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4309 Variables}.
4310 @end table
4311
4312 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4313
4314
4315 @node Break Commands
4316 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4317
4318 @cindex breakpoint commands
4319 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4320 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4321 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4322 enable other breakpoints.
4323
4324 @table @code
4325 @kindex commands
4326 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4327 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
4328 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4329 @itemx end
4330 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
4331 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4332 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4333
4334 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4335 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4336
4337 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
4338 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
4339 recently encountered).
4340 @end table
4341
4342 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4343 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4344
4345 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4346 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4347 that resumes execution.
4348
4349 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4350 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4351 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4352 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4353 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4354
4355 @kindex silent
4356 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4357 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4358 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4359 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4360 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4361 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4362
4363 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4364 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4365 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4366
4367 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4368 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4369
4370 @smallexample
4371 break foo if x>0
4372 commands
4373 silent
4374 printf "x is %d\n",x
4375 cont
4376 end
4377 @end smallexample
4378
4379 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4380 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4381 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4382 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4383 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4384 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4385 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4386
4387 @smallexample
4388 break 403
4389 commands
4390 silent
4391 set x = y + 4
4392 cont
4393 end
4394 @end smallexample
4395
4396 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4397 @node Error in Breakpoints
4398 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4399
4400 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4401 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4402
4403 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4404 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4405 @smallexample
4406 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4407 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4412 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4413 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4414
4415 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4416 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4417
4418 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4419 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4420 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4421
4422 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4423 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4424 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4425 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4426
4427 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4428 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4429 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4430 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4431 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4432 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4433 first in the bundle.
4434
4435 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4436 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4437 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4438 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4439 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4440 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4441 is hit.
4442
4443 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4444 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4445
4446 @smallexample
4447 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4451 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4452 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4453 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4454 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4455 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4456 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4457 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4458
4459 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4460 adjusted breakpoints:
4461
4462 @smallexample
4463 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4464 to 0x00010410.
4465 @end smallexample
4466
4467 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4468 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4469 frequently than expected.
4470
4471 @node Continuing and Stepping
4472 @section Continuing and Stepping
4473
4474 @cindex stepping
4475 @cindex continuing
4476 @cindex resuming execution
4477 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4478 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4479 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4480 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4481 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4482 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4483 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4484 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4485
4486 @table @code
4487 @kindex continue
4488 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4489 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4490 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4491 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4492 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4493 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4494 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4495 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4496 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4497 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4498
4499 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4500 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4501 @code{continue} is ignored.
4502
4503 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4504 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4505 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4506 @code{continue}.
4507 @end table
4508
4509 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4510 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4511 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4512 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4513
4514 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4515 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4516 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4517 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4518 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4519 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4520
4521 @table @code
4522 @kindex step
4523 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4524 @item step
4525 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4526 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4527 abbreviated @code{s}.
4528
4529 @quotation
4530 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4531 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4532 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4533 @c distinction here.
4534 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4535 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4536 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4537 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4538 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4539 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4540 below.
4541 @end quotation
4542
4543 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4544 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4545 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4546 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4547 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4548 called within the line.
4549
4550 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4551 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4552 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4553 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4554 was any debugging information about the routine.
4555
4556 @item step @var{count}
4557 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4558 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4559 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4560
4561 @kindex next
4562 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4563 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4564 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4565 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4566 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4567 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4568 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4569 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4570
4571 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4572
4573
4574 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4575 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4576 @c
4577 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4578 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4579 @c function are executed without stopping.
4580
4581 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4582 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4583 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4584
4585 @kindex set step-mode
4586 @item set step-mode
4587 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4588 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4589 @itemx set step-mode on
4590 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4591 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4592 information rather than stepping over it.
4593
4594 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4595 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4596 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4597
4598 @item set step-mode off
4599 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4600 debug information. This is the default.
4601
4602 @item show step-mode
4603 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4604 source line debug information.
4605
4606 @kindex finish
4607 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4608 @item finish
4609 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4610 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4611 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4612
4613 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4614 ,Returning from a Function}).
4615
4616 @kindex until
4617 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4618 @cindex run until specified location
4619 @item until
4620 @itemx u
4621 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4622 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4623 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4624 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4625 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4626 than the address of the jump.
4627
4628 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4629 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4630 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4631 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4632 through the next iteration.
4633
4634 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4635 stack frame.
4636
4637 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4638 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4639 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4640 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4641 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4642
4643 @smallexample
4644 (@value{GDBP}) f
4645 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4646 206 expand_input();
4647 (@value{GDBP}) until
4648 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4652 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4653 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4654 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4655 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4656 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4657 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4658
4659 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4660 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4661 argument.
4662
4663 @item until @var{location}
4664 @itemx u @var{location}
4665 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4666 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4667 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4668 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4669 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4670 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4671 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4672 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4673 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4674 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4675 invocations have returned.
4676
4677 @smallexample
4678 94 int factorial (int value)
4679 95 @{
4680 96 if (value > 1) @{
4681 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4682 98 @}
4683 99 return (value);
4684 100 @}
4685 @end smallexample
4686
4687
4688 @kindex advance @var{location}
4689 @itemx advance @var{location}
4690 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4691 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4692 @ref{Specify Location}.
4693 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4694 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4695 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4696 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4697
4698
4699 @kindex stepi
4700 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4701 @item stepi
4702 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4703 @itemx si
4704 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4705
4706 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4707 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4708 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4709 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4710
4711 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4712
4713 @need 750
4714 @kindex nexti
4715 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4716 @item nexti
4717 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4718 @itemx ni
4719 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4720 proceed until the function returns.
4721
4722 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4723 @end table
4724
4725 @node Signals
4726 @section Signals
4727 @cindex signals
4728
4729 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4730 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4731 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4732 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4733 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4734 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4735 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4736 requested an alarm).
4737
4738 @cindex fatal signals
4739 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4740 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4741 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4742 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4743 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4744 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4745
4746 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4747 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4748 signal.
4749
4750 @cindex handling signals
4751 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4752 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4753 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4754 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4755 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4756
4757 @table @code
4758 @kindex info signals
4759 @kindex info handle
4760 @item info signals
4761 @itemx info handle
4762 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4763 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4764 the defined types of signals.
4765
4766 @item info signals @var{sig}
4767 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4768
4769 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4770
4771 @kindex handle
4772 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4773 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4774 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4775 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4776 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4777 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4778 say what change to make.
4779 @end table
4780
4781 @c @group
4782 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4783 Their full names are:
4784
4785 @table @code
4786 @item nostop
4787 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4788 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4789
4790 @item stop
4791 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4792 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4793
4794 @item print
4795 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4796
4797 @item noprint
4798 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4799 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4800
4801 @item pass
4802 @itemx noignore
4803 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4804 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4805 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4806
4807 @item nopass
4808 @itemx ignore
4809 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4810 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4811 @end table
4812 @c @end group
4813
4814 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4815 program until you
4816 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4817 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4818 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4819 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4820 program sees that signal when you continue.
4821
4822 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4823 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4824 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4825 erroneous signals.
4826
4827 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4828 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4829 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4830 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4831 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4832 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4833 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4834 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4835 Program a Signal}.
4836
4837 @cindex extra signal information
4838 @anchor{extra signal information}
4839
4840 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4841 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4842 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4843 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4844 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4845 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4846 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4847 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4848 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4849 system header.
4850
4851 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4852 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4853
4854 @smallexample
4855 @group
4856 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4857 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4858 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4859 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4860 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4861 type = struct @{
4862 int si_signo;
4863 int si_errno;
4864 int si_code;
4865 union @{
4866 int _pad[28];
4867 struct @{...@} _kill;
4868 struct @{...@} _timer;
4869 struct @{...@} _rt;
4870 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4871 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4872 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4873 @} _sifields;
4874 @}
4875 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4876 type = struct @{
4877 void *si_addr;
4878 @}
4879 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4880 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4881 @end group
4882 @end smallexample
4883
4884 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4885
4886 @node Thread Stops
4887 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4888
4889 @cindex stopped threads
4890 @cindex threads, stopped
4891
4892 @cindex continuing threads
4893 @cindex threads, continuing
4894
4895 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4896 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4897 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4898 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4899 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4900 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4901 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4902 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4903 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4904
4905 @menu
4906 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4907 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4908 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4909 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4910 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4911 @end menu
4912
4913 @node All-Stop Mode
4914 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4915
4916 @cindex all-stop mode
4917
4918 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4919 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4920 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4921 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4922 underfoot.
4923
4924 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4925 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4926 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4927
4928 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4929 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4930 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4931 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4932 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4933 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4934 stops.
4935
4936 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4937 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4938 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4939 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4940
4941 @cindex automatic thread selection
4942 @cindex switching threads automatically
4943 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4944 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4945 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4946 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4947 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4948 thread.
4949
4950 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4951 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4952
4953 @table @code
4954 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4955 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4956 @cindex lock scheduler
4957 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4958 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4959 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4960 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4961 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4962 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4963 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4964 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4965 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4966 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4967 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4968 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4969
4970 @item show scheduler-locking
4971 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4972 @end table
4973
4974 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
4975 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
4976 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
4977 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
4978 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
4979 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
4980 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
4981 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
4982 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
4983 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
4984 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
4985 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
4986 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
4987 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
4988
4989 @table @code
4990 @kindex set schedule-multiple
4991 @item set schedule-multiple
4992 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
4993 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
4994 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
4995 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
4996 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
4997 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
4998
4999 @item show schedule-multiple
5000 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5001 multiple processes.
5002 @end table
5003
5004 @node Non-Stop Mode
5005 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5006
5007 @cindex non-stop mode
5008
5009 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5010 @c with more details.
5011
5012 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5013 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5014 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5015 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5016 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5017 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5018
5019 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5020 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5021 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5022 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5023 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5024 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5025 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5026 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5027 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5028 independently and simultaneously.
5029
5030 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5031 or attach to your program:
5032
5033 @smallexample
5034 # Enable the async interface.
5035 set target-async 1
5036
5037 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5038 set pagination off
5039
5040 # Finally, turn it on!
5041 set non-stop on
5042 @end smallexample
5043
5044 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5045
5046 @table @code
5047 @kindex set non-stop
5048 @item set non-stop on
5049 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5050 @item set non-stop off
5051 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5052 @kindex show non-stop
5053 @item show non-stop
5054 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5055 @end table
5056
5057 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5058 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5059 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5060 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5061 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5062 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5063 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5064 default.
5065
5066 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5067 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5068 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5069
5070 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5071 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5072 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5073 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5074 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5075
5076 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5077 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5078 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5079 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5080 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5081
5082 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5083
5084 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5085 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5086 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5087 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5088 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5089 previously current thread.
5090
5091 @node Background Execution
5092 @subsection Background Execution
5093
5094 @cindex foreground execution
5095 @cindex background execution
5096 @cindex asynchronous execution
5097 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5098
5099 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5100 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5101 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5102 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5103 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5104 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5105
5106 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5107 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5108 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5109
5110 @table @code
5111 @kindex set target-async
5112 @item set target-async on
5113 Enable asynchronous mode.
5114 @item set target-async off
5115 Disable asynchronous mode.
5116 @kindex show target-async
5117 @item show target-async
5118 Show the current target-async setting.
5119 @end table
5120
5121 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5122 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5123
5124 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5125 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5126 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5127 are:
5128
5129 @table @code
5130 @kindex run&
5131 @item run
5132 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5133
5134 @item attach
5135 @kindex attach&
5136 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5137
5138 @item step
5139 @kindex step&
5140 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5141
5142 @item stepi
5143 @kindex stepi&
5144 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5145
5146 @item next
5147 @kindex next&
5148 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5149
5150 @item nexti
5151 @kindex nexti&
5152 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5153
5154 @item continue
5155 @kindex continue&
5156 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5157
5158 @item finish
5159 @kindex finish&
5160 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5161
5162 @item until
5163 @kindex until&
5164 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5165
5166 @end table
5167
5168 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5169 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5170 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5171 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5172 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5173 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5174
5175 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5176 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5177
5178 @table @code
5179 @kindex interrupt
5180 @item interrupt
5181 @itemx interrupt -a
5182
5183 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5184 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5185 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5186 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5187 @end table
5188
5189 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5190 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5191
5192 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5193 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5194 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5195
5196 @table @code
5197 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5198 @cindex thread breakpoints
5199 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5200 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5201 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5202 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5203 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5204 specify some source line.
5205
5206 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5207 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5208 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5209 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5210 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5211
5212 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5213 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5214 program.
5215
5216 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5217 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
5218 breakpoint condition, like this:
5219
5220 @smallexample
5221 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5222 @end smallexample
5223
5224 @end table
5225
5226 @node Interrupted System Calls
5227 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5228
5229 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5230 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5231 @cindex premature return from system calls
5232 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5233 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5234 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5235 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5236 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5237 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5238 stop execution.
5239
5240 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5241 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5242 style anyways.
5243
5244 For example, do not write code like this:
5245
5246 @smallexample
5247 sleep (10);
5248 @end smallexample
5249
5250 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5251 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5252
5253 Instead, write this:
5254
5255 @smallexample
5256 int unslept = 10;
5257 while (unslept > 0)
5258 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5259 @end smallexample
5260
5261 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5262 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5263 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5264 @value{GDBN}.
5265
5266 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5267 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5268 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5269 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5270
5271
5272 @node Reverse Execution
5273 @chapter Running programs backward
5274 @cindex reverse execution
5275 @cindex running programs backward
5276
5277 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5278 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5279 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5280 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5281
5282 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5283 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5284 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5285 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5286 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5287 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5288
5289 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5290 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5291 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5292 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5293 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5294 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5295 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5296 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5297 prior values@footnote{
5298 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5299 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5300 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5301
5302 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5303 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5304 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5305 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5306 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5307 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5308 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5309 }.
5310
5311 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5312 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5313
5314 @table @code
5315 @kindex reverse-continue
5316 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5317 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5318 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5319 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5320 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5321 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5322 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5323
5324 @kindex reverse-step
5325 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5326 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5327 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5328 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5329
5330 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5331 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5332 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5333 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5334 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5335 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5336
5337 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5338 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5339
5340 @kindex reverse-stepi
5341 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5342 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5343 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5344 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5345 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5346 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5347 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5348
5349 @kindex reverse-next
5350 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5351 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5352 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5353 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5354 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5355 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5356 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5357 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5358 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5359 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5360
5361 @kindex reverse-nexti
5362 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5363 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5364 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5365 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5366 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5367 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5368 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5369 frame) is reached.
5370
5371 @kindex reverse-finish
5372 @item reverse-finish
5373 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5374 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5375 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5376 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5377
5378 @kindex set exec-direction
5379 @item set exec-direction
5380 Set the direction of target execution.
5381 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5382 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5383 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5384 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5385 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5386 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5387 @item set exec-direction forward
5388 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5389 This is the default.
5390 @end table
5391
5392
5393 @node Process Record and Replay
5394 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5395 @cindex process record and replay
5396 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5397
5398 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5399 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5400 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5401
5402 @cindex replay mode
5403 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5404 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5405 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5406 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5407 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5408 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5409 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5410 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5411 execution log.
5412
5413 @cindex record mode
5414 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5415 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5416 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5417 for future replay.
5418
5419 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5420 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5421 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5422 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5423 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5424 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5425
5426 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5427 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5428 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5429 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5430
5431 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5432 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5433
5434 @table @code
5435 @kindex target record
5436 @kindex record
5437 @kindex rec
5438 @item target record
5439 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5440 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5441 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5442 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5443 the @kbd{target record} command.
5444
5445 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5446
5447 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5448 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5449 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5450 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5451 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5452
5453 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5454 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5455 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5456 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5457 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5458 support these two modes.
5459
5460 @kindex record stop
5461 @kindex rec s
5462 @item record stop
5463 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5464 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5465 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5466
5467 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5468 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5469 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5470 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5471 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5472
5473 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5474 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5475 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5476 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5477 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5478
5479 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5480 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5481
5482 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5483 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5484 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5485
5486 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5487 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5488 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5489 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5490 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5491 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5492 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5493 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5494
5495 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5496 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5497 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5498
5499 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5500 @item show record insn-number-max
5501 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5502
5503 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5504 @item set record stop-at-limit
5505 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5506 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5507 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5508 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5509 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5510 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5511
5512 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5513 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5514
5515 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5516 @item show record stop-at-limit
5517 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5518
5519 @kindex info record
5520 @item info record
5521 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5522 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5523
5524 @itemize @bullet
5525 @item
5526 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5527 @item
5528 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5529 @item
5530 Highest recorded instruction number.
5531 @item
5532 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5533 @item
5534 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5535 @item
5536 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5537 @end itemize
5538
5539 @kindex record delete
5540 @kindex rec del
5541 @item record delete
5542 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5543 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5544 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5545 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5546 @end table
5547
5548
5549 @node Stack
5550 @chapter Examining the Stack
5551
5552 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5553 stopped and how it got there.
5554
5555 @cindex call stack
5556 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5557 is generated.
5558 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5559 the arguments of the call,
5560 and the local variables of the function being called.
5561 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5562 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5563 stack}.
5564
5565 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5566 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5567
5568 @cindex selected frame
5569 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5570 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5571 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5572 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5573 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5574 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5575
5576 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5577 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5578 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5579
5580 @menu
5581 * Frames:: Stack frames
5582 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5583 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5584 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5585
5586 @end menu
5587
5588 @node Frames
5589 @section Stack Frames
5590
5591 @cindex frame, definition
5592 @cindex stack frame
5593 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5594 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5595 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5596 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5597 which the function is executing.
5598
5599 @cindex initial frame
5600 @cindex outermost frame
5601 @cindex innermost frame
5602 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5603 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5604 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5605 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5606 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5607 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5608 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5609 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5610
5611 @cindex frame pointer
5612 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5613 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5614 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5615 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5616 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5617 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5618
5619 @cindex frame number
5620 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5621 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5622 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5623 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5624 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5625
5626 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5627 @c underflow problems.
5628 @cindex frameless execution
5629 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5630 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5631 @smallexample
5632 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5633 @end smallexample
5634 generates functions without a frame.)
5635 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5636 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5637 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5638 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5639 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5640 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5641 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5642
5643 @table @code
5644 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5645 @cindex current stack frame
5646 @item frame @var{args}
5647 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5648 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5649 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5650 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5651
5652 @kindex select-frame
5653 @cindex selecting frame silently
5654 @item select-frame
5655 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5656 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5657 @code{frame}.
5658 @end table
5659
5660 @node Backtrace
5661 @section Backtraces
5662
5663 @cindex traceback
5664 @cindex call stack traces
5665 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5666 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5667 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5668 stack.
5669
5670 @table @code
5671 @kindex backtrace
5672 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5673 @item backtrace
5674 @itemx bt
5675 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5676 frames in the stack.
5677
5678 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5679 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5680
5681 @item backtrace @var{n}
5682 @itemx bt @var{n}
5683 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5684
5685 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5686 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5687 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5688
5689 @item backtrace full
5690 @itemx bt full
5691 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5692 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5693 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5694 number of frames to print, as described above.
5695 @end table
5696
5697 @kindex where
5698 @kindex info stack
5699 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5700 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5701
5702 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5703 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5704 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5705 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5706 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5707 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5708 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5709 multi-threaded program.
5710
5711 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5712 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5713 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5714 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5715 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5716 line number.
5717
5718 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5719 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 @group
5723 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5724 at builtin.c:993
5725 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5726 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5727 at macro.c:71
5728 (More stack frames follow...)
5729 @end group
5730 @end smallexample
5731
5732 @noindent
5733 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5734 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5735 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5736
5737 @noindent
5738 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5739 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5740 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5741 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5742 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5743
5744 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5745 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5746 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5747 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5748 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5749 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5750 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5751 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5752 such a backtrace might look like:
5753
5754 @smallexample
5755 @group
5756 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5757 at builtin.c:993
5758 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5759 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5760 at macro.c:71
5761 (More stack frames follow...)
5762 @end group
5763 @end smallexample
5764
5765 @noindent
5766 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5767 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5768
5769 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5770 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5771 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5772
5773 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5774 @cindex program entry point
5775 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5776 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5777 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5778 @code{main}@footnote{
5779 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5780 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5781 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5782 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5783 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5784 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5785
5786 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5787 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5788
5789 @table @code
5790 @item set backtrace past-main
5791 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5792 @kindex set backtrace
5793 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5794
5795 @item set backtrace past-main off
5796 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5797 default.
5798
5799 @item show backtrace past-main
5800 @kindex show backtrace
5801 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5802
5803 @item set backtrace past-entry
5804 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5805 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5806 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5807 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5808
5809 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5810 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5811 application. This is the default.
5812
5813 @item show backtrace past-entry
5814 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5815
5816 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5817 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5818 @cindex backtrace limit
5819 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5820 unlimited.
5821
5822 @item show backtrace limit
5823 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5824 @end table
5825
5826 @node Selection
5827 @section Selecting a Frame
5828
5829 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5830 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5831 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5832 of the stack frame just selected.
5833
5834 @table @code
5835 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5836 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5837 @item frame @var{n}
5838 @itemx f @var{n}
5839 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5840 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5841 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5842 @code{main}.
5843
5844 @item frame @var{addr}
5845 @itemx f @var{addr}
5846 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5847 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5848 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5849 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5850 switches between them.
5851
5852 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5853 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5854
5855 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5856 pointer and a program counter.
5857
5858 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5859 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5860
5861 @kindex up
5862 @item up @var{n}
5863 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5864 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5865 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5866
5867 @kindex down
5868 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5869 @item down @var{n}
5870 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5871 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5872 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5873 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5874 @end table
5875
5876 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5877 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5878 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5879 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5880
5881 @need 1000
5882 For example:
5883
5884 @smallexample
5885 @group
5886 (@value{GDBP}) up
5887 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5888 at env.c:10
5889 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5890 @end group
5891 @end smallexample
5892
5893 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5894 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5895 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5896 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5897 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5898 for details.
5899
5900 @table @code
5901 @kindex down-silently
5902 @kindex up-silently
5903 @item up-silently @var{n}
5904 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5905 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5906 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5907 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5908 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5909 distracting.
5910 @end table
5911
5912 @node Frame Info
5913 @section Information About a Frame
5914
5915 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5916 stack frame.
5917
5918 @table @code
5919 @item frame
5920 @itemx f
5921 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5922 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5923 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5924 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5925 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5926
5927 @kindex info frame
5928 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5929 @item info frame
5930 @itemx info f
5931 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5932 including:
5933
5934 @itemize @bullet
5935 @item
5936 the address of the frame
5937 @item
5938 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5939 @item
5940 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5941 @item
5942 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5943 @item
5944 the address of the frame's arguments
5945 @item
5946 the address of the frame's local variables
5947 @item
5948 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5949 @item
5950 which registers were saved in the frame
5951 @end itemize
5952
5953 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5954 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5955 the usual conventions.
5956
5957 @item info frame @var{addr}
5958 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5959 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5960 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5961 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5962 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5963 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5964
5965 @kindex info args
5966 @item info args
5967 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5968
5969 @item info locals
5970 @kindex info locals
5971 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5972 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5973 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5974
5975 @kindex info catch
5976 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5977 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5978 @item info catch
5979 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5980 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5981 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5982 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5983 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5984
5985 @end table
5986
5987
5988 @node Source
5989 @chapter Examining Source Files
5990
5991 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5992 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5993 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5994 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5995 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5996 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5997 source files by explicit command.
5998
5999 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6000 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6001 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6002
6003 @menu
6004 * List:: Printing source lines
6005 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6006 * Edit:: Editing source files
6007 * Search:: Searching source files
6008 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6009 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6010 @end menu
6011
6012 @node List
6013 @section Printing Source Lines
6014
6015 @kindex list
6016 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6017 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6018 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6019 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6020 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6021
6022 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6023
6024 @table @code
6025 @item list @var{linenum}
6026 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6027 current source file.
6028
6029 @item list @var{function}
6030 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6031 @var{function}.
6032
6033 @item list
6034 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6035 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6036 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6037 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6038 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6039
6040 @item list -
6041 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6042 @end table
6043
6044 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6045 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6046 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6047
6048 @table @code
6049 @kindex set listsize
6050 @item set listsize @var{count}
6051 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6052 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6053
6054 @kindex show listsize
6055 @item show listsize
6056 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6057 @end table
6058
6059 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6060 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6061 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6062 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6063 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6064
6065 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6066 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6067 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6068 to specify some source line.
6069
6070 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6071
6072 @table @code
6073 @item list @var{linespec}
6074 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6075
6076 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6077 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6078 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6079 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6080 the same source file as the first linespec.
6081
6082 @item list ,@var{last}
6083 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6084
6085 @item list @var{first},
6086 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6087
6088 @item list +
6089 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6090
6091 @item list -
6092 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6093
6094 @item list
6095 As described in the preceding table.
6096 @end table
6097
6098 @node Specify Location
6099 @section Specifying a Location
6100 @cindex specifying location
6101 @cindex linespec
6102
6103 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6104 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6105 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6106 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6107
6108 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6109 @value{GDBN} understands:
6110
6111 @table @code
6112 @item @var{linenum}
6113 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6114
6115 @item -@var{offset}
6116 @itemx +@var{offset}
6117 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6118 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6119 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6120 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6121 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6122 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6123 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6124 linespec.
6125
6126 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6127 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6128
6129 @item @var{function}
6130 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6131 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6132
6133 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6134 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6135 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6136 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6137 functions in different source files.
6138
6139 @item *@var{address}
6140 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6141 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6142 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6143 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6144 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6145 source files.
6146
6147 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6148 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6149 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6150 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6151 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6152 of @var{address}:
6153
6154 @table @code
6155 @item @var{expression}
6156 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6157
6158 @item @var{funcaddr}
6159 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6160 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6161 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6162 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6163 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6164 (although the Pascal form also works).
6165
6166 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6167 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6168
6169 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6170 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6171 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6172 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6173 functions with identical names in different source files.
6174 @end table
6175
6176 @end table
6177
6178
6179 @node Edit
6180 @section Editing Source Files
6181 @cindex editing source files
6182
6183 @kindex edit
6184 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6185 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6186 The editing program of your choice
6187 is invoked with the current line set to
6188 the active line in the program.
6189 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6190 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6191
6192 @table @code
6193 @item edit @var{location}
6194 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6195 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6196 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6197 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6198 command most commonly used:
6199
6200 @table @code
6201 @item edit @var{number}
6202 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6203
6204 @item edit @var{function}
6205 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6206 @end table
6207
6208 @end table
6209
6210 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6211 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6212 @footnote{
6213 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6214 following command-line syntax:
6215 @smallexample
6216 ex +@var{number} file
6217 @end smallexample
6218 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6219 the file where to start editing.}.
6220 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6221 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6222 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6223 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6224 @smallexample
6225 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6226 export EDITOR
6227 gdb @dots{}
6228 @end smallexample
6229 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6230 @smallexample
6231 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6232 gdb @dots{}
6233 @end smallexample
6234
6235 @node Search
6236 @section Searching Source Files
6237 @cindex searching source files
6238
6239 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6240 regular expression.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @kindex search
6244 @kindex forward-search
6245 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6246 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6247 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6248 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6249 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6250 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6251 @code{fo}.
6252
6253 @kindex reverse-search
6254 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6255 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6256 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6257 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6258 this command as @code{rev}.
6259 @end table
6260
6261 @node Source Path
6262 @section Specifying Source Directories
6263
6264 @cindex source path
6265 @cindex directories for source files
6266 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6267 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6268 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6269 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6270 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6271 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6272 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6273
6274 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6275 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6276 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6277 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6278 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6279 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6280 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6281 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6282 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6283 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6284 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6285
6286 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6287 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6288 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6289 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6290 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6291 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6292
6293 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6294 source files.
6295
6296 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6297 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6298 each line is in the file.
6299
6300 @kindex directory
6301 @kindex dir
6302 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6303 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6304 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6305
6306 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6307 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6308
6309 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6310 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6311 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6312 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6313 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6314 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6315 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6316 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6317 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6318 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6319 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6320 name to look up the sources.
6321
6322 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6323 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6324 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6325 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6326 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6327 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6328 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6329 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6330
6331 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6332 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6333 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6334 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6335 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6336 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6337 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6338
6339 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6340 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6341 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6342 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6343 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6344 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6345 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6346 command.
6347
6348 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6349 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6350 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6351 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6352 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6353 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6354 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6355
6356 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6357 @cindex default source path substitution
6358 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6359 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6360 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6361 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6362 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6363 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6364 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6365 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6366 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6367 together.
6368
6369 @table @code
6370 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6371 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6372 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6373 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6374 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6375 part of absolute file names) or
6376 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6377 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6378
6379 @kindex cdir
6380 @kindex cwd
6381 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6382 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6383 @cindex compilation directory
6384 @cindex current directory
6385 @cindex working directory
6386 @cindex directory, current
6387 @cindex directory, compilation
6388 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6389 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6390 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6391 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6392 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6393 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6394
6395 @item directory
6396 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6397
6398 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6399 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6400
6401 @item show directories
6402 @kindex show directories
6403 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6404
6405 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6406 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6407 @kindex set substitute-path
6408 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6409 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6410 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6411
6412 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6413 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6414
6415 @smallexample
6416 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6417 @end smallexample
6418
6419 @noindent
6420 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6421 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6422 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6423
6424 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6425 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6426 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6427 the substitution.
6428
6429 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6430
6431 @smallexample
6432 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6433 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6434 @end smallexample
6435
6436 @noindent
6437 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6438 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6439 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6440 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6441
6442
6443 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6444 @kindex unset substitute-path
6445 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6446 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6447 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6448
6449 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6450
6451 @item show substitute-path [path]
6452 @kindex show substitute-path
6453 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6454 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6455
6456 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6457 rules.
6458
6459 @end table
6460
6461 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6462 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6463 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6464
6465 @enumerate
6466 @item
6467 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6468
6469 @item
6470 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6471 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6472 directories in one command.
6473 @end enumerate
6474
6475 @node Machine Code
6476 @section Source and Machine Code
6477 @cindex source line and its code address
6478
6479 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6480 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6481 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6482 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6483 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6484 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6485 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6486 well as hex.
6487
6488 @table @code
6489 @kindex info line
6490 @item info line @var{linespec}
6491 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6492 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6493 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6494 @end table
6495
6496 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6497 the object code for the first line of function
6498 @code{m4_changequote}:
6499
6500 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6501 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6502 @smallexample
6503 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6504 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6505 @end smallexample
6506
6507 @noindent
6508 @cindex code address and its source line
6509 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6510 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6511 @smallexample
6512 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6513 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6514 @end smallexample
6515
6516 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6517 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6518 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6519 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6520 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6521 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6522 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6523 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6524 Variables}).
6525
6526 @table @code
6527 @kindex disassemble
6528 @cindex assembly instructions
6529 @cindex instructions, assembly
6530 @cindex machine instructions
6531 @cindex listing machine instructions
6532 @item disassemble
6533 @itemx disassemble /m
6534 @itemx disassemble /r
6535 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6536 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6537 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6538 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6539 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6540 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6541 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6542 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
6543 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump. In that case, the name of
6544 the function is also printed (since there could be several functions in
6545 the given range).
6546
6547 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6548 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6549 @end table
6550
6551 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6552 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6553
6554 @smallexample
6555 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
6556 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6557 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6558 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6559 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6560 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6561 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6562 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6563 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6564 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6565 End of assembler dump.
6566 @end smallexample
6567
6568 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6569 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6573 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6574 5 @{
6575 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6576 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6577 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6578 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6579 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6580
6581 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6582 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6583 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6584
6585 7 return 0;
6586 8 @}
6587 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6588 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6589 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6590
6591 End of assembler dump.
6592 @end smallexample
6593
6594 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6595 mnemonics or other syntax.
6596
6597 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6598 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6599 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6600 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6601 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6602
6603 @table @code
6604 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6605 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6606 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6607 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6608 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6609 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6610
6611 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6612 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6613 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6614 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6615
6616 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6617 @item show disassembly-flavor
6618 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6619 @end table
6620
6621 @table @code
6622 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6623 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6624 @item set disassemble-next-line
6625 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6626 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6627 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6628 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6629 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6630 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6631 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6632 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6633 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6634 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6635 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6636 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6637 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6638 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6639 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6640 instruction.
6641 @end table
6642
6643
6644 @node Data
6645 @chapter Examining Data
6646
6647 @cindex printing data
6648 @cindex examining data
6649 @kindex print
6650 @kindex inspect
6651 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6652 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6653 @c different window or something like that.
6654 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6655 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6656 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6657 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6658 Different Languages}).
6659
6660 @table @code
6661 @item print @var{expr}
6662 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6663 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6664 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6665 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6666 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6667 Formats}.
6668
6669 @item print
6670 @itemx print /@var{f}
6671 @cindex reprint the last value
6672 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6673 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6674 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6675 @end table
6676
6677 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6678 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6679 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6680
6681 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6682 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6683 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6684 Table}.
6685
6686 @menu
6687 * Expressions:: Expressions
6688 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6689 * Variables:: Program variables
6690 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6691 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6692 * Memory:: Examining memory
6693 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6694 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6695 * Value History:: Value history
6696 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6697 * Registers:: Registers
6698 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6699 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6700 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6701 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6702 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6703 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6704 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6705 character set than GDB does
6706 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6707 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6708 @end menu
6709
6710 @node Expressions
6711 @section Expressions
6712
6713 @cindex expressions
6714 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6715 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6716 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6717 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6718 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6719 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6720 @ref{Compilation}.
6721
6722 @cindex arrays in expressions
6723 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6724 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6725 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6726 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6727 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6728 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6729
6730 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6731 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6732 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6733 languages.
6734
6735 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6736 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6737
6738 @cindex casts, in expressions
6739 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6740 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6741 at that address in memory.
6742 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6743
6744 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6745 to programming languages:
6746
6747 @table @code
6748 @item @@
6749 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6750 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6751
6752 @item ::
6753 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6754 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6755
6756 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6757 @cindex type casting memory
6758 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6759 @cindex casts, to view memory
6760 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6761 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6762 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6763 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6764 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6765 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6766 @end table
6767
6768 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6769 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6770 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6771
6772 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6773 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6774 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6775 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6776 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6777 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6778 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6779
6780 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6781 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6782 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6783 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6784 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6785 as well.
6786
6787 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6788 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6789 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6790 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6791 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6792 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6793 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6794 choices.
6795
6796 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6797 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6798 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6799
6800 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6801 @smallexample
6802 @group
6803 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6804 [0] cancel
6805 [1] all
6806 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6807 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6808 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6809 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6810 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6811 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6812 > 2 4 6
6813 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6814 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6815 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6816 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6817 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6818 breakpoints.
6819 (@value{GDBP})
6820 @end group
6821 @end smallexample
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6825 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6826 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6827
6828 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6829 is ambiguous.
6830
6831 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6832 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6833 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6834 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6835 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6836 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6837 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6838 in the use of the menu.
6839
6840 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6841 when an ambiguity is detected.
6842
6843 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6844 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6845
6846 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6847 @item show multiple-symbols
6848 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6849 @end table
6850
6851 @node Variables
6852 @section Program Variables
6853
6854 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6855 in your program.
6856
6857 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6858 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6859
6860 @itemize @bullet
6861 @item
6862 global (or file-static)
6863 @end itemize
6864
6865 @noindent or
6866
6867 @itemize @bullet
6868 @item
6869 visible according to the scope rules of the
6870 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6871 @end itemize
6872
6873 @noindent This means that in the function
6874
6875 @smallexample
6876 foo (a)
6877 int a;
6878 @{
6879 bar (a);
6880 @{
6881 int b = test ();
6882 bar (b);
6883 @}
6884 @}
6885 @end smallexample
6886
6887 @noindent
6888 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6889 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6890 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6891 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6892
6893 @cindex variable name conflict
6894 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6895 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6896 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6897 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6898 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6899 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6900 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6901
6902 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6903 @ifnotinfo
6904 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6905 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6906 @end ifnotinfo
6907 @smallexample
6908 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6909 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6910 @end smallexample
6911
6912 @noindent
6913 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6914 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6915 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6916 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6917
6918 @smallexample
6919 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6920 @end smallexample
6921
6922 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6923 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6924 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6925 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6926 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6927 @c conflict?? --mew
6928
6929 @cindex wrong values
6930 @cindex variable values, wrong
6931 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6932 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6933 @quotation
6934 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6935 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6936 scope, and just before exit.
6937 @end quotation
6938 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6939 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6940 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6941 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6942 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6943 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6944 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6945 variable definitions may be gone.
6946
6947 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6948 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6949 when compiling.
6950
6951 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6952 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6953 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6954 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6955 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6956 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6957 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6958
6959 @smallexample
6960 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6961 @end smallexample
6962
6963 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6964 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6965 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6966 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6967 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6968 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6969 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6970 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6971 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6972 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6973 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6974
6975 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6976 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6977 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6978 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6979
6980 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6981 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6982 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6983 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6984 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6985 For program code
6986
6987 @smallexample
6988 char var0[] = "A";
6989 signed char var1[] = "A";
6990 @end smallexample
6991
6992 You get during debugging
6993 @smallexample
6994 (gdb) print var0
6995 $1 = "A"
6996 (gdb) print var1
6997 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6998 @end smallexample
6999
7000 @node Arrays
7001 @section Artificial Arrays
7002
7003 @cindex artificial array
7004 @cindex arrays
7005 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7006 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7007 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7008 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7009 program.
7010
7011 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7012 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7013 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7014 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7015 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7016 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7017 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7018 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7019 example. If a program says
7020
7021 @smallexample
7022 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7023 @end smallexample
7024
7025 @noindent
7026 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7027
7028 @smallexample
7029 p *array@@len
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7033 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7034 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7035 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7036 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7037
7038 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7039 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7040 The value need not be in memory:
7041 @smallexample
7042 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7043 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7044 @end smallexample
7045
7046 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7047 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7048 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7049 @smallexample
7050 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7051 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7052 @end smallexample
7053
7054 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7055 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7056 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7057 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7058 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7059 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7060 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7061 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7062 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7063 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7064
7065 @smallexample
7066 set $i = 0
7067 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7068 @key{RET}
7069 @key{RET}
7070 @dots{}
7071 @end smallexample
7072
7073 @node Output Formats
7074 @section Output Formats
7075
7076 @cindex formatted output
7077 @cindex output formats
7078 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7079 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7080 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7081 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7082 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7083
7084 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7085 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7086 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7087 letters supported are:
7088
7089 @table @code
7090 @item x
7091 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7092 hexadecimal.
7093
7094 @item d
7095 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7096
7097 @item u
7098 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7099
7100 @item o
7101 Print as integer in octal.
7102
7103 @item t
7104 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7105 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7106 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7107 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7108
7109 @item a
7110 @cindex unknown address, locating
7111 @cindex locate address
7112 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7113 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7114 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7115
7116 @smallexample
7117 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7118 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7119 @end smallexample
7120
7121 @noindent
7122 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7123 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7124
7125 @item c
7126 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7127 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7128 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7129 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7130
7131 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7132 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7133 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7134 data.
7135
7136 @item f
7137 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7138 using typical floating point syntax.
7139
7140 @item s
7141 @cindex printing strings
7142 @cindex printing byte arrays
7143 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7144 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7145 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7146 natural types.
7147
7148 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7149 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7150 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7151 array.
7152
7153 @item r
7154 @cindex raw printing
7155 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7156 use a type-specific pretty-printer. The @samp{r} format bypasses any
7157 pretty-printer which might exist for the value's type.
7158 @end table
7159
7160 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7161
7162 @smallexample
7163 p/x $pc
7164 @end smallexample
7165
7166 @noindent
7167 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7168 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7169
7170 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7171 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7172 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7173
7174 @node Memory
7175 @section Examining Memory
7176
7177 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7178 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7179
7180 @cindex examining memory
7181 @table @code
7182 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7183 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7184 @itemx x @var{addr}
7185 @itemx x
7186 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7187 @end table
7188
7189 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7190 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7191 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7192 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7193 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7194
7195 @table @r
7196 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7197 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7198 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7199 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7200 @c 4.1.2.
7201
7202 @item @var{f}, the display format
7203 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7204 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7205 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7206 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7207 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7208
7209 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7210 The unit size is any of
7211
7212 @table @code
7213 @item b
7214 Bytes.
7215 @item h
7216 Halfwords (two bytes).
7217 @item w
7218 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7219 @item g
7220 Giant words (eight bytes).
7221 @end table
7222
7223 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7224 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
7225 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
7226
7227 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7228 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7229 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7230 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7231 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7232 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7233 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7234 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7235 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7236 a value from memory).
7237 @end table
7238
7239 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7240 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7241 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7242 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7243 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7244
7245 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7246 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7247 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7248 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7249 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7250
7251 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7252 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7253 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7254 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7255 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7256 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7257 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7258 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7259 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7260
7261 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7262 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7263 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7264 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7265 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7266 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7267 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7268
7269 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7270 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7271
7272 @smallexample
7273 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7274 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7275 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7276 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7277 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7278 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7279 @end smallexample
7280
7281 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7282 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7283 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7284 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7285 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7286 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7287 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7288 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7289 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7290
7291 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7292 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7293 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7294
7295 @cindex remote memory comparison
7296 @cindex verify remote memory image
7297 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7298 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7299 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7300 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7301 situations.
7302
7303 @table @code
7304 @kindex compare-sections
7305 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7306 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7307 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7308 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7309 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7310 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7311 remote request.
7312 @end table
7313
7314 @node Auto Display
7315 @section Automatic Display
7316 @cindex automatic display
7317 @cindex display of expressions
7318
7319 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7320 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7321 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7322 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7323 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7324 The automatic display looks like this:
7325
7326 @smallexample
7327 2: foo = 38
7328 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7329 @end smallexample
7330
7331 @noindent
7332 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7333 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7334 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7335 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7336 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7337 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7338
7339 @table @code
7340 @kindex display
7341 @item display @var{expr}
7342 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7343 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7344
7345 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7346
7347 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7348 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7349 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7350 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7351 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7352
7353 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7354 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7355 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7356 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7357 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7358 @end table
7359
7360 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7361 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7362 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7363
7364 @table @code
7365 @kindex delete display
7366 @kindex undisplay
7367 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7368 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7369 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7370
7371 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7372 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7373
7374 @kindex disable display
7375 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7376 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7377 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7378 enabled again later.
7379
7380 @kindex enable display
7381 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7382 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7383 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7384
7385 @item display
7386 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7387 done when your program stops.
7388
7389 @kindex info display
7390 @item info display
7391 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7392 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7393 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7394 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7395 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7396 @end table
7397
7398 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7399 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7400 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7401 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7402 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7403 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7404 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7405 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7406 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7407 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7408 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7409
7410 @node Print Settings
7411 @section Print Settings
7412
7413 @cindex format options
7414 @cindex print settings
7415 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7416 and symbols are printed.
7417
7418 @noindent
7419 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7420
7421 @table @code
7422 @kindex set print
7423 @item set print address
7424 @itemx set print address on
7425 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7426 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7427 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7428 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7429 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7430 @code{set print address on}:
7431
7432 @smallexample
7433 @group
7434 (@value{GDBP}) f
7435 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7436 at input.c:530
7437 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7438 @end group
7439 @end smallexample
7440
7441 @item set print address off
7442 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7443 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7444
7445 @smallexample
7446 @group
7447 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7448 (@value{GDBP}) f
7449 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7450 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7451 @end group
7452 @end smallexample
7453
7454 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7455 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7456 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7457 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7458
7459 @kindex show print
7460 @item show print address
7461 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7462 @end table
7463
7464 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7465 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7466 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7467 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7468 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7469 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7470 it prints a symbolic address:
7471
7472 @table @code
7473 @item set print symbol-filename on
7474 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7475 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7476 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7477 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7478
7479 @item set print symbol-filename off
7480 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7481 default.
7482
7483 @item show print symbol-filename
7484 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7485 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7486 @end table
7487
7488 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7489 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7490 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7491
7492 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7493 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7494
7495 @table @code
7496 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7497 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7498 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7499 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7500 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7501 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7502
7503 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7504 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7505 symbolic address.
7506 @end table
7507
7508 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7509 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7510 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7511 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7512 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7513 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7514 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7515 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7516
7517 @smallexample
7518 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7519 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7520 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7521 @end smallexample
7522
7523 @quotation
7524 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7525 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7526 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7527 @end quotation
7528
7529 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7530
7531 @table @code
7532 @item set print array
7533 @itemx set print array on
7534 @cindex pretty print arrays
7535 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7536 but uses more space. The default is off.
7537
7538 @item set print array off
7539 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7540
7541 @item show print array
7542 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7543 arrays.
7544
7545 @cindex print array indexes
7546 @item set print array-indexes
7547 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7548 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7549 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7550 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7551
7552 @item set print array-indexes off
7553 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7554
7555 @item show print array-indexes
7556 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7557 arrays.
7558
7559 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7560 @cindex number of array elements to print
7561 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7562 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7563 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7564 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7565 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7566 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7567 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7568
7569 @item show print elements
7570 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7571 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7572
7573 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7574 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7575 @cindex printing frame argument values
7576 @cindex print all frame argument values
7577 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7578 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7579 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7580 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7581 values are:
7582
7583 @table @code
7584 @item all
7585 The values of all arguments are printed.
7586
7587 @item scalars
7588 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7589 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7590 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7591 only scalar arguments are shown:
7592
7593 @smallexample
7594 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7595 at frame-args.c:23
7596 @end smallexample
7597
7598 @item none
7599 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7600 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7601
7602 @smallexample
7603 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7604 at frame-args.c:23
7605 @end smallexample
7606 @end table
7607
7608 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7609 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7610 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7611 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7612 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7613 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7614 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7615 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7616 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7617 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7618
7619 @item show print frame-arguments
7620 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7621
7622 @item set print repeats
7623 @cindex repeated array elements
7624 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7625 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7626 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7627 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7628 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7629 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7630 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7631
7632 @item show print repeats
7633 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7634 elements.
7635
7636 @item set print null-stop
7637 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7638 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7639 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7640 contain only short strings.
7641 The default is off.
7642
7643 @item show print null-stop
7644 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7645 @sc{null} character.
7646
7647 @item set print pretty on
7648 @cindex print structures in indented form
7649 @cindex indentation in structure display
7650 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7651 per line, like this:
7652
7653 @smallexample
7654 @group
7655 $1 = @{
7656 next = 0x0,
7657 flags = @{
7658 sweet = 1,
7659 sour = 1
7660 @},
7661 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7662 @}
7663 @end group
7664 @end smallexample
7665
7666 @item set print pretty off
7667 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7668
7669 @smallexample
7670 @group
7671 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7672 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7673 @end group
7674 @end smallexample
7675
7676 @noindent
7677 This is the default format.
7678
7679 @item show print pretty
7680 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7681
7682 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7683 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7684 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7685 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7686 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7687 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7688 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7689 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7690
7691 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7692 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7693 international character sets, and is the default.
7694
7695 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7696 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7697
7698 @item set print union on
7699 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7700 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7701 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7702
7703 @item set print union off
7704 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7705 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7706 instead.
7707
7708 @item show print union
7709 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7710 structures and other unions.
7711
7712 For example, given the declarations
7713
7714 @smallexample
7715 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7716 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7717 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7718 Bug_forms;
7719
7720 struct thing @{
7721 Species it;
7722 union @{
7723 Tree_forms tree;
7724 Bug_forms bug;
7725 @} form;
7726 @};
7727
7728 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7729 @end smallexample
7730
7731 @noindent
7732 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7733
7734 @smallexample
7735 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7736 @end smallexample
7737
7738 @noindent
7739 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7740
7741 @smallexample
7742 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7743 @end smallexample
7744
7745 @noindent
7746 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7747 and in Pascal.
7748 @end table
7749
7750 @need 1000
7751 @noindent
7752 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7753
7754 @table @code
7755 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7756 @item set print demangle
7757 @itemx set print demangle on
7758 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7759 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7760 linkage. The default is on.
7761
7762 @item show print demangle
7763 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7764
7765 @item set print asm-demangle
7766 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7767 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7768 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7769 The default is off.
7770
7771 @item show print asm-demangle
7772 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7773 or demangled form.
7774
7775 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7776 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7777 @kindex set demangle-style
7778 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7779 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7780 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7781
7782 @table @code
7783 @item auto
7784 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7785
7786 @item gnu
7787 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7788 This is the default.
7789
7790 @item hp
7791 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7792
7793 @item lucid
7794 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7795
7796 @item arm
7797 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7798 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7799 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7800 require further enhancement to permit that.
7801
7802 @end table
7803 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7804
7805 @item show demangle-style
7806 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7807
7808 @item set print object
7809 @itemx set print object on
7810 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7811 @cindex display derived types
7812 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7813 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7814 the virtual function table.
7815
7816 @item set print object off
7817 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7818 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7819
7820 @item show print object
7821 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7822
7823 @item set print static-members
7824 @itemx set print static-members on
7825 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7826 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7827
7828 @item set print static-members off
7829 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7830
7831 @item show print static-members
7832 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7833
7834 @item set print pascal_static-members
7835 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7836 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7837 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7838 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7839
7840 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7841 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7842
7843 @item show print pascal_static-members
7844 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7845
7846 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7847 @item set print vtbl
7848 @itemx set print vtbl on
7849 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7850 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7851 @cindex VTBL display
7852 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7853 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7854 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7855
7856 @item set print vtbl off
7857 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7858
7859 @item show print vtbl
7860 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7861 @end table
7862
7863 @node Value History
7864 @section Value History
7865
7866 @cindex value history
7867 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7868 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7869 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7870 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7871 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7872 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7873 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7874 symbol table.
7875
7876 @cindex @code{$}
7877 @cindex @code{$$}
7878 @cindex history number
7879 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7880 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7881 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7882 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7883 history number.
7884
7885 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7886 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7887 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7888 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7889 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7890 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7891 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7892
7893 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7894 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7895
7896 @smallexample
7897 p *$
7898 @end smallexample
7899
7900 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7901 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7902
7903 @smallexample
7904 p *$.next
7905 @end smallexample
7906
7907 @noindent
7908 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7909 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7910
7911 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7912 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7913
7914 @smallexample
7915 print x
7916 set x=5
7917 @end smallexample
7918
7919 @noindent
7920 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7921 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7922
7923 @table @code
7924 @kindex show values
7925 @item show values
7926 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7927 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7928 values} does not change the history.
7929
7930 @item show values @var{n}
7931 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7932
7933 @item show values +
7934 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7935 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7936 @end table
7937
7938 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7939 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7940
7941 @node Convenience Vars
7942 @section Convenience Variables
7943
7944 @cindex convenience variables
7945 @cindex user-defined variables
7946 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7947 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7948 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7949 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7950 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7951
7952 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7953 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7954 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7955 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7956 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7957
7958 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7959 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7960 For example:
7961
7962 @smallexample
7963 set $foo = *object_ptr
7964 @end smallexample
7965
7966 @noindent
7967 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7968 @code{object_ptr}.
7969
7970 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7971 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7972 value with another assignment at any time.
7973
7974 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7975 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7976 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7977 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7978
7979 @table @code
7980 @kindex show convenience
7981 @cindex show all user variables
7982 @item show convenience
7983 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7984 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7985
7986 @kindex init-if-undefined
7987 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7988 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7989 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7990 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7991 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7992 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7993 override default values used in a command script.
7994
7995 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7996 any side-effects do not occur.
7997 @end table
7998
7999 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8000 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8001 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8002
8003 @smallexample
8004 set $i = 0
8005 print bar[$i++]->contents
8006 @end smallexample
8007
8008 @noindent
8009 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8010
8011 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8012 values likely to be useful.
8013
8014 @table @code
8015 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8016 @item $_
8017 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8018 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8019 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8020 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8021 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8022 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8023 to the type of @code{$__}.
8024
8025 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8026 @item $__
8027 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8028 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8029 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8030
8031 @item $_exitcode
8032 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8033 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8034 the program being debugged terminates.
8035
8036 @item $_siginfo
8037 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8038 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8039 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8040 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8041 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8042 @end table
8043
8044 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8045 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8046 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8047
8048 @cindex convenience functions
8049 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8050 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8051 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8052 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8053 @value{GDBN}.
8054
8055 @table @code
8056 @item help function
8057 @kindex help function
8058 @cindex show all convenience functions
8059 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8060 @end table
8061
8062 @node Registers
8063 @section Registers
8064
8065 @cindex registers
8066 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8067 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8068 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8069 your machine.
8070
8071 @table @code
8072 @kindex info registers
8073 @item info registers
8074 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8075 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8076
8077 @kindex info all-registers
8078 @cindex floating point registers
8079 @item info all-registers
8080 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8081 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8082
8083 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8084 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8085 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8086 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8087 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8088 @end table
8089
8090 @cindex stack pointer register
8091 @cindex program counter register
8092 @cindex process status register
8093 @cindex frame pointer register
8094 @cindex standard registers
8095 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8096 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8097 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8098 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8099 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8100 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8101 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8102 you could print the program counter in hex with
8103
8104 @smallexample
8105 p/x $pc
8106 @end smallexample
8107
8108 @noindent
8109 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8110
8111 @smallexample
8112 x/i $pc
8113 @end smallexample
8114
8115 @noindent
8116 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8117 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8118 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8119 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8120 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8121 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8122 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8123
8124 @smallexample
8125 set $sp += 4
8126 @end smallexample
8127
8128 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8129 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8130 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8131 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8132 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8133 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8134 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8135
8136 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8137 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8138 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8139 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8140 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8141 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8142 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8143
8144 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8145 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8146 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8147 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8148 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8149 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8150 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8151 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8152 prints the data in both formats.
8153
8154 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8155 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8156 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8157 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8158 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8159 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8160 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8161
8162 @smallexample
8163 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8164 $1 = @{
8165 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8166 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8167 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8168 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8169 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8170 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8171 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8172 @}
8173 @end smallexample
8174
8175 @noindent
8176 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8177 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8178 value to a @code{struct} member:
8179
8180 @smallexample
8181 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8182 @end smallexample
8183
8184 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8185 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8186 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8187 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8188 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8189 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8190
8191 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8192 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8193 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8194 frame makes no difference.
8195
8196 @node Floating Point Hardware
8197 @section Floating Point Hardware
8198 @cindex floating point
8199
8200 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8201 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8202
8203 @table @code
8204 @kindex info float
8205 @item info float
8206 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8207 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8208 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8209 the ARM and x86 machines.
8210 @end table
8211
8212 @node Vector Unit
8213 @section Vector Unit
8214 @cindex vector unit
8215
8216 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8217 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8218
8219 @table @code
8220 @kindex info vector
8221 @item info vector
8222 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8223 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8224 @end table
8225
8226 @node OS Information
8227 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8228 @cindex OS information
8229
8230 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8231 you debug your program.
8232
8233 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8234 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8235 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8236 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8237 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8238 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8239 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8240 structure.
8241
8242 @table @code
8243 @item info udot
8244 @kindex info udot
8245 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8246 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8247 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8248 the @code{examine} command.
8249 @end table
8250
8251 @cindex auxiliary vector
8252 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8253 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8254 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8255 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8256 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8257 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8258 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8259 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8260 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8261 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8262 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8263 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8264
8265 @table @code
8266 @kindex info auxv
8267 @item info auxv
8268 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8269 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8270 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8271 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8272 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8273 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8274 an unrecognized tag.
8275 @end table
8276
8277 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8278 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8279 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8280 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8281
8282 @table @code
8283 @kindex info os processes
8284 @item info os processes
8285 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8286 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8287 the command corresponding to the process.
8288 @end table
8289
8290 @node Memory Region Attributes
8291 @section Memory Region Attributes
8292 @cindex memory region attributes
8293
8294 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8295 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8296 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8297 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8298 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8299 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8300 user can override the fetched regions.
8301
8302 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8303 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8304 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8305 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8306 all memory.
8307
8308 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8309 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8310
8311 @table @code
8312 @kindex mem
8313 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8314 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8315 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8316 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8317 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8318 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8319
8320 @item mem auto
8321 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8322 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8323
8324 @kindex delete mem
8325 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8326 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8327 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8328
8329 @kindex disable mem
8330 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8331 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8332 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8333 It may be enabled again later.
8334
8335 @kindex enable mem
8336 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8337 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8338
8339 @kindex info mem
8340 @item info mem
8341 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8342 for each region:
8343
8344 @table @emph
8345 @item Memory Region Number
8346 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8347 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8348 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8349
8350 @item Lo Address
8351 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8352
8353 @item Hi Address
8354 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8355
8356 @item Attributes
8357 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8358 @end table
8359 @end table
8360
8361
8362 @subsection Attributes
8363
8364 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8365 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8366 write accesses to a memory region.
8367
8368 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8369 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8370 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8371
8372 @table @code
8373 @item ro
8374 Memory is read only.
8375 @item wo
8376 Memory is write only.
8377 @item rw
8378 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8379 @end table
8380
8381 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8382 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8383 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8384 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8385 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8386
8387 @table @code
8388 @item 8
8389 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8390 @item 16
8391 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8392 @item 32
8393 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8394 @item 64
8395 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8396 @end table
8397
8398 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8399 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8400 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8401 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8402 @c
8403 @c @table @code
8404 @c @item hwbreak
8405 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8406 @c @item swbreak (default)
8407 @c @end table
8408
8409 @subsubsection Data Cache
8410 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8411 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8412 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8413 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8414 registers.
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item cache
8418 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8419 @item nocache
8420 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8421 @end table
8422
8423 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8424 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8425 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8426 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8427 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8428
8429 @table @code
8430 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8431 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8432 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8433 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8434 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8435 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8436 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8437 The default value is @code{on}.
8438 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8439 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8440 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8441 @end table
8442
8443
8444 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8445 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8446 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8447 @c
8448 @c @table @code
8449 @c @item verify
8450 @c @item noverify (default)
8451 @c @end table
8452
8453 @node Dump/Restore Files
8454 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8455 @cindex dump/restore files
8456 @cindex append data to a file
8457 @cindex dump data to a file
8458 @cindex restore data from a file
8459
8460 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8461 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8462 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8463 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8464 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8465 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8466 files.
8467
8468 @table @code
8469
8470 @kindex dump
8471 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8472 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8473 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8474 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8475
8476 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8477 @table @code
8478 @item binary
8479 Raw binary form.
8480 @item ihex
8481 Intel hex format.
8482 @item srec
8483 Motorola S-record format.
8484 @item tekhex
8485 Tektronix Hex format.
8486 @end table
8487
8488 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8489 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8490 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8491 form.
8492
8493 @kindex append
8494 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8495 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8496 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8497 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8498 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8499
8500 @kindex restore
8501 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8502 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8503 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8504 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8505 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8506
8507 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8508 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8509 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8510 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8511 from that location.
8512
8513 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8514 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8515 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8516 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8517
8518 @end table
8519
8520 @node Core File Generation
8521 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8522 @cindex dump core from inferior
8523
8524 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8525 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8526 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8527 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8528 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8529 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8530 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8531
8532 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8533 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8534 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8535
8536 @table @code
8537 @kindex gcore
8538 @kindex generate-core-file
8539 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8540 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8541 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8542 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8543 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8544 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8545
8546 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8547 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8548 @end table
8549
8550 @node Character Sets
8551 @section Character Sets
8552 @cindex character sets
8553 @cindex charset
8554 @cindex translating between character sets
8555 @cindex host character set
8556 @cindex target character set
8557
8558 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8559 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8560 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8561 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8562 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8563 @dfn{target character set}.
8564
8565 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8566 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8567 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8568 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8569 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8570 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8571 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8572 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8573 character and string literals in expressions.
8574
8575 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8576 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8577 target-charset} command, described below.
8578
8579 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8580 support:
8581
8582 @table @code
8583 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8584 @kindex set target-charset
8585 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8586 list of supported target character sets, type
8587 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8588
8589 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8590 @kindex set host-charset
8591 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8592
8593 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8594 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8595 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8596 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8597 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8598
8599 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8600 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8601 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8602
8603 @item set charset @var{charset}
8604 @kindex set charset
8605 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8606 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8607 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8608 for both host and target.
8609
8610 @item show charset
8611 @kindex show charset
8612 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8613
8614 @item show host-charset
8615 @kindex show host-charset
8616 Show the name of the current host character set.
8617
8618 @item show target-charset
8619 @kindex show target-charset
8620 Show the name of the current target character set.
8621
8622 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8623 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8624 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8625 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8626 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8627 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8628
8629 @item show target-wide-charset
8630 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8631 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8632 @end table
8633
8634 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8635 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8636 @file{charset-test.c}:
8637
8638 @smallexample
8639 #include <stdio.h>
8640
8641 char ascii_hello[]
8642 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8643 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8644 char ibm1047_hello[]
8645 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8646 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8647
8648 main ()
8649 @{
8650 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8651 @}
8652 @end smallexample
8653
8654 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8655 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8656 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8657
8658 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8659
8660 @smallexample
8661 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8662 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8663 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8664 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8665 @dots{}
8666 (@value{GDBP})
8667 @end smallexample
8668
8669 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8670 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8671 strings:
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8675 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8676 (@value{GDBP})
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8680 initial character set:
8681 @smallexample
8682 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8683 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8684 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8685 (@value{GDBP})
8686 @end smallexample
8687
8688 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8689 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8690 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8691 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8692 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8693
8694 @smallexample
8695 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8696 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8697 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8698 $2 = 72 'H'
8699 (@value{GDBP})
8700 @end smallexample
8701
8702 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8703 literals you use in expressions:
8704
8705 @smallexample
8706 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8707 $3 = 43 '+'
8708 (@value{GDBP})
8709 @end smallexample
8710
8711 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8712 character.
8713
8714 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8715 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8716 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8717
8718 @smallexample
8719 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8720 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8721 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8722 $5 = 200 '\310'
8723 (@value{GDBP})
8724 @end smallexample
8725
8726 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8727 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8728
8729 @smallexample
8730 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8731 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8732 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8733 @end smallexample
8734
8735 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8736 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8737 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8738 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8739 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8740
8741 @smallexample
8742 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8743 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8744 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8745 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8746 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8747 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8748 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8749 $7 = 72 '\110'
8750 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8751 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8752 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8753 $9 = 200 'H'
8754 (@value{GDBP})
8755 @end smallexample
8756
8757 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8758 string literals you use in expressions:
8759
8760 @smallexample
8761 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8762 $10 = 78 '+'
8763 (@value{GDBP})
8764 @end smallexample
8765
8766 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8767 character.
8768
8769 @node Caching Remote Data
8770 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8771 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8772
8773 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
8774 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8775 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8776 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
8777 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
8778 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
8779 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
8780 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
8781 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
8782 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
8783 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
8784 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
8785 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
8786 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
8787 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
8788
8789 @table @code
8790 @kindex set remotecache
8791 @item set remotecache on
8792 @itemx set remotecache off
8793 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
8794 with old scripts.
8795
8796 @kindex show remotecache
8797 @item show remotecache
8798 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
8799
8800 @kindex set stack-cache
8801 @item set stack-cache on
8802 @itemx set stack-cache off
8803 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
8804 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
8805
8806 @kindex show stack-cache
8807 @item show stack-cache
8808 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
8809
8810 @kindex info dcache
8811 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
8812 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8813 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
8814 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
8815 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
8816 operation.
8817
8818 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
8819 printed in hex.
8820 @end table
8821
8822 @node Searching Memory
8823 @section Search Memory
8824 @cindex searching memory
8825
8826 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8827 @code{find} command.
8828
8829 @table @code
8830 @kindex find
8831 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8832 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8833 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8834 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8835 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8836 @end table
8837
8838 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8839 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8840
8841 @table @r
8842 @item @var{s}, search query size
8843 The size of each search query value.
8844
8845 @table @code
8846 @item b
8847 bytes
8848 @item h
8849 halfwords (two bytes)
8850 @item w
8851 words (four bytes)
8852 @item g
8853 giant words (eight bytes)
8854 @end table
8855
8856 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8857 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8858 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8859
8860 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8861 value's type in the current language.
8862 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8863 pattern as a mixture of types.
8864 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8865 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8866 which is typically four bytes.
8867
8868 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8869 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8870 @end table
8871
8872 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8873 (@code{"}).
8874 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8875 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8876
8877 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8878 number of matches found.
8879
8880 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8881 @samp{$_}.
8882 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8883
8884 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8885
8886 @smallexample
8887 void
8888 hello ()
8889 @{
8890 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8891 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8892 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8893 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8894 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8895 @}
8896 @end smallexample
8897
8898 @noindent
8899 you get during debugging:
8900
8901 @smallexample
8902 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8903 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8904 1 pattern found
8905 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8906 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8907 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8908 2 patterns found
8909 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8910 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8911 1 pattern found
8912 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8913 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8914 1 pattern found
8915 (gdb) print $numfound
8916 $1 = 1
8917 (gdb) print $_
8918 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8919 @end smallexample
8920
8921 @node Optimized Code
8922 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
8923 @cindex optimized code, debugging
8924 @cindex debugging optimized code
8925
8926 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
8927 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
8928 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
8929 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
8930 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
8931 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
8932 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
8933
8934 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
8935 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
8936 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
8937 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
8938
8939 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
8940 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
8941 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
8942 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
8943 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
8944 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
8945
8946 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
8947 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
8948 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
8949 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
8950 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
8951
8952 @menu
8953 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
8954 @end menu
8955
8956 @node Inline Functions
8957 @section Inline Functions
8958 @cindex inline functions, debugging
8959
8960 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
8961 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
8962 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
8963 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
8964 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
8965 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
8966 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
8967 @code{info frame} command.
8968
8969 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
8970 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
8971 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
8972 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
8973 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
8974 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
8975 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
8976 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
8977 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
8978 local variables in the caller.
8979
8980 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
8981 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
8982 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
8983 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
8984 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
8985 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
8986 instructions are executed.
8987
8988 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
8989 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
8990 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
8991 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
8992
8993 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
8994 function calls are the same as normal calls:
8995
8996 @itemize @bullet
8997 @item
8998 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
8999 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9000 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9001 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9002 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9003 function instead.
9004
9005 @item
9006 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9007 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9008 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9009 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9010 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9011 or inside the inlined function instead.
9012
9013 @item
9014 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9015 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9016 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9017 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9018
9019 @end itemize
9020
9021
9022 @node Macros
9023 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9024
9025 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9026 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9027 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9028 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9029 where it was defined.
9030
9031 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9032 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9033 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9034 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9035
9036 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9037 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9038 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9039 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9040 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9041 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9042 see @ref{List}.
9043
9044 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9045 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9046 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9047
9048 @table @code
9049
9050 @kindex macro expand
9051 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9052 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9053 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9054 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9055 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9056 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9057 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9058 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9059 it can be any string of tokens.
9060
9061 @kindex macro exp1
9062 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9063 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9064 @cindex expand macro once
9065 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9066 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9067 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9068 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9069 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9070 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9071 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9072 can be any string of tokens.
9073
9074 @kindex info macro
9075 @cindex macro definition, showing
9076 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9077 @item info macro @var{macro}
9078 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9079 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9080
9081 @kindex macro define
9082 @cindex user-defined macros
9083 @cindex defining macros interactively
9084 @cindex macros, user-defined
9085 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9086 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9087 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9088 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9089 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9090 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9091 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9092 @var{arglist}.
9093
9094 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9095 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9096 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9097 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9098 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9099
9100 @kindex macro undef
9101 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9102 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9103 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9104 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9105 in the program being debugged.
9106
9107 @kindex macro list
9108 @item macro list
9109 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9110 @end table
9111
9112 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9113 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9114 show our source files:
9115
9116 @smallexample
9117 $ cat sample.c
9118 #include <stdio.h>
9119 #include "sample.h"
9120
9121 #define M 42
9122 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9123
9124 main ()
9125 @{
9126 #define N 28
9127 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9128 #undef N
9129 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9130 #define N 1729
9131 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9132 @}
9133 $ cat sample.h
9134 #define Q <
9135 $
9136 @end smallexample
9137
9138 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9139 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9140 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9141 information.
9142
9143 @smallexample
9144 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9145 $
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9149
9150 @smallexample
9151 $ gdb -nw sample
9152 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9153 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9154 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9155 (@value{GDBP})
9156 @end smallexample
9157
9158 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9159 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9160 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9161
9162 @smallexample
9163 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9164 3
9165 4 #define M 42
9166 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9167 6
9168 7 main ()
9169 8 @{
9170 9 #define N 28
9171 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9172 11 #undef N
9173 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9174 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9175 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9176 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9177 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9178 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9179 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9180 #define Q <
9181 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9182 expands to: (42 + 1)
9183 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9184 expands to: once (M + 1)
9185 (@value{GDBP})
9186 @end smallexample
9187
9188 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9189 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9190 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9191 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9192
9193 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9194 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9195
9196 @smallexample
9197 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9198 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9199 (@value{GDBP}) run
9200 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9201
9202 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9203 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9204 (@value{GDBP})
9205 @end smallexample
9206
9207 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9208
9209 @smallexample
9210 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9211 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9212 #define N 28
9213 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9214 expands to: 28 < 42
9215 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9216 $1 = 1
9217 (@value{GDBP})
9218 @end smallexample
9219
9220 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9221 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9222 thereof) in force at each point:
9223
9224 @smallexample
9225 (@value{GDBP}) next
9226 Hello, world!
9227 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9228 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9229 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9230 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9231 (@value{GDBP}) next
9232 We're so creative.
9233 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9234 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9235 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9236 #define N 1729
9237 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9238 expands to: 1729 < 42
9239 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9240 $2 = 0
9241 (@value{GDBP})
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9245 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9246 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9247 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9248
9249 @smallexample
9250 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9251 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9252 -D__STDC__=1
9253 (@value{GDBP})
9254 @end smallexample
9255
9256
9257 @node Tracepoints
9258 @chapter Tracepoints
9259 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9260 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9261
9262 @cindex tracepoints
9263 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9264 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9265 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9266 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9267 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9268 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9269 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9270
9271 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9272 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9273 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9274 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9275 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9276 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9277 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9278 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9279 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9280 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9281 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9282
9283 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9284 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9285 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9286 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9287 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9288 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9289 Packets}.
9290
9291 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9292
9293 @menu
9294 * Set Tracepoints::
9295 * Analyze Collected Data::
9296 * Tracepoint Variables::
9297 @end menu
9298
9299 @node Set Tracepoints
9300 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9301
9302 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9303 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9304 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9305 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9306 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9307 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9308 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9309
9310 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9311 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9312 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9313 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9314 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9315 tracepoint was hit.
9316
9317 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Conditional
9318 expressions and ignore counts on tracepoints have no effect, and
9319 tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} commands when they are
9320 hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific either.
9321
9322 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9323 conditions and actions.
9324
9325 @menu
9326 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9327 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9328 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9329 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9330 * Tracepoint Actions::
9331 * Listing Tracepoints::
9332 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9333 @end menu
9334
9335 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9336 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9337
9338 @table @code
9339 @cindex set tracepoint
9340 @kindex trace
9341 @item trace @var{location}
9342 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9343 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9344 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9345 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9346 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9347 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9348 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9349 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9350 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9351
9352 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9353
9354 @smallexample
9355 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9356
9357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9358
9359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9360
9361 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9362
9363 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9364 @end smallexample
9365
9366 @noindent
9367 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9368
9369 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9370 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9371 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9372 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9373 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9374 information on tracepoint conditions.
9375
9376 @vindex $tpnum
9377 @cindex last tracepoint number
9378 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9379 @cindex tracepoint number
9380 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9381 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9382
9383 @kindex delete tracepoint
9384 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9385 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9386 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9387 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9388 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9389
9390 Examples:
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9394
9395 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9396 @end smallexample
9397
9398 @noindent
9399 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9400 @end table
9401
9402 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9403 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9404
9405 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9406
9407 @table @code
9408 @kindex disable tracepoint
9409 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9410 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9411 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9412 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9413 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9414
9415 @kindex enable tracepoint
9416 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9417 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9418 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9419 run.
9420 @end table
9421
9422 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
9423 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9424
9425 @table @code
9426 @kindex passcount
9427 @cindex tracepoint pass count
9428 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
9429 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
9430 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
9431 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
9432 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
9433 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
9434 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
9435 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
9436 user.
9437
9438 Examples:
9439
9440 @smallexample
9441 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
9442 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
9443
9444 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
9445 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
9446 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9447 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
9448 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
9449 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
9450 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
9451 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
9452 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
9453 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
9454 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
9455 @end smallexample
9456 @end table
9457
9458 @node Tracepoint Conditions
9459 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
9460 @cindex conditional tracepoints
9461 @cindex tracepoint conditions
9462
9463 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
9464 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
9465 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
9466 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
9467 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
9468 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
9469 is true.
9470
9471 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
9472 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
9473 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
9474 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
9475 just as with breakpoints.
9476
9477 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
9478 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
9479 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
9480 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
9481 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
9482 accesses, and so forth.
9483
9484 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
9485 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
9486 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
9487 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
9488 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
9489 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
9490 search through.
9491
9492 @smallexample
9493 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
9494 @end smallexample
9495
9496 @node Tracepoint Actions
9497 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
9498
9499 @table @code
9500 @kindex actions
9501 @cindex tracepoint actions
9502 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9503 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
9504 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
9505 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
9506 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
9507 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
9508 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
9509 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
9510 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
9511 @code{while-stepping}.
9512
9513 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
9514 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
9515 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
9516
9517 @smallexample
9518 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
9519
9520 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
9521
9522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
9523 @end smallexample
9524
9525 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
9526 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
9527 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
9528 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
9529 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
9530 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
9531 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
9532 @code{end} command.
9533
9534 @smallexample
9535 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9536 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9537 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
9538 > collect bar,baz
9539 > collect $regs
9540 > while-stepping 12
9541 > collect $fp, $sp
9542 > end
9543 end
9544 @end smallexample
9545
9546 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
9547 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9548 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
9549 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
9550 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
9551 special arguments are supported:
9552
9553 @table @code
9554 @item $regs
9555 collect all registers
9556
9557 @item $args
9558 collect all function arguments
9559
9560 @item $locals
9561 collect all local variables.
9562 @end table
9563
9564 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
9565 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
9566 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
9567
9568 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
9569 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
9570
9571 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
9572 @item while-stepping @var{n}
9573 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
9574 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
9575 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
9576 its own @code{end} command):
9577
9578 @smallexample
9579 > while-stepping 12
9580 > collect $regs, myglobal
9581 > end
9582 >
9583 @end smallexample
9584
9585 @noindent
9586 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
9587 @code{stepping}.
9588 @end table
9589
9590 @node Listing Tracepoints
9591 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
9592
9593 @table @code
9594 @kindex info tracepoints
9595 @kindex info tp
9596 @cindex information about tracepoints
9597 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9598 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
9599 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
9600 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
9601 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
9602 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
9603
9604 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
9605 tracing:
9606
9607 @itemize @bullet
9608 @item
9609 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
9610 @item
9611 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
9612 @item
9613 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command. The actions
9614 are prefixed with an @samp{A} so as to distinguish them from commands.
9615 @end itemize
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
9619 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
9620 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
9621 pass count 1200
9622 step count 20
9623 A while-stepping 20
9624 A collect globfoo, $regs
9625 A end
9626 A collect globfoo2
9627 A end
9628 (@value{GDBP})
9629 @end smallexample
9630
9631 @noindent
9632 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9633 @end table
9634
9635 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9636 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9637
9638 @table @code
9639 @kindex tstart
9640 @cindex start a new trace experiment
9641 @cindex collected data discarded
9642 @item tstart
9643 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9644 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9645 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9646 experiment.
9647
9648 @kindex tstop
9649 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
9650 @item tstop
9651 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9652 stops collecting data.
9653
9654 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9655 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9656 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9657
9658 @kindex tstatus
9659 @cindex status of trace data collection
9660 @cindex trace experiment, status of
9661 @item tstatus
9662 This command displays the status of the current trace data
9663 collection.
9664 @end table
9665
9666 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9667
9668 @smallexample
9669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9671 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9672 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
9673 > while-stepping 11
9674 > collect $regs
9675 > end
9676 > end
9677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9678 [time passes @dots{}]
9679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9680 @end smallexample
9681
9682
9683 @node Analyze Collected Data
9684 @section Using the Collected Data
9685
9686 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
9687 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
9688 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
9689 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
9690 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
9691 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
9692 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
9693 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
9694 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
9695 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
9696 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
9697 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
9698 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
9699 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
9700 the buffer will fail.
9701
9702 @menu
9703 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
9704 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
9705 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
9706 @end menu
9707
9708 @node tfind
9709 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
9710
9711 @kindex tfind
9712 @cindex select trace snapshot
9713 @cindex find trace snapshot
9714 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
9715 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
9716 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
9717 snapshot is selected.
9718
9719 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
9720
9721 @table @code
9722 @item tfind start
9723 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
9724 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
9725
9726 @item tfind none
9727 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
9728
9729 @item tfind end
9730 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
9731
9732 @item tfind
9733 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
9734
9735 @item tfind -
9736 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
9737 retracing earlier steps.
9738
9739 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
9740 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
9741 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
9742 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
9743 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
9744
9745 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
9746 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
9747 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
9748 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
9749 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
9750
9751 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9752 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
9753 addresses.
9754
9755 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9756 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
9757 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
9758
9759 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
9760 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
9761 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
9762 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
9763 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
9764 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
9765 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
9766 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
9767 @end table
9768
9769 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
9770 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
9771 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
9772 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
9773 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
9774 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
9775 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
9776 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
9777 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
9778 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
9779 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
9780 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
9781 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
9782 tracepoint as the current one.
9783
9784 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
9785 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
9786 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
9787 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9788 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9789
9790 @smallexample
9791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9792 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9793 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9794 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9795 > tfind
9796 > end
9797
9798 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9799 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9800 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9801 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9802 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9803 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9804 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9805 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9806 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9807 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9808 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9809 @end smallexample
9810
9811 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9812 the buffer:
9813
9814 @smallexample
9815 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9817 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9818 > tfind line
9819 > end
9820
9821 Frame 0, X = 1
9822 Frame 7, X = 2
9823 Frame 13, X = 255
9824 @end smallexample
9825
9826 @node tdump
9827 @subsection @code{tdump}
9828 @kindex tdump
9829 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9830 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9831
9832 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9833 the current trace snapshot.
9834
9835 @smallexample
9836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9837 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9838 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9839 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9840 > end
9841
9842 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9843
9844 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9845 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9846 at gdb_test.c:444
9847 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9848
9849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9850 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9851 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9852 d1 0x18 24
9853 d2 0x80 128
9854 d3 0x33 51
9855 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9856 d5 0x22 34
9857 d6 0xe0 224
9858 d7 0x380035 3670069
9859 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
9860 a1 0x3000668 50333288
9861 a2 0x100 256
9862 a3 0x322000 3284992
9863 a4 0x3000698 50333336
9864 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
9865 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
9866 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
9867 ps 0x0 0
9868 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
9869 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9870 fpstatus 0x0 0
9871 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9872 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9873 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9874 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9875 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9876 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9877 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9878 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9879 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9880
9881 (@value{GDBP})
9882 @end smallexample
9883
9884 @node save-tracepoints
9885 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9886 @kindex save-tracepoints
9887 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9888
9889 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9890 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9891 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9892 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9893 Files}).
9894
9895 @node Tracepoint Variables
9896 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9897 @cindex tracepoint variables
9898 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9899
9900 @table @code
9901 @vindex $trace_frame
9902 @item (int) $trace_frame
9903 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9904 snapshot is selected.
9905
9906 @vindex $tracepoint
9907 @item (int) $tracepoint
9908 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9909
9910 @vindex $trace_line
9911 @item (int) $trace_line
9912 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9913
9914 @vindex $trace_file
9915 @item (char []) $trace_file
9916 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9917
9918 @vindex $trace_func
9919 @item (char []) $trace_func
9920 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9921 @end table
9922
9923 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9924 use @code{output} instead.
9925
9926 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9927 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9928 data.
9929
9930 @smallexample
9931 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9932
9933 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9934 > output $trace_file
9935 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9936 > tfind
9937 > end
9938 @end smallexample
9939
9940 @node Overlays
9941 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9942 @cindex overlays
9943
9944 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9945 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9946 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9947 use overlays.
9948
9949 @menu
9950 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9951 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9952 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9953 mapped by asking the inferior.
9954 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9955 @end menu
9956
9957 @node How Overlays Work
9958 @section How Overlays Work
9959 @cindex mapped overlays
9960 @cindex unmapped overlays
9961 @cindex load address, overlay's
9962 @cindex mapped address
9963 @cindex overlay area
9964
9965 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9966 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9967 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9968 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9969 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9970
9971 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9972 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9973 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9974 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9975 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9976 largest overlay as well.
9977
9978 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9979 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9980 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9981 there.
9982
9983 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9984 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9985 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9986
9987 @smallexample
9988 @group
9989 Data Instruction Larger
9990 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9991 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9992 | | | | | |
9993 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9994 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9995 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9996 | and heap | | | | | |
9997 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9998 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9999 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10000 | | | | | |
10001 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10002 address | | | | | |
10003 | overlay | <-' | | |
10004 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10005 | | <---. | | load address
10006 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10007 | | | |
10008 +-----------+ | |
10009 +-----------+
10010 | |
10011 +-----------+
10012
10013 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10014 @end group
10015 @end smallexample
10016
10017 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10018 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10019 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10020 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10021 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10022 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10023 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10024 program and the overlay area.
10025
10026 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10027 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10028 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10029 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10030 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10031 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10032 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10033
10034 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10035 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10036 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10037
10038 @itemize @bullet
10039
10040 @item
10041 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10042 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10043 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10044 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10045
10046 @item
10047 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10048 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10049 your program's performance.
10050
10051 @item
10052 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10053 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10054 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10055 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10056 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10057 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10058 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10059
10060 @item
10061 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10062 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10063 instruction and data spaces.
10064
10065 @end itemize
10066
10067 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
10068 improved in many ways:
10069
10070 @itemize @bullet
10071
10072 @item
10073 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
10074 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
10075 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
10076 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
10077 area in the usual way.
10078
10079 @item
10080 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
10081 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
10082
10083 @item
10084 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
10085 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
10086 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
10087 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
10088 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
10089 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
10090 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
10091
10092 @end itemize
10093
10094
10095 @node Overlay Commands
10096 @section Overlay Commands
10097
10098 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
10099 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
10100 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
10101 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
10102 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
10103 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
10104
10105 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
10106 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
10107
10108 @table @code
10109 @item overlay off
10110 @kindex overlay
10111 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
10112 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
10113 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
10114 overlay support is disabled.
10115
10116 @item overlay manual
10117 @cindex manual overlay debugging
10118 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10119 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
10120 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
10121 commands described below.
10122
10123 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
10124 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
10125 @cindex map an overlay
10126 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
10127 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
10128 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
10129 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
10130 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
10131 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
10132
10133 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
10134 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
10135 @cindex unmap an overlay
10136 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
10137 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
10138 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
10139 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
10140
10141 @item overlay auto
10142 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10143 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
10144 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
10145 Overlay Debugging}.
10146
10147 @item overlay load-target
10148 @itemx overlay load
10149 @cindex reloading the overlay table
10150 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
10151 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
10152 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
10153 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
10154 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
10155
10156 @item overlay list-overlays
10157 @itemx overlay list
10158 @cindex listing mapped overlays
10159 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
10160 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
10161
10162 @end table
10163
10164 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
10165 of the function the address falls in:
10166
10167 @smallexample
10168 (@value{GDBP}) print main
10169 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
10170 @end smallexample
10171 @noindent
10172 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
10173 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
10174 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
10175 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
10176
10177 @smallexample
10178 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10179 No sections are mapped.
10180 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
10181 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
10182 @end smallexample
10183 @noindent
10184 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
10185 name normally:
10186
10187 @smallexample
10188 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10189 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
10190 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
10191 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
10192 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
10193 @end smallexample
10194
10195 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
10196 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
10197 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
10198 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
10199 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
10200
10201 @itemize @bullet
10202 @item
10203 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
10204 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
10205 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
10206 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
10207 @item
10208 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
10209 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
10210 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
10211 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
10212 breakpoints properly.
10213 @end itemize
10214
10215
10216 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
10217 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
10218 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
10219
10220 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
10221 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
10222 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
10223 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
10224 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
10225 current state of the overlays.
10226
10227 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
10228 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
10229
10230 @table @asis
10231
10232 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
10233 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
10234
10235 @smallexample
10236 struct
10237 @{
10238 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
10239 unsigned long vma;
10240
10241 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
10242 unsigned long size;
10243
10244 /* The overlay's load address. */
10245 unsigned long lma;
10246
10247 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
10248 zero otherwise. */
10249 unsigned long mapped;
10250 @}
10251 @end smallexample
10252
10253 @item @code{_novlys}:
10254 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
10255 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
10256
10257 @end table
10258
10259 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
10260 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
10261 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
10262 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
10263 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
10264 currently mapped.
10265
10266 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
10267 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
10268 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
10269 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
10270 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
10271 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
10272 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
10273 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
10274 are not being executed.
10275
10276 @node Overlay Sample Program
10277 @section Overlay Sample Program
10278 @cindex overlay example program
10279
10280 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
10281 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
10282 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
10283 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
10284 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
10285 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
10286 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
10287
10288 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
10289 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
10290 suite. The program consists of the following files from
10291 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
10292
10293 @table @file
10294 @item overlays.c
10295 The main program file.
10296 @item ovlymgr.c
10297 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
10298 @item foo.c
10299 @itemx bar.c
10300 @itemx baz.c
10301 @itemx grbx.c
10302 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
10303 @item d10v.ld
10304 @itemx m32r.ld
10305 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
10306 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
10307 @end table
10308
10309 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
10310 cross-compiler like this:
10311
10312 @smallexample
10313 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
10314 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
10315 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
10316 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
10317 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
10318 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
10319 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
10320 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
10321 @end smallexample
10322
10323 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
10324 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
10325 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
10326
10327
10328 @node Languages
10329 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
10330 @cindex languages
10331
10332 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
10333 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
10334 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
10335 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
10336 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
10337 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
10338
10339 @cindex working language
10340 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
10341 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
10342 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
10343 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
10344 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
10345 language}.
10346
10347 @menu
10348 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
10349 * Show:: Displaying the language
10350 * Checks:: Type and range checks
10351 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
10352 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
10353 @end menu
10354
10355 @node Setting
10356 @section Switching Between Source Languages
10357
10358 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
10359 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
10360 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
10361 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
10362 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
10363 are printed, etc.
10364
10365 In addition to the working language, every source file that
10366 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
10367 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
10368 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
10369 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
10370 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
10371 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
10372 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
10373 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
10374 Displaying the Language}.
10375
10376 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
10377 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
10378 another language. In that case, make the
10379 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
10380 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
10381 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
10382
10383 @menu
10384 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
10385 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
10386 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
10387 @end menu
10388
10389 @node Filenames
10390 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
10391
10392 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
10393 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
10394
10395 @table @file
10396 @item .ada
10397 @itemx .ads
10398 @itemx .adb
10399 @itemx .a
10400 Ada source file.
10401
10402 @item .c
10403 C source file
10404
10405 @item .C
10406 @itemx .cc
10407 @itemx .cp
10408 @itemx .cpp
10409 @itemx .cxx
10410 @itemx .c++
10411 C@t{++} source file
10412
10413 @item .m
10414 Objective-C source file
10415
10416 @item .f
10417 @itemx .F
10418 Fortran source file
10419
10420 @item .mod
10421 Modula-2 source file
10422
10423 @item .s
10424 @itemx .S
10425 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
10426 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
10427 @end table
10428
10429 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
10430 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
10431
10432 @node Manually
10433 @subsection Setting the Working Language
10434
10435 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
10436 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
10437 your program.
10438
10439 @kindex set language
10440 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
10441 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
10442 a language, such as
10443 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
10444 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
10445
10446 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
10447 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
10448 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
10449 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
10450 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
10451 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
10452 command such as:
10453
10454 @smallexample
10455 print a = b + c
10456 @end smallexample
10457
10458 @noindent
10459 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
10460 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
10461 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
10462 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
10463
10464 @node Automatically
10465 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
10466
10467 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
10468 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
10469 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
10470 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
10471 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
10472 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
10473 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
10474 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
10475 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
10476
10477 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
10478 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
10479 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
10480 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
10481 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
10482
10483 @node Show
10484 @section Displaying the Language
10485
10486 The following commands help you find out which language is the
10487 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
10488
10489 @table @code
10490 @item show language
10491 @kindex show language
10492 Display the current working language. This is the
10493 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
10494 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
10495
10496 @item info frame
10497 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
10498 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
10499 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
10500 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
10501 information listed here.
10502
10503 @item info source
10504 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
10505 Display the source language of this source file.
10506 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
10507 information listed here.
10508 @end table
10509
10510 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
10511 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
10512 with a language explicitly:
10513
10514 @table @code
10515 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
10516 @kindex set extension-language
10517 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
10518 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
10519
10520 @item info extensions
10521 @kindex info extensions
10522 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
10523 @end table
10524
10525 @node Checks
10526 @section Type and Range Checking
10527
10528 @quotation
10529 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
10530 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
10531 section documents the intended facilities.
10532 @end quotation
10533 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
10534
10535 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
10536 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
10537 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
10538 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
10539 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
10540 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
10541 errors when your program is running.
10542
10543 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
10544 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
10545 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
10546 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
10547 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
10548 automatically based on your program's source language.
10549 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
10550 settings of supported languages.
10551
10552 @menu
10553 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
10554 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
10555 @end menu
10556
10557 @cindex type checking
10558 @cindex checks, type
10559 @node Type Checking
10560 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
10561
10562 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
10563 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
10564 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
10565 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
10566
10567 @smallexample
10568 1 + 2 @result{} 3
10569 @exdent but
10570 @error{} 1 + 2.3
10571 @end smallexample
10572
10573 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
10574 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
10575
10576 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
10577 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
10578 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
10579 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
10580 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
10581 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
10582 also issues a warning.
10583
10584 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
10585 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
10586 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
10587 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
10588 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
10589 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
10590
10591 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
10592 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
10593 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
10594 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
10595 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
10596 details on specific languages.
10597
10598 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
10599
10600 @kindex set check type
10601 @kindex show check type
10602 @table @code
10603 @item set check type auto
10604 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
10605 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10606 each language.
10607
10608 @item set check type on
10609 @itemx set check type off
10610 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10611 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
10612 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
10613 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
10614 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
10615
10616 @item set check type warn
10617 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
10618 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
10619 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
10620 numbers and structures.
10621
10622 @item show type
10623 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
10624 is setting it automatically.
10625 @end table
10626
10627 @cindex range checking
10628 @cindex checks, range
10629 @node Range Checking
10630 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
10631
10632 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
10633 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
10634 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
10635 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
10636 not exceed the bounds of the array.
10637
10638 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
10639 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
10640 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
10641 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
10642
10643 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
10644 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
10645 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
10646 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
10647 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
10648 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
10649
10650 @smallexample
10651 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
10652 @end smallexample
10653
10654 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
10655 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
10656 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
10657
10658 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
10659
10660 @kindex set check range
10661 @kindex show check range
10662 @table @code
10663 @item set check range auto
10664 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
10665 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10666 each language.
10667
10668 @item set check range on
10669 @itemx set check range off
10670 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10671 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
10672 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
10673 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
10674
10675 @item set check range warn
10676 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
10677 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
10678 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
10679 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
10680 systems).
10681
10682 @item show range
10683 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
10684 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
10685 @end table
10686
10687 @node Supported Languages
10688 @section Supported Languages
10689
10690 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
10691 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
10692 @c This is false ...
10693 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
10694 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
10695 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
10696 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
10697 language.
10698
10699 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
10700 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
10701 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
10702 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
10703 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
10704 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
10705 language reference or tutorial.
10706
10707 @menu
10708 * C:: C and C@t{++}
10709 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
10710 * Fortran:: Fortran
10711 * Pascal:: Pascal
10712 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
10713 * Ada:: Ada
10714 @end menu
10715
10716 @node C
10717 @subsection C and C@t{++}
10718
10719 @cindex C and C@t{++}
10720 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
10721
10722 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
10723 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
10724 together.
10725
10726 @cindex C@t{++}
10727 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
10728 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
10729 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
10730 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
10731 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
10732 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
10733 compiler (@code{aCC}).
10734
10735 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
10736 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
10737 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
10738 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
10739 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
10740 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
10741
10742 @menu
10743 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
10744 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
10745 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
10746 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
10747 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
10748 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
10749 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
10750 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
10751 @end menu
10752
10753 @node C Operators
10754 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
10755
10756 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
10757
10758 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10759 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10760 often defined on groups of types.
10761
10762 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
10763
10764 @itemize @bullet
10765
10766 @item
10767 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
10768 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
10769
10770 @item
10771 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
10772 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
10773
10774 @item
10775 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
10776
10777 @item
10778 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
10779
10780 @end itemize
10781
10782 @noindent
10783 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
10784 in order of increasing precedence:
10785
10786 @table @code
10787 @item ,
10788 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10789 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10790 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10791
10792 @item =
10793 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10794 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10795
10796 @item @var{op}=
10797 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10798 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10799 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10800 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10801 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10802
10803 @item ?:
10804 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10805 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10806 integral type.
10807
10808 @item ||
10809 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10810
10811 @item &&
10812 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10813
10814 @item |
10815 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10816
10817 @item ^
10818 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10819
10820 @item &
10821 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10822
10823 @item ==@r{, }!=
10824 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10825 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10826
10827 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10828 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10829 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10830 and non-zero for true.
10831
10832 @item <<@r{, }>>
10833 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10834
10835 @item @@
10836 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10837
10838 @item +@r{, }-
10839 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10840 pointer types.
10841
10842 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10843 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10844 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10845 integral types.
10846
10847 @item ++@r{, }--
10848 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10849 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10850 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10851 operation takes place.
10852
10853 @item *
10854 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10855 @code{++}.
10856
10857 @item &
10858 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
10859
10860 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
10861 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
10862 to examine the address
10863 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
10864 stored.
10865
10866 @item -
10867 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
10868 precedence as @code{++}.
10869
10870 @item !
10871 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10872 @code{++}.
10873
10874 @item ~
10875 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10876 @code{++}.
10877
10878
10879 @item .@r{, }->
10880 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10881 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10882 pointer based on the stored type information.
10883 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10884
10885 @item .*@r{, }->*
10886 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10887
10888 @item []
10889 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10890 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10891
10892 @item ()
10893 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10894
10895 @item ::
10896 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10897 and @code{class} types.
10898
10899 @item ::
10900 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10901 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10902 above.
10903 @end table
10904
10905 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10906 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10907 predefined meaning.
10908
10909 @node C Constants
10910 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10911
10912 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10913
10914 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10915 following ways:
10916
10917 @itemize @bullet
10918 @item
10919 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10920 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10921 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10922 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10923 @code{long} value.
10924
10925 @item
10926 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10927 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10928 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10929 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10930 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10931 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10932 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10933 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10934 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10935 constant.
10936
10937 @item
10938 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10939 integral equivalents.
10940
10941 @item
10942 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10943 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10944 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10945 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10946 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10947 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10948 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10949 @samp{\n} for newline.
10950
10951 @item
10952 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10953 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10954 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10955 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10956 characters.
10957
10958 @item
10959 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10960 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10961
10962 @item
10963 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10964 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10965 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10966 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10967 @end itemize
10968
10969 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10970 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10971
10972 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10973 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10974
10975 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10976 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10977 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10978 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10979 @quotation
10980 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10981 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10982 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10983 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10984 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10985 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10986 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10987 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10988 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10989 C@t{++} code.
10990 @end quotation
10991
10992 @enumerate
10993
10994 @cindex member functions
10995 @item
10996 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10997
10998 @smallexample
10999 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11000 @end smallexample
11001
11002 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11003 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11004 @item
11005 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11006 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11007 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11008 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11009
11010 @cindex call overloaded functions
11011 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11012 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11013 @item
11014 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11015 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11016 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11017 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11018 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11019 default arguments.
11020
11021 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11022 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11023 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11024 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11025 number of function arguments.
11026
11027 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11028 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11029 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11030
11031 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11032 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11033 @smallexample
11034 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11038 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11039
11040 @cindex reference declarations
11041 @item
11042 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11043 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11044 dereferenced.
11045
11046 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11047 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11048 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11049 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11050 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11051
11052 @item
11053 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11054 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11055 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11056 necessary, for example in an expression like
11057 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11058 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11059 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
11060 @end enumerate
11061
11062 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
11063 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
11064 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
11065 invoking user-defined operators.
11066
11067 @node C Defaults
11068 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
11069
11070 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
11071
11072 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
11073 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
11074 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11075 selects the working language.
11076
11077 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
11078 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
11079 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
11080 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
11081 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
11082 for further details.
11083
11084 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
11085 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
11086 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
11087
11088 @node C Checks
11089 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
11090
11091 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
11092
11093 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
11094 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
11095 considers two variables type equivalent if:
11096
11097 @itemize @bullet
11098 @item
11099 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
11100 enumerated tag.
11101
11102 @item
11103 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
11104 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
11105
11106 @ignore
11107 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
11108 @c FIXME--beers?
11109 @item
11110 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
11111 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
11112 compilers.)
11113 @end ignore
11114 @end itemize
11115
11116 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
11117 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
11118 that is not itself an array.
11119
11120 @node Debugging C
11121 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
11122
11123 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
11124 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
11125 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
11126 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
11127
11128 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
11129 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
11130 ,Expressions}.
11131
11132 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
11133 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
11134
11135 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
11136
11137 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
11138 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
11139
11140 @table @code
11141 @cindex break in overloaded functions
11142 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
11143 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
11144 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
11145 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
11146 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
11147
11148 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
11149 @item rbreak @var{regex}
11150 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
11151 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
11152 classes.
11153 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11154
11155 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
11156 @item catch throw
11157 @itemx catch catch
11158 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
11159 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
11160
11161 @cindex inheritance
11162 @item ptype @var{typename}
11163 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
11164 @var{typename}.
11165 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
11166
11167 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
11168 @item set print demangle
11169 @itemx show print demangle
11170 @itemx set print asm-demangle
11171 @itemx show print asm-demangle
11172 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
11173 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
11174 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11175
11176 @item set print object
11177 @itemx show print object
11178 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
11179 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11180
11181 @item set print vtbl
11182 @itemx show print vtbl
11183 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
11184 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11185 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11186 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11187
11188 @kindex set overload-resolution
11189 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
11190 @item set overload-resolution on
11191 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
11192 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
11193 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
11194 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
11195 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
11196 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
11197
11198 @item set overload-resolution off
11199 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
11200 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11201 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
11202 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
11203 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11204 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
11205 argument types.
11206
11207 @kindex show overload-resolution
11208 @item show overload-resolution
11209 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
11210
11211 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
11212 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
11213 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
11214 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
11215 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
11216 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
11217 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
11218 @end table
11219
11220 @node Decimal Floating Point
11221 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
11222 @cindex decimal floating point format
11223
11224 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
11225 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
11226 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
11227 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
11228
11229 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
11230 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
11231 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
11232 target.
11233
11234 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
11235 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
11236 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
11237
11238 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
11239 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
11240 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
11241
11242 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
11243 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
11244 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
11245
11246 @node Objective-C
11247 @subsection Objective-C
11248
11249 @cindex Objective-C
11250 This section provides information about some commands and command
11251 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
11252 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
11253 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
11254
11255 @menu
11256 * Method Names in Commands::
11257 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
11258 @end menu
11259
11260 @node Method Names in Commands
11261 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
11262
11263 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
11264 names as line specifications:
11265
11266 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
11267 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
11268 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
11269 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
11270 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
11271 @itemize
11272 @item @code{clear}
11273 @item @code{break}
11274 @item @code{info line}
11275 @item @code{jump}
11276 @item @code{list}
11277 @end itemize
11278
11279 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
11280
11281 @smallexample
11282 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
11283 @end smallexample
11284
11285 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
11286 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
11287 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
11288 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
11289 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
11290 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
11291 debugged, enter:
11292
11293 @smallexample
11294 break -[Fruit create]
11295 @end smallexample
11296
11297 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
11298 enter:
11299
11300 @smallexample
11301 list +[NSText initialize]
11302 @end smallexample
11303
11304 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
11305 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
11306 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
11307 is also possible to specify just a method name:
11308
11309 @smallexample
11310 break create
11311 @end smallexample
11312
11313 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
11314 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
11315 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
11316 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
11317 none apply.
11318
11319 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
11320 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
11321
11322 @smallexample
11323 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
11324 @end smallexample
11325
11326 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
11327 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
11328 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
11329 @kindex print-object
11330 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
11331
11332 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
11333
11334 @smallexample
11335 print -[@var{object} hash]
11336 @end smallexample
11337
11338 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
11339 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
11340 @noindent
11341 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
11342 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
11343 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
11344 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
11345 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
11346 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
11347
11348 @node Fortran
11349 @subsection Fortran
11350 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
11351
11352 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
11353 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
11354
11355 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
11356 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
11357 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
11358 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
11359 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
11360 underscore.
11361
11362 @menu
11363 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
11364 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
11365 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
11366 @end menu
11367
11368 @node Fortran Operators
11369 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
11370
11371 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
11372
11373 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11374 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
11375 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
11376
11377 @table @code
11378 @item **
11379 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
11380 of the second one.
11381
11382 @item :
11383 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
11384 represent a section of array.
11385
11386 @item %
11387 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
11388 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
11389 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
11390 union type.
11391 @end table
11392
11393 @node Fortran Defaults
11394 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
11395
11396 @cindex Fortran Defaults
11397
11398 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
11399 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
11400 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
11401 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
11402
11403 @node Special Fortran Commands
11404 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
11405
11406 @cindex Special Fortran commands
11407
11408 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
11409 such as displaying common blocks.
11410
11411 @table @code
11412 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
11413 @kindex info common
11414 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
11415 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
11416 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
11417 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
11418 printed.
11419 @end table
11420
11421 @node Pascal
11422 @subsection Pascal
11423
11424 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
11425 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
11426 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
11427 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
11428 syntax.
11429
11430 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
11431 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
11432 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
11433
11434 @node Modula-2
11435 @subsection Modula-2
11436
11437 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
11438
11439 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
11440 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
11441 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
11442 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11443 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
11444 table.
11445
11446 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
11447 @menu
11448 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
11449 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
11450 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
11451 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
11452 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
11453 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
11454 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
11455 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11456 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11457 @end menu
11458
11459 @node M2 Operators
11460 @subsubsection Operators
11461 @cindex Modula-2 operators
11462
11463 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11464 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11465 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
11466 following definitions hold:
11467
11468 @itemize @bullet
11469
11470 @item
11471 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
11472 their subranges.
11473
11474 @item
11475 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
11476
11477 @item
11478 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
11479
11480 @item
11481 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
11482 @var{type}}.
11483
11484 @item
11485 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
11486
11487 @item
11488 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
11489
11490 @item
11491 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
11492 @end itemize
11493
11494 @noindent
11495 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
11496 increasing precedence:
11497
11498 @table @code
11499 @item ,
11500 Function argument or array index separator.
11501
11502 @item :=
11503 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
11504 @var{value}.
11505
11506 @item <@r{, }>
11507 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
11508 types.
11509
11510 @item <=@r{, }>=
11511 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
11512 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
11513 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
11514
11515 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
11516 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
11517 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
11518 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
11519 comment character.
11520
11521 @item IN
11522 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
11523 Same precedence as @code{<}.
11524
11525 @item OR
11526 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11527
11528 @item AND@r{, }&
11529 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11530
11531 @item @@
11532 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11533
11534 @item +@r{, }-
11535 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
11536 and difference on set types.
11537
11538 @item *
11539 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
11540 on set types.
11541
11542 @item /
11543 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
11544 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
11545
11546 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
11547 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
11548 precedence as @code{*}.
11549
11550 @item -
11551 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
11552
11553 @item ^
11554 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
11555
11556 @item NOT
11557 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
11558 @code{^}.
11559
11560 @item .
11561 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
11562 precedence as @code{^}.
11563
11564 @item []
11565 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
11566
11567 @item ()
11568 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
11569 as @code{^}.
11570
11571 @item ::@r{, }.
11572 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
11573 @end table
11574
11575 @quotation
11576 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
11577 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
11578 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
11579 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
11580 @end quotation
11581
11582
11583 @node Built-In Func/Proc
11584 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
11585 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
11586
11587 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
11588 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
11589
11590 @table @var
11591
11592 @item a
11593 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
11594
11595 @item c
11596 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
11597
11598 @item i
11599 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
11600
11601 @item m
11602 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
11603 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
11604 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
11605
11606 @item n
11607 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
11608
11609 @item r
11610 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
11611
11612 @item t
11613 represents a type.
11614
11615 @item v
11616 represents a variable.
11617
11618 @item x
11619 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
11620 explanation of the function for details.
11621 @end table
11622
11623 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
11624
11625 @table @code
11626 @item ABS(@var{n})
11627 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
11628
11629 @item CAP(@var{c})
11630 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
11631 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
11632
11633 @item CHR(@var{i})
11634 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11635
11636 @item DEC(@var{v})
11637 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11638
11639 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
11640 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11641 new value.
11642
11643 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11644 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
11645 set.
11646
11647 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
11648 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
11649
11650 @item HIGH(@var{a})
11651 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
11652
11653 @item INC(@var{v})
11654 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11655
11656 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
11657 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11658 new value.
11659
11660 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11661 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
11662 there. Returns the new set.
11663
11664 @item MAX(@var{t})
11665 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
11666
11667 @item MIN(@var{t})
11668 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
11669
11670 @item ODD(@var{i})
11671 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
11672
11673 @item ORD(@var{x})
11674 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
11675 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
11676 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
11677 integral, character and enumerated types.
11678
11679 @item SIZE(@var{x})
11680 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11681
11682 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
11683 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
11684
11685 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
11686 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11687
11688 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
11689 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11690 @end table
11691
11692 @quotation
11693 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
11694 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
11695 an error.
11696 @end quotation
11697
11698 @cindex Modula-2 constants
11699 @node M2 Constants
11700 @subsubsection Constants
11701
11702 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
11703 ways:
11704
11705 @itemize @bullet
11706
11707 @item
11708 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
11709 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
11710 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
11711 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
11712
11713 @item
11714 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
11715 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
11716 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
11717 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
11718 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
11719 digits.
11720
11721 @item
11722 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
11723 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
11724 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
11725 followed by a @samp{C}.
11726
11727 @item
11728 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
11729 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
11730 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
11731 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
11732 sequences.
11733
11734 @item
11735 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
11736
11737 @item
11738 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
11739 @code{FALSE}.
11740
11741 @item
11742 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
11743
11744 @item
11745 Set constants are not yet supported.
11746 @end itemize
11747
11748 @node M2 Types
11749 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
11750 @cindex Modula-2 types
11751
11752 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
11753 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
11754 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
11755 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
11756 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
11757 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
11758
11759 The first example contains the following section of code:
11760
11761 @smallexample
11762 VAR
11763 s: SET OF CHAR ;
11764 r: [20..40] ;
11765 @end smallexample
11766
11767 @noindent
11768 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
11769 @code{r} and @code{s}.
11770
11771 @smallexample
11772 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11773 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
11774 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11775 SET OF CHAR
11776 (@value{GDBP}) print r
11777 21
11778 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
11779 [20..40]
11780 @end smallexample
11781
11782 @noindent
11783 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
11784
11785 @smallexample
11786 VAR
11787 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11788 @end smallexample
11789
11790 @noindent
11791 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11792
11793 @smallexample
11794 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11795 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11796 @end smallexample
11797
11798 @noindent
11799 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11800 expressions using the debugger.
11801
11802 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11803 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11804
11805 @smallexample
11806 VAR
11807 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11808 @end smallexample
11809
11810 @smallexample
11811 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11812 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11813 @end smallexample
11814
11815 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11816 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11817 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11818 above.
11819
11820 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11821
11822 @smallexample
11823 TYPE
11824 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11825 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11826 VAR
11827 s: t ;
11828 BEGIN
11829 s := blue ;
11830 @end smallexample
11831
11832 @noindent
11833 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11834 and value of a variable.
11835
11836 @smallexample
11837 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11838 $1 = blue
11839 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11840 type = [blue..yellow]
11841 @end smallexample
11842
11843 @noindent
11844 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11845 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11846 their @code{C} counterparts.
11847
11848 @smallexample
11849 VAR
11850 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11851 BEGIN
11852 s[1] := 1 ;
11853 @end smallexample
11854
11855 @smallexample
11856 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11857 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
11858 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11859 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11860 @end smallexample
11861
11862 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
11863 pointer types as shown in this example:
11864
11865 @smallexample
11866 VAR
11867 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11868 BEGIN
11869 NEW(s) ;
11870 s^[1] := 1 ;
11871 @end smallexample
11872
11873 @noindent
11874 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11875
11876 @smallexample
11877 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11878 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11879 @end smallexample
11880
11881 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11882 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11883 types:
11884
11885 @smallexample
11886 TYPE
11887 foo = RECORD
11888 f1: CARDINAL ;
11889 f2: CHAR ;
11890 f3: myarray ;
11891 END ;
11892
11893 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11894 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11895 VAR
11896 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11897 @end smallexample
11898
11899 @noindent
11900 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11901 below.
11902
11903 @smallexample
11904 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11905 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11906 f1 : CARDINAL;
11907 f2 : CHAR;
11908 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11909 END
11910 @end smallexample
11911
11912 @node M2 Defaults
11913 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11914 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11915
11916 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11917 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11918 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11919 selected the working language.
11920
11921 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11922 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11923 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11924 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11925
11926 @node Deviations
11927 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11928 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11929
11930 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11931 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11932
11933 @itemize @bullet
11934 @item
11935 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11936 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11937 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11938 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11939 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11940 returned a pointer.)
11941
11942 @item
11943 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11944 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11945 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11946 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11947
11948 @item
11949 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11950 argument.
11951
11952 @item
11953 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11954 @end itemize
11955
11956 @node M2 Checks
11957 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11958 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11959
11960 @quotation
11961 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11962 range checking.
11963 @end quotation
11964 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11965
11966 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11967
11968 @itemize @bullet
11969 @item
11970 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11971 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11972
11973 @item
11974 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11975 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11976 @end itemize
11977
11978 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11979 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11980
11981 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11982 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11983
11984 @node M2 Scope
11985 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11986 @cindex scope
11987 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11988 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11989 @ifinfo
11990 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11991 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11992 @end ifinfo
11993 @ifnotinfo
11994 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11995 @end ifnotinfo
11996
11997 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11998 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11999 similar syntax:
12000
12001 @smallexample
12002
12003 @var{module} . @var{id}
12004 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
12005 @end smallexample
12006
12007 @noindent
12008 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12009 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12010 identifier within your program, except another module.
12011
12012 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12013 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12014 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12015 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
12016
12017 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
12018 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
12019 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
12020 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
12021 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
12022 @var{module}.
12023
12024 @node GDB/M2
12025 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12026
12027 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
12028 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
12029 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
12030 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
12031 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
12032 analogue in Modula-2.
12033
12034 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
12035 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
12036 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
12037 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
12038 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
12039 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
12040
12041 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
12042 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
12043 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
12044
12045 @node Ada
12046 @subsection Ada
12047 @cindex Ada
12048
12049 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
12050 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
12051 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
12052 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12053 to be difficult.
12054
12055
12056 @cindex expressions in Ada
12057 @menu
12058 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
12059 and semantics supported by Ada mode
12060 in @value{GDBN}.
12061 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
12062 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
12063 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
12064 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
12065 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12066 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
12067 @end menu
12068
12069 @node Ada Mode Intro
12070 @subsubsection Introduction
12071 @cindex Ada mode, general
12072
12073 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
12074 syntax, with some extensions.
12075 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
12076
12077 @itemize @bullet
12078 @item
12079 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
12080 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
12081 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
12082 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
12083
12084 @item
12085 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
12086 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12087
12088 @item
12089 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12090 @end itemize
12091
12092 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
12093 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
12094 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
12095 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
12096 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
12097
12098 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
12099 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
12100 was translated from an Ada source file.
12101
12102 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
12103 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
12104 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
12105 middle (to allow based literals).
12106
12107 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
12108 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
12109 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
12110 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
12111 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
12112 functions to procedures elsewhere.
12113
12114 @node Omissions from Ada
12115 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
12116 @cindex Ada, omissions from
12117
12118 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
12119
12120 @itemize @bullet
12121 @item
12122 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
12123
12124 @itemize @minus
12125 @item
12126 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
12127 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
12128
12129 @item
12130 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
12131
12132 @item
12133 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
12134
12135 @item
12136 @t{'Tag}.
12137
12138 @item
12139 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
12140 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
12141
12142 @item
12143 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
12144 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
12145
12146 @item
12147 @t{'Address}.
12148 @end itemize
12149
12150 @item
12151 The names in
12152 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
12153 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
12154 not currently available.
12155
12156 @item
12157 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
12158 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
12159 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
12160 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
12161 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
12162 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
12163 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
12164 indeterminate values.
12165
12166 @item
12167 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
12168 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
12169 are not implemented.
12170
12171 @item
12172 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
12173 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
12174 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
12175 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
12176 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
12177
12178 @smallexample
12179 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
12180 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
12181 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
12182 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
12183 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
12184 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
12185 @end smallexample
12186
12187 Changing a
12188 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
12189 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
12190 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
12191 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
12192 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
12193 declared to have a type such as:
12194
12195 @smallexample
12196 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
12197 Id : Integer;
12198 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
12199 end record;
12200 @end smallexample
12201
12202 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
12203 assignments:
12204
12205 @smallexample
12206 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
12207 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
12208 @end smallexample
12209
12210 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
12211 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
12212 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
12213 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
12214 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
12215 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
12216 redundant component associations, although which component values are
12217 assigned in such cases is not defined.
12218
12219 @item
12220 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
12221
12222 @item
12223 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
12224 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
12225 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
12226 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
12227 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
12228 the proper resolution.
12229
12230 @item
12231 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
12232
12233 @item
12234 Entry calls are not implemented.
12235
12236 @item
12237 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
12238 formats are not supported.
12239
12240 @item
12241 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
12242
12243 @item
12244 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
12245 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
12246 context.
12247 Should your program
12248 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
12249 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
12250 @end itemize
12251
12252 @node Additions to Ada
12253 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
12254 @cindex Ada, deviations from
12255
12256 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
12257 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
12258
12259 @itemize @bullet
12260 @item
12261 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
12262 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
12263 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
12264 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
12265 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
12266 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
12267 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
12268 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
12269
12270 @item
12271 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
12272 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
12273 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
12274
12275 @item
12276 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
12277 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
12278
12279 @item
12280 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
12281 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
12282 @end itemize
12283
12284 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
12285 additions specific to Ada:
12286
12287 @itemize @bullet
12288 @item
12289 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
12290 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
12291
12292 @smallexample
12293 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
12294 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
12295 @end smallexample
12296
12297 @item
12298 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
12299 the value of its right-hand operand.
12300 This allows, for example,
12301 complex conditional breaks:
12302
12303 @smallexample
12304 (@value{GDBP}) break f
12305 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
12306 @end smallexample
12307
12308 @item
12309 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
12310 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
12311 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
12312 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
12313 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
12314 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
12315 in strings. For example,
12316 @smallexample
12317 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
12318 @end smallexample
12319 @noindent
12320 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
12321 after each period.
12322
12323 @item
12324 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
12325 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
12326 to write
12327
12328 @smallexample
12329 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
12330 @end smallexample
12331
12332 @item
12333 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
12334 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
12335 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
12336 of 3 might print as
12337
12338 @smallexample
12339 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
12340 @end smallexample
12341
12342 @noindent
12343 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
12344 clause.
12345
12346 @item
12347 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
12348 multi-character subsequence of
12349 their names (an exact match gets preference).
12350 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
12351 in place of @t{a'length}.
12352
12353 @item
12354 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
12355 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
12356 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
12357 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
12358 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
12359 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
12360 For example,
12361 @smallexample
12362 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
12363 @end smallexample
12364
12365 @item
12366 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
12367 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
12368 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
12369 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
12370 object.
12371
12372 @end itemize
12373
12374 @node Stopping Before Main Program
12375 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
12376
12377 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
12378 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
12379 before reaching the main procedure.
12380 As defined in the Ada Reference
12381 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
12382 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
12383 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
12384 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
12385
12386 @node Ada Tasks
12387 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
12388 @cindex Ada, tasking
12389
12390 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
12391 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
12392
12393 @table @code
12394 @kindex info tasks
12395 @item info tasks
12396 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
12397
12398
12399 @smallexample
12400 @iftex
12401 @leftskip=0.5cm
12402 @end iftex
12403 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12404 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12405 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12406 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
12407 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
12408 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
12409
12410 @end smallexample
12411
12412 @noindent
12413 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
12414 task currently being inspected.
12415
12416 @table @asis
12417 @item ID
12418 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
12419
12420 @item TID
12421 The Ada task ID.
12422
12423 @item P-ID
12424 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
12425
12426 @item Pri
12427 The base priority of the task.
12428
12429 @item State
12430 Current state of the task.
12431
12432 @table @code
12433 @item Unactivated
12434 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
12435 executing.
12436
12437 @item Runnable
12438 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
12439 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
12440
12441 @item Terminated
12442 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
12443 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
12444 terminated themselves.
12445
12446 @item Child Activation Wait
12447 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
12448
12449 @item Accept Statement
12450 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
12451
12452 @item Waiting on entry call
12453 The task is waiting on an entry call.
12454
12455 @item Async Select Wait
12456 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
12457 select statement.
12458
12459 @item Delay Sleep
12460 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
12461 alternative open.
12462
12463 @item Child Termination Wait
12464 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
12465 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
12466 waiting on a terminate Phase.
12467
12468 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
12469 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
12470 finish terminating.
12471
12472 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
12473 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
12474 @end table
12475
12476 @item Name
12477 Name of the task in the program.
12478
12479 @end table
12480
12481 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
12482 @item info task @var{taskno}
12483 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
12484 the following example:
12485 @smallexample
12486 @iftex
12487 @leftskip=0.5cm
12488 @end iftex
12489 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12490 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12491 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12492 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
12493 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
12494 Ada Task: 0x807c468
12495 Name: task_1
12496 Thread: 0x807f378
12497 Parent: 1 (main_task)
12498 Base Priority: 15
12499 State: Runnable
12500 @end smallexample
12501
12502 @item task
12503 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
12504 @cindex current Ada task ID
12505 This command prints the ID of the current task.
12506
12507 @smallexample
12508 @iftex
12509 @leftskip=0.5cm
12510 @end iftex
12511 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12512 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12513 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12514 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12515 (@value{GDBP}) task
12516 [Current task is 2]
12517 @end smallexample
12518
12519 @item task @var{taskno}
12520 @cindex Ada task switching
12521 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
12522 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
12523 from the current task to the given task.
12524
12525 @smallexample
12526 @iftex
12527 @leftskip=0.5cm
12528 @end iftex
12529 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12530 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12531 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12532 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12533 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
12534 [Switching to task 1]
12535 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12536 (@value{GDBP}) bt
12537 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12538 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
12539 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
12540 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
12541 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
12542 @end smallexample
12543
12544 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
12545 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
12546 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
12547 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
12548 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
12549 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
12550 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
12551 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
12552 in @ref{Specify Location}.
12553
12554 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
12555 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
12556 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
12557 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
12558 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
12559
12560 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
12561 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
12562 program.
12563
12564 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
12565 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
12566 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
12567
12568 For example,
12569
12570 @smallexample
12571 @iftex
12572 @leftskip=0.5cm
12573 @end iftex
12574 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12575 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12576 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12577 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
12578 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12579 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
12580 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
12581 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
12582 (@value{GDBP}) cont
12583 Continuing.
12584 task # 1 running
12585 task # 2 running
12586
12587 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
12588 15 flush;
12589 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12590 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12591 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12592 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
12593 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12594 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
12595 @end smallexample
12596 @end table
12597
12598 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
12599 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12600 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
12601
12602 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
12603 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
12604 the platform being used.
12605 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
12606 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
12607 as usual.
12608
12609 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
12610 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
12611 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
12612 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
12613 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
12614 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
12615
12616 @node Ada Glitches
12617 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
12618 @cindex Ada, problems
12619
12620 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
12621 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
12622 @value{GDBN},
12623 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
12624 and the GNU Ada compiler.
12625
12626 @itemize @bullet
12627 @item
12628 Currently, the debugger
12629 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
12630 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
12631 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
12632 to get it printed properly.
12633
12634 @item
12635 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
12636 storage are invisible to the debugger.
12637
12638 @item
12639 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
12640 argument lists are treated as positional).
12641
12642 @item
12643 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
12644
12645 @item
12646 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
12647 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
12648 the host machine.
12649
12650 @item
12651 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
12652 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
12653 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
12654 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
12655 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
12656 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
12657 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
12658 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
12659 you can usually resolve the confusion
12660 by qualifying the problematic names with package
12661 @code{Standard} explicitly.
12662 @end itemize
12663
12664 @node Unsupported Languages
12665 @section Unsupported Languages
12666
12667 @cindex unsupported languages
12668 @cindex minimal language
12669 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
12670 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
12671 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
12672 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
12673 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
12674 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
12675
12676 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
12677 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
12678 language.
12679
12680 @node Symbols
12681 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
12682
12683 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
12684 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
12685 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
12686 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
12687 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
12688 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
12689 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12690
12691 @cindex symbol names
12692 @cindex names of symbols
12693 @cindex quoting names
12694 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
12695 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
12696 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
12697 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
12698 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
12699 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
12700 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
12701 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
12702
12703 @smallexample
12704 p 'foo.c'::x
12705 @end smallexample
12706
12707 @noindent
12708 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
12709
12710 @table @code
12711 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
12712 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
12713 @kindex set case-sensitive
12714 @item set case-sensitive on
12715 @itemx set case-sensitive off
12716 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
12717 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
12718 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
12719 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
12720 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
12721 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
12722 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
12723 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
12724 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
12725 case-insensitive matches.
12726
12727 @kindex show case-sensitive
12728 @item show case-sensitive
12729 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
12730 lookups.
12731
12732 @kindex info address
12733 @cindex address of a symbol
12734 @item info address @var{symbol}
12735 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
12736 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
12737 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
12738 is always stored.
12739
12740 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
12741 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
12742 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
12743
12744 @kindex info symbol
12745 @cindex symbol from address
12746 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
12747 @item info symbol @var{addr}
12748 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
12749 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
12750 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
12751
12752 @smallexample
12753 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
12754 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
12755 @end smallexample
12756
12757 @noindent
12758 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
12759 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
12760
12761 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
12762 library containing the symbol is also printed:
12763
12764 @smallexample
12765 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
12766 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
12767 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
12768 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
12769 @end smallexample
12770
12771 @kindex whatis
12772 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
12773 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
12774 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
12775 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
12776 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
12777 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
12778 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
12779 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
12780 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
12781 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
12782 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12783
12784 @kindex ptype
12785 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
12786 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
12787 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
12788 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12789
12790 For example, for this variable declaration:
12791
12792 @smallexample
12793 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
12794 @end smallexample
12795
12796 @noindent
12797 the two commands give this output:
12798
12799 @smallexample
12800 @group
12801 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
12802 type = struct complex
12803 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
12804 type = struct complex @{
12805 double real;
12806 double imag;
12807 @}
12808 @end group
12809 @end smallexample
12810
12811 @noindent
12812 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
12813 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
12814
12815 @cindex incomplete type
12816 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
12817 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
12818 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
12819 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
12820 given these declarations:
12821
12822 @smallexample
12823 struct foo;
12824 struct foo *fooptr;
12825 @end smallexample
12826
12827 @noindent
12828 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
12829
12830 @smallexample
12831 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
12832 $1 = <incomplete type>
12833 @end smallexample
12834
12835 @noindent
12836 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12837 completely specified.
12838
12839 @kindex info types
12840 @item info types @var{regexp}
12841 @itemx info types
12842 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12843 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12844 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12845 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12846 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12847 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12848 name is @code{value}.
12849
12850 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12851 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12852 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12853
12854 @kindex info scope
12855 @cindex local variables
12856 @item info scope @var{location}
12857 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
12858 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
12859 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
12860 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
12861 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
12862
12863 @smallexample
12864 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
12865 Scope for command_line_handler:
12866 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
12867 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
12868 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
12869 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
12870 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
12871 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
12872 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
12873 @end smallexample
12874
12875 @noindent
12876 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
12877 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
12878 collect}.
12879
12880 @kindex info source
12881 @item info source
12882 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
12883 the function containing the current point of execution:
12884 @itemize @bullet
12885 @item
12886 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
12887 @item
12888 the directory it was compiled in,
12889 @item
12890 its length, in lines,
12891 @item
12892 which programming language it is written in,
12893 @item
12894 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
12895 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
12896 @item
12897 whether the debugging information includes information about
12898 preprocessor macros.
12899 @end itemize
12900
12901
12902 @kindex info sources
12903 @item info sources
12904 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
12905 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
12906 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
12907
12908 @kindex info functions
12909 @item info functions
12910 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
12911
12912 @item info functions @var{regexp}
12913 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
12914 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
12915 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
12916 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
12917 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
12918 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12919 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12920
12921 @kindex info variables
12922 @item info variables
12923 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12924 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12925
12926 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12927 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12928 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12929 @var{regexp}.
12930
12931 @kindex info classes
12932 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12933 @item info classes
12934 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12935 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12936 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12937 expression.
12938
12939 @kindex info selectors
12940 @item info selectors
12941 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12942 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12943 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12944 expression.
12945
12946 @ignore
12947 This was never implemented.
12948 @kindex info methods
12949 @item info methods
12950 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12951 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12952 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12953 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12954 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12955 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12956 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12957 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12958 @end ignore
12959
12960 @cindex reloading symbols
12961 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12962 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12963 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12964 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12965 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12966
12967 @table @code
12968 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12969 @item set symbol-reloading on
12970 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12971 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12972
12973 @item set symbol-reloading off
12974 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12975 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12976 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12977 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12978 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12979 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12980 name.
12981
12982 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12983 @item show symbol-reloading
12984 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12985 @end table
12986
12987 @cindex opaque data types
12988 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12989 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12990 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12991 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12992 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12993 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12994 another source file. The default is on.
12995
12996 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12997 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12998
12999 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
13000 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
13001 is printed as follows:
13002 @smallexample
13003 @{<no data fields>@}
13004 @end smallexample
13005
13006 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
13007 @item show opaque-type-resolution
13008 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
13009
13010 @kindex maint print symbols
13011 @cindex symbol dump
13012 @kindex maint print psymbols
13013 @cindex partial symbol dump
13014 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
13015 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
13016 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
13017 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
13018 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
13019 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
13020 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
13021 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
13022 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
13023 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
13024 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
13025 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
13026 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
13027 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
13028 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
13029 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
13030 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
13031
13032 @kindex maint info symtabs
13033 @kindex maint info psymtabs
13034 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
13035 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13036 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13037 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13038 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13039 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13040
13041 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
13042 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
13043 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
13044 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
13045 structure in more detail. For example:
13046
13047 @smallexample
13048 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
13049 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13050 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13051 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13052 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
13053 readin no
13054 fullname (null)
13055 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
13056 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
13057 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
13058 dependencies (none)
13059 @}
13060 @}
13061 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13062 (@value{GDBP})
13063 @end smallexample
13064 @noindent
13065 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
13066 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
13067 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
13068 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
13069 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
13070
13071 @smallexample
13072 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
13073 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
13074 line 1574.
13075 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13076 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13077 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13078 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13079 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
13080 dirname (null)
13081 fullname (null)
13082 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
13083 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
13084 debugformat DWARF 2
13085 @}
13086 @}
13087 (@value{GDBP})
13088 @end smallexample
13089 @end table
13090
13091
13092 @node Altering
13093 @chapter Altering Execution
13094
13095 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
13096 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
13097 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
13098 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
13099 program.
13100
13101 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
13102 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
13103 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
13104
13105 @menu
13106 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
13107 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
13108 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
13109 * Returning:: Returning from a function
13110 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
13111 * Patching:: Patching your program
13112 @end menu
13113
13114 @node Assignment
13115 @section Assignment to Variables
13116
13117 @cindex assignment
13118 @cindex setting variables
13119 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
13120 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
13121
13122 @smallexample
13123 print x=4
13124 @end smallexample
13125
13126 @noindent
13127 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
13128 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
13129 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
13130 information on operators in supported languages.
13131
13132 @kindex set variable
13133 @cindex variables, setting
13134 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
13135 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
13136 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
13137 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
13138 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
13139
13140 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
13141 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
13142 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
13143 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
13144 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
13145 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
13146 command @code{set width}:
13147
13148 @smallexample
13149 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
13150 type = double
13151 (@value{GDBP}) p width
13152 $4 = 13
13153 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
13154 Invalid syntax in expression.
13155 @end smallexample
13156
13157 @noindent
13158 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
13159 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
13160
13161 @smallexample
13162 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
13163 @end smallexample
13164
13165 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
13166 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
13167 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
13168 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
13169 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
13170 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
13171
13172 @smallexample
13173 @group
13174 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
13175 type = double
13176 (@value{GDBP}) p g
13177 $1 = 1
13178 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
13179 (@value{GDBP}) p g
13180 $2 = 1
13181 (@value{GDBP}) r
13182 The program being debugged has been started already.
13183 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
13184 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
13185 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
13186 Invalid bfd target.
13187 (@value{GDBP}) show g
13188 The current BFD target is "=4".
13189 @end group
13190 @end smallexample
13191
13192 @noindent
13193 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
13194 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
13195 @code{g}, use
13196
13197 @smallexample
13198 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
13199 @end smallexample
13200
13201 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
13202 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
13203 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
13204 same length or shorter.
13205 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
13206 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
13207
13208 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
13209 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
13210 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
13211 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
13212 and representation in memory), and
13213
13214 @smallexample
13215 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
13216 @end smallexample
13217
13218 @noindent
13219 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
13220
13221 @node Jumping
13222 @section Continuing at a Different Address
13223
13224 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
13225 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
13226 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
13227
13228 @table @code
13229 @kindex jump
13230 @item jump @var{linespec}
13231 @itemx jump @var{location}
13232 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
13233 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
13234 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
13235 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
13236 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
13237 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
13238
13239 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
13240 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
13241 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
13242 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
13243 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
13244 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
13245 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
13246 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
13247 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
13248 @end table
13249
13250 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
13251 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
13252 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
13253 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
13254 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
13255 example,
13256
13257 @smallexample
13258 set $pc = 0x485
13259 @end smallexample
13260
13261 @noindent
13262 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
13263 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
13264 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
13265
13266 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
13267 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
13268 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
13269 detail.
13270
13271 @c @group
13272 @node Signaling
13273 @section Giving your Program a Signal
13274 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
13275
13276 @table @code
13277 @kindex signal
13278 @item signal @var{signal}
13279 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
13280 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
13281 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
13282 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
13283
13284 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
13285 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
13286 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
13287 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
13288 signal.
13289
13290 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
13291 after executing the command.
13292 @end table
13293 @c @end group
13294
13295 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
13296 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
13297 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
13298 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
13299 passes the signal directly to your program.
13300
13301
13302 @node Returning
13303 @section Returning from a Function
13304
13305 @table @code
13306 @cindex returning from a function
13307 @kindex return
13308 @item return
13309 @itemx return @var{expression}
13310 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
13311 command. If you give an
13312 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
13313 value.
13314 @end table
13315
13316 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
13317 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
13318 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
13319 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
13320
13321 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
13322 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
13323 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
13324 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
13325 of functions.
13326
13327 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
13328 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
13329 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
13330 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
13331 selected stack frame returns naturally.
13332
13333 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
13334 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
13335 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
13336 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
13337 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
13338 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
13339 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
13340 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
13341 assignment into the right register(s).
13342
13343 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
13344 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
13345 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
13346 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
13347 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
13348 into a @code{long long int}:
13349
13350 @smallexample
13351 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
13352 29 return 31;
13353 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13354 Make func return now? (y or n) y
13355 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
13356 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
13357 (@value{GDBP})
13358 @end smallexample
13359
13360 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
13361 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
13362 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
13363 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
13364 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
13365 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
13366 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
13367 an appropriate cast explicitly:
13368
13369 @smallexample
13370 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
13371 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13372 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
13373 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
13374 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
13375 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
13376 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
13377 (@value{GDBP})
13378 @end smallexample
13379
13380 @node Calling
13381 @section Calling Program Functions
13382
13383 @table @code
13384 @cindex calling functions
13385 @cindex inferior functions, calling
13386 @item print @var{expr}
13387 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
13388 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
13389 debugged.
13390
13391 @kindex call
13392 @item call @var{expr}
13393 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
13394 returned values.
13395
13396 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
13397 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
13398 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
13399 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
13400 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
13401 value history.
13402 @end table
13403
13404 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
13405 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
13406 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
13407 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
13408
13409 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
13410 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
13411 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
13412 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
13413 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
13414 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
13415 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
13416 in that case is controlled by the
13417 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
13418
13419 @table @code
13420 @item set unwindonsignal
13421 @kindex set unwindonsignal
13422 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
13423 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
13424 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
13425 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
13426 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
13427 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
13428 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
13429 received.
13430
13431 @item show unwindonsignal
13432 @kindex show unwindonsignal
13433 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13434 @value{GDBN}.
13435
13436 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13437 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13438 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
13439 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
13440 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
13441 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
13442 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
13443 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
13444 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
13445 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
13446
13447 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13448 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13449 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13450 @value{GDBN}.
13451
13452 @end table
13453
13454 @cindex weak alias functions
13455 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
13456 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
13457 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
13458 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
13459 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
13460 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
13461 function instead.
13462
13463 @node Patching
13464 @section Patching Programs
13465
13466 @cindex patching binaries
13467 @cindex writing into executables
13468 @cindex writing into corefiles
13469
13470 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
13471 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
13472 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
13473 patching your program's binary.
13474
13475 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
13476 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
13477 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
13478 repairs.
13479
13480 @table @code
13481 @kindex set write
13482 @item set write on
13483 @itemx set write off
13484 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
13485 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
13486 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
13487
13488 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
13489 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
13490 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
13491
13492 @item show write
13493 @kindex show write
13494 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
13495 as well as reading.
13496 @end table
13497
13498 @node GDB Files
13499 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
13500
13501 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
13502 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
13503 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
13504 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
13505
13506 @menu
13507 * Files:: Commands to specify files
13508 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
13509 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
13510 * Data Files:: GDB data files
13511 @end menu
13512
13513 @node Files
13514 @section Commands to Specify Files
13515
13516 @cindex symbol table
13517 @cindex core dump file
13518
13519 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
13520 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
13521 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
13522 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
13523
13524 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
13525 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
13526 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
13527 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
13528 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
13529 new files are useful.
13530
13531 @table @code
13532 @cindex executable file
13533 @kindex file
13534 @item file @var{filename}
13535 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
13536 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
13537 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
13538 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
13539 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
13540 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
13541 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
13542 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
13543
13544 @cindex unlinked object files
13545 @cindex patching object files
13546 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
13547 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
13548 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
13549 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
13550 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
13551 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
13552 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
13553 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
13554
13555 @item file
13556 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
13557 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
13558
13559 @kindex exec-file
13560 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
13561 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
13562 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
13563 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
13564 discard information on the executable file.
13565
13566 @kindex symbol-file
13567 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
13568 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
13569 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
13570 table and program to run from the same file.
13571
13572 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
13573 program's symbol table.
13574
13575 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
13576 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
13577 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
13578 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
13579 @value{GDBN}.
13580
13581 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
13582 executing it once.
13583
13584 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
13585 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
13586 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
13587 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
13588 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
13589 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
13590 optimized code.
13591
13592 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
13593 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
13594 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
13595 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
13596 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
13597
13598 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
13599 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
13600 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
13601 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
13602 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
13603 Warnings and Messages}.)
13604
13605 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
13606 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
13607 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
13608 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
13609 in stabs format.
13610
13611 @kindex readnow
13612 @cindex reading symbols immediately
13613 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
13614 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13615 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13616 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
13617 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
13618 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
13619 entire symbol table available.
13620
13621 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
13622 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
13623 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
13624 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
13625 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
13626 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
13627 @c files.
13628
13629 @kindex core-file
13630 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
13631 @itemx core
13632 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
13633 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
13634 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
13635 executable file itself for other parts.
13636
13637 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
13638 to be used.
13639
13640 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
13641 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
13642 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
13643 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
13644 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
13645
13646 @kindex add-symbol-file
13647 @cindex dynamic linking
13648 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
13649 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13650 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
13651 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
13652 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
13653 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
13654 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
13655 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
13656 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
13657 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
13658 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
13659 @var{address} as an expression.
13660
13661 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
13662 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
13663 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
13664 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
13665 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
13666
13667 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
13668 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
13669 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
13670 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
13671 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
13672 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
13673 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
13674 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
13675 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
13676
13677 @itemize @bullet
13678 @item
13679 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
13680 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
13681 @item
13682 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
13683 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
13684 @item
13685 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
13686 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13687 @end itemize
13688
13689 @noindent
13690 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
13691 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
13692 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
13693 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
13694 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
13695 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
13696 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
13697 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
13698 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
13699 way.
13700
13701 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
13702
13703 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
13704 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
13705 @cindex load symbols from memory
13706 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
13707 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
13708 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
13709 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
13710 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
13711 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
13712 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
13713 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
13714 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
13715
13716 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
13717 @kindex assf
13718 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
13719 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
13720 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
13721 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
13722 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
13723 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
13724 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
13725 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
13726 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
13727 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
13728
13729 @kindex section
13730 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
13731 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
13732 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
13733 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
13734 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
13735 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
13736 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
13737 their addresses.
13738
13739 @kindex info files
13740 @kindex info target
13741 @item info files
13742 @itemx info target
13743 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
13744 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
13745 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
13746 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
13747 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
13748 current ones.
13749
13750 @kindex maint info sections
13751 @item maint info sections
13752 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
13753 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
13754 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
13755 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
13756 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
13757 may be arbitrarily combined):
13758
13759 @table @code
13760 @item ALLOBJ
13761 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
13762 @item @var{sections}
13763 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
13764 @item @var{section-flags}
13765 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
13766 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
13767 @table @code
13768 @item ALLOC
13769 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
13770 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
13771 @item LOAD
13772 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
13773 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
13774 @item RELOC
13775 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
13776 @item READONLY
13777 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
13778 @item CODE
13779 Section contains executable code only.
13780 @item DATA
13781 Section contains data only (no executable code).
13782 @item ROM
13783 Section will reside in ROM.
13784 @item CONSTRUCTOR
13785 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
13786 @item HAS_CONTENTS
13787 Section is not empty.
13788 @item NEVER_LOAD
13789 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
13790 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
13791 A notification to the linker that the section contains
13792 COFF shared library information.
13793 @item IS_COMMON
13794 Section contains common symbols.
13795 @end table
13796 @end table
13797 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
13798 @cindex read-only sections
13799 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
13800 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
13801 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
13802 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
13803 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
13804 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
13805 enhancement to debugging performance.
13806
13807 The default is off.
13808
13809 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
13810 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
13811 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
13812 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
13813
13814 @item show trust-readonly-sections
13815 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
13816 @end table
13817
13818 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
13819 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
13820 name and remembers it that way.
13821
13822 @cindex shared libraries
13823 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
13824 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
13825 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
13826
13827 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
13828 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
13829
13830 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
13831 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
13832 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
13833 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
13834 debugging a core file).
13835
13836 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
13837 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
13838
13839 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
13840 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
13841 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
13842
13843 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
13844 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
13845 particularly large or there are many of them.
13846
13847 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
13848 commands:
13849
13850 @table @code
13851 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13852 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13853 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13854 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13855 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
13856 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
13857 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
13858 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
13859
13860 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
13861 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
13862 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
13863 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
13864 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
13865 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
13866 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
13867 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
13868 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
13869
13870 @kindex show auto-solib-add
13871 @item show auto-solib-add
13872 Display the current autoloading mode.
13873 @end table
13874
13875 @cindex load shared library
13876 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
13877 command:
13878
13879 @table @code
13880 @kindex info sharedlibrary
13881 @kindex info share
13882 @item info share @var{regex}
13883 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13884 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
13885 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
13886 all shared libraries that are loaded.
13887
13888 @kindex sharedlibrary
13889 @kindex share
13890 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13891 @itemx share @var{regex}
13892 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
13893 Unix regular expression.
13894 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
13895 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
13896 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
13897 loaded.
13898
13899 @item nosharedlibrary
13900 @kindex nosharedlibrary
13901 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
13902 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
13903 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
13904 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
13905 discarded.
13906 @end table
13907
13908 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
13909 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
13910 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
13911
13912 @table @code
13913 @item set stop-on-solib-events
13914 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
13915 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
13916 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
13917 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
13918 shared library.
13919
13920 @item show stop-on-solib-events
13921 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
13922 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
13923 library events happen.
13924 @end table
13925
13926 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
13927 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
13928 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
13929 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
13930 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
13931 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
13932 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
13933 not.
13934
13935 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
13936 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
13937 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
13938 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
13939 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
13940
13941 @table @code
13942 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
13943 @cindex system root, alternate
13944 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
13945 @kindex set sysroot
13946 @item set sysroot @var{path}
13947 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
13948 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
13949 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
13950 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
13951 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
13952 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
13953 under @var{path}.
13954
13955 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
13956 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
13957 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
13958 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
13959 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
13960 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
13961 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
13962 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
13963 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
13964
13965 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
13966 sysroot}.
13967
13968 @cindex default system root
13969 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
13970 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
13971 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
13972 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13973 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
13974 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13975 location.
13976
13977 @kindex show sysroot
13978 @item show sysroot
13979 Display the current shared library prefix.
13980
13981 @kindex set solib-search-path
13982 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13983 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13984 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13985 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13986 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13987 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13988 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13989 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13990 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13991 of shared library symbols.
13992
13993 @kindex show solib-search-path
13994 @item show solib-search-path
13995 Display the current shared library search path.
13996 @end table
13997
13998
13999 @node Separate Debug Files
14000 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
14001 @cindex separate debugging information files
14002 @cindex debugging information in separate files
14003 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
14004 @cindex debugging information directory, global
14005 @cindex global debugging information directory
14006 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
14007 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
14008
14009 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
14010 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
14011 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
14012 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
14013 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
14014 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
14015 install only when they need to debug a problem.
14016
14017 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
14018 file:
14019
14020 @itemize @bullet
14021 @item
14022 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
14023 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
14024 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
14025 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
14026 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
14027 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
14028 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
14029 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
14030
14031 @item
14032 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
14033 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
14034 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
14035 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
14036 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
14037 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
14038 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
14039 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
14040 below.
14041 @end itemize
14042
14043 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
14044 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
14045
14046 @itemize @bullet
14047 @item
14048 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
14049 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
14050 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
14051 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
14052 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
14053
14054 @item
14055 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
14056 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
14057 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
14058 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
14059 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
14060 hex characters, not 10.)
14061 @end itemize
14062
14063 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
14064 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
14065 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
14066 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
14067 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
14068 debug information files, in the indicated order:
14069
14070 @itemize @minus
14071 @item
14072 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
14073 @item
14074 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
14075 @item
14076 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
14077 @item
14078 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
14079 @end itemize
14080
14081 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
14082 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
14083
14084 @table @code
14085
14086 @kindex set debug-file-directory
14087 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
14088 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14089 information files to @var{directory}.
14090
14091 @kindex show debug-file-directory
14092 @item show debug-file-directory
14093 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14094 information files.
14095
14096 @end table
14097
14098 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
14099 @cindex debug link sections
14100 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
14101 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
14102
14103 @itemize
14104 @item
14105 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
14106 a zero byte,
14107 @item
14108 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
14109 boundary within the section, and
14110 @item
14111 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
14112 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
14113 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
14114 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
14115 @end itemize
14116
14117 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
14118 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
14119 described above.
14120
14121 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
14122 @cindex build ID sections
14123 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
14124 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
14125 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
14126 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
14127 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
14128 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
14129 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
14130 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
14131 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
14132
14133 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
14134 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
14135 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
14136 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
14137 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
14138 in an ordinary executable.
14139
14140 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
14141 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
14142 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
14143 following commands:
14144
14145 @smallexample
14146 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
14147 @kbd{strip -g foo}
14148 @end smallexample
14149
14150 @noindent
14151 These commands remove the debugging
14152 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
14153 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
14154 two files:
14155
14156 @itemize @bullet
14157 @item
14158 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
14159 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
14160
14161 @smallexample
14162 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
14163 @end smallexample
14164
14165 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
14166 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
14167 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
14168 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
14169
14170 @item
14171 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
14172 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
14173 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
14174 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
14175 @end itemize
14176
14177 @noindent
14178
14179 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
14180 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
14181 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
14182
14183 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
14184 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
14185 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
14186 @c different ways!
14187 @ifhtml
14188 @display
14189 @html
14190 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
14191 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
14192 @end html
14193 @end display
14194 @end ifhtml
14195 @ifnothtml
14196 @display
14197 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
14198 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
14199 @end display
14200 @end ifnothtml
14201
14202 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
14203 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
14204 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
14205 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
14206 CRC.
14207
14208 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
14209 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
14210 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
14211 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
14212 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
14213 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
14214
14215 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
14216 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
14217 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
14218 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
14219 @code{0xffffffff}.
14220
14221 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
14222 @smallexample
14223 unsigned long
14224 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
14225 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
14226 @{
14227 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
14228 @{
14229 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
14230 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
14231 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
14232 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
14233 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
14234 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
14235 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
14236 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
14237 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
14238 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
14239 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
14240 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
14241 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
14242 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
14243 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
14244 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
14245 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
14246 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
14247 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
14248 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
14249 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
14250 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
14251 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
14252 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
14253 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
14254 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
14255 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
14256 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
14257 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
14258 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
14259 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
14260 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
14261 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
14262 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
14263 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
14264 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
14265 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
14266 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
14267 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
14268 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
14269 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
14270 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
14271 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
14272 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
14273 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
14274 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
14275 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
14276 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
14277 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
14278 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
14279 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
14280 0x2d02ef8d
14281 @};
14282 unsigned char *end;
14283
14284 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14285 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
14286 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
14287 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14288 @}
14289 @end smallexample
14290
14291 @noindent
14292 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
14293
14294
14295 @node Symbol Errors
14296 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
14297
14298 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
14299 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
14300 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
14301 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
14302 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
14303 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
14304 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
14305 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
14306 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
14307 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14308 Messages}).
14309
14310 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
14311
14312 @table @code
14313 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
14314
14315 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
14316 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
14317 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
14318 in its outer scope blocks.
14319
14320 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
14321 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
14322 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
14323 function.
14324
14325 @item block at @var{address} out of order
14326
14327 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
14328 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
14329 do so.
14330
14331 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
14332 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
14333 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
14334 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14335 Messages}.)
14336
14337 @item bad block start address patched
14338
14339 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
14340 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
14341 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
14342
14343 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
14344 starting on the previous source line.
14345
14346 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
14347
14348 @cindex foo
14349 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
14350 larger than the size of the string table.
14351
14352 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
14353 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
14354 with this name.
14355
14356 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
14357
14358 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
14359 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
14360 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
14361
14362 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
14363 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
14364 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
14365 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
14366 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
14367 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
14368
14369 @item stub type has NULL name
14370
14371 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
14372
14373 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
14374 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
14375 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
14376 it.
14377
14378 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
14379
14380 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
14381
14382 @end table
14383
14384 @node Data Files
14385 @section GDB Data Files
14386
14387 @cindex prefix for data files
14388 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
14389 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
14390
14391 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
14392 is currently using.
14393
14394 @table @code
14395 @kindex set data-directory
14396 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
14397 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
14398 to @var{directory}.
14399
14400 @kindex show data-directory
14401 @item show data-directory
14402 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
14403 @end table
14404
14405 @cindex default data directory
14406 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
14407 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
14408 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
14409 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14410 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
14411 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14412 location.
14413
14414 @node Targets
14415 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
14416
14417 @cindex debugging target
14418 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
14419
14420 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
14421 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
14422 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
14423 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
14424 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
14425 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
14426 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
14427 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
14428
14429 @cindex target architecture
14430 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
14431 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
14432 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
14433 command.
14434
14435 @table @code
14436 @kindex set architecture
14437 @kindex show architecture
14438 @item set architecture @var{arch}
14439 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
14440 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
14441 supported architectures.
14442
14443 @item show architecture
14444 Show the current target architecture.
14445
14446 @item set processor
14447 @itemx processor
14448 @kindex set processor
14449 @kindex show processor
14450 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
14451 and @code{show architecture}.
14452 @end table
14453
14454 @menu
14455 * Active Targets:: Active targets
14456 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
14457 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
14458 @end menu
14459
14460 @node Active Targets
14461 @section Active Targets
14462
14463 @cindex stacking targets
14464 @cindex active targets
14465 @cindex multiple targets
14466
14467 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
14468 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
14469 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
14470 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
14471 a core file.
14472
14473 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
14474 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
14475 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
14476 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
14477 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
14478 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
14479 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
14480 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
14481 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
14482
14483 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
14484 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
14485 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
14486 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
14487 process target is active.
14488
14489 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
14490 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
14491 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
14492 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
14493 Process}).
14494
14495 @node Target Commands
14496 @section Commands for Managing Targets
14497
14498 @table @code
14499 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
14500 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
14501 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
14502 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
14503 protocol of the target machine.
14504
14505 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
14506 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
14507 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
14508
14509 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
14510 after executing the command.
14511
14512 @kindex help target
14513 @item help target
14514 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
14515 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
14516 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
14517
14518 @item help target @var{name}
14519 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
14520 select it.
14521
14522 @kindex set gnutarget
14523 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
14524 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
14525 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
14526 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
14527 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
14528 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
14529
14530 @quotation
14531 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
14532 you must know the actual BFD name.
14533 @end quotation
14534
14535 @noindent
14536 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
14537
14538 @kindex show gnutarget
14539 @item show gnutarget
14540 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
14541 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
14542 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
14543 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
14544 @end table
14545
14546 @cindex common targets
14547 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
14548 configuration):
14549
14550 @table @code
14551 @kindex target
14552 @item target exec @var{program}
14553 @cindex executable file target
14554 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
14555 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
14556
14557 @item target core @var{filename}
14558 @cindex core dump file target
14559 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
14560 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
14561
14562 @item target remote @var{medium}
14563 @cindex remote target
14564 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
14565 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
14566 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
14567
14568 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
14569 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
14570
14571 @smallexample
14572 target remote /dev/ttya
14573 @end smallexample
14574
14575 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
14576 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
14577 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
14578 clobbered by the download.
14579
14580 @item target sim
14581 @cindex built-in simulator target
14582 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
14583 In general,
14584 @smallexample
14585 target sim
14586 load
14587 run
14588 @end smallexample
14589 @noindent
14590 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
14591 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
14592 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
14593 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
14594 Processors}.
14595
14596 @end table
14597
14598 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
14599
14600 @table @code
14601
14602 @item target nrom @var{dev}
14603 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
14604 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
14605
14606 @end table
14607
14608 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
14609 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
14610
14611 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
14612 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
14613 various aspects of this process.
14614
14615 @table @code
14616
14617 @item set hash
14618 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14619 @cindex hash mark while downloading
14620 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
14621 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
14622 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
14623 monitor.
14624
14625 @item show hash
14626 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14627 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
14628
14629 @item set debug monitor
14630 @kindex set debug monitor
14631 @cindex display remote monitor communications
14632 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
14633 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14634
14635 @item show debug monitor
14636 @kindex show debug monitor
14637 Show the current status of displaying communications between
14638 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14639 @end table
14640
14641 @table @code
14642
14643 @kindex load @var{filename}
14644 @item load @var{filename}
14645 @anchor{load}
14646 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
14647 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
14648 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
14649 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
14650 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
14651 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14652
14653 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
14654 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
14655 target is @dots{}}''
14656
14657 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
14658 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
14659 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
14660 specifies a fixed address.
14661 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
14662
14663 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
14664 load programs into flash memory.
14665
14666 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
14667 @end table
14668
14669 @node Byte Order
14670 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
14671
14672 @cindex choosing target byte order
14673 @cindex target byte order
14674
14675 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
14676 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
14677 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
14678 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
14679 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
14680 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
14681
14682 @table @code
14683 @kindex set endian
14684 @item set endian big
14685 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
14686
14687 @item set endian little
14688 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
14689
14690 @item set endian auto
14691 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
14692 executable.
14693
14694 @item show endian
14695 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
14696
14697 @end table
14698
14699 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
14700 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
14701 target system.
14702
14703
14704 @node Remote Debugging
14705 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
14706 @cindex remote debugging
14707
14708 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
14709 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
14710 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
14711 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
14712 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
14713
14714 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
14715 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
14716 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
14717 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
14718 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
14719 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
14720
14721 Other remote targets may be available in your
14722 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
14723
14724 @menu
14725 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
14726 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
14727 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
14728 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
14729 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
14730 @end menu
14731
14732 @node Connecting
14733 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
14734
14735 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
14736 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
14737 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
14738 program as the first argument.
14739
14740 @cindex @code{target remote}
14741 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
14742 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
14743 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
14744 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
14745 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
14746 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
14747
14748 @table @code
14749
14750 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
14751 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
14752 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
14753 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
14754
14755 @smallexample
14756 target remote /dev/ttyb
14757 @end smallexample
14758
14759 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
14760 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
14761 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
14762 @code{target} command.
14763
14764 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
14765 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14766 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
14767 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
14768 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
14769 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
14770 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
14771 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
14772 target.
14773
14774 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
14775 @code{manyfarms}:
14776
14777 @smallexample
14778 target remote manyfarms:2828
14779 @end smallexample
14780
14781 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
14782 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
14783 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
14784 port 1234 on your local machine:
14785
14786 @smallexample
14787 target remote :1234
14788 @end smallexample
14789 @noindent
14790
14791 Note that the colon is still required here.
14792
14793 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14794 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
14795 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
14796 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
14797
14798 @smallexample
14799 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
14800 @end smallexample
14801
14802 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
14803 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
14804 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
14805 cause havoc with your debugging session.
14806
14807 @item target remote | @var{command}
14808 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
14809 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
14810 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
14811 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
14812 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
14813 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
14814 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
14815 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
14816
14817 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
14818 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
14819 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
14820
14821 @end table
14822
14823 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
14824 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
14825 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
14826 need to use @kbd{run}.
14827
14828 @cindex interrupting remote programs
14829 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
14830 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
14831 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
14832 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
14833 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
14834 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
14835
14836 @smallexample
14837 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
14838 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
14839 @end smallexample
14840
14841 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
14842 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
14843 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
14844 goes back to waiting.
14845
14846 @table @code
14847 @kindex detach (remote)
14848 @item detach
14849 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
14850 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
14851 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
14852 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
14853 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
14854
14855 @kindex disconnect
14856 @item disconnect
14857 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
14858 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
14859 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
14860 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
14861 another target.
14862
14863 @cindex send command to remote monitor
14864 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
14865 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
14866 @kindex monitor
14867 @item monitor @var{cmd}
14868 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
14869 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
14870 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
14871 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
14872 and implement.
14873 @end table
14874
14875 @node File Transfer
14876 @section Sending files to a remote system
14877 @cindex remote target, file transfer
14878 @cindex file transfer
14879 @cindex sending files to remote systems
14880
14881 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
14882 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
14883 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
14884 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
14885 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
14886 the only way to upload or download files.
14887
14888 Not all remote targets support these commands.
14889
14890 @table @code
14891 @kindex remote put
14892 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
14893 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
14894 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
14895
14896 @kindex remote get
14897 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
14898 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
14899 on the host system.
14900
14901 @kindex remote delete
14902 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
14903 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
14904
14905 @end table
14906
14907 @node Server
14908 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
14909
14910 @kindex gdbserver
14911 @cindex remote connection without stubs
14912 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
14913 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
14914 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
14915
14916 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
14917 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
14918 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
14919 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
14920 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
14921 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
14922 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
14923 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
14924 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
14925 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
14926 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
14927 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
14928 choice for debugging.
14929
14930 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
14931 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
14932 protocol.
14933
14934 @quotation
14935 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
14936 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
14937 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
14938 target system with the same privileges as the user running
14939 @code{gdbserver}.
14940 @end quotation
14941
14942 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
14943 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
14944
14945 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
14946 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
14947 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
14948 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
14949 system does all the symbol handling.
14950
14951 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
14952 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
14953 syntax is:
14954
14955 @smallexample
14956 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
14957 @end smallexample
14958
14959 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
14960 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
14961 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
14962 @file{/dev/com1}:
14963
14964 @smallexample
14965 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
14966 @end smallexample
14967
14968 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
14969 with it.
14970
14971 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
14972
14973 @smallexample
14974 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
14975 @end smallexample
14976
14977 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
14978 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
14979 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
14980 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
14981 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
14982 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
14983 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
14984 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
14985 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
14986 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
14987 @code{target remote} command.
14988
14989 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
14990
14991 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
14992 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
14993
14994 @smallexample
14995 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
14996 @end smallexample
14997
14998 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
14999 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
15000
15001 @pindex pidof
15002 @cindex attach to a program by name
15003 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
15004 @code{pidof} utility:
15005
15006 @smallexample
15007 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
15008 @end smallexample
15009
15010 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
15011 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
15012 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
15013
15014 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
15015 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
15016 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
15017
15018 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
15019 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
15020 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
15021 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
15022
15023 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
15024 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
15025 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
15026 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
15027 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
15028 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
15029 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
15030 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
15031 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
15032
15033 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
15034 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
15035 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
15036 the program you want to debug.
15037
15038 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
15039 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
15040 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
15041
15042 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
15043
15044 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
15045 status information about the debugging process. The
15046 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
15047 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
15048 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
15049
15050 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
15051 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
15052 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
15053 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
15054
15055 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
15056 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
15057 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
15058 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
15059
15060 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
15061 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
15062 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
15063 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
15064
15065 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
15066 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
15067 environment:
15068
15069 @smallexample
15070 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
15071 @end smallexample
15072
15073 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
15074
15075 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
15076
15077 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
15078 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
15079 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
15080 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
15081
15082 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
15083 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
15084 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
15085 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
15086 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
15087 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
15088 programs.
15089
15090 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15091 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
15092 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
15093 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
15094 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
15095 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
15096 already on the target.
15097
15098 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
15099 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
15100 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
15101
15102 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
15103 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
15104 Here are the available commands.
15105
15106 @table @code
15107 @item monitor help
15108 List the available monitor commands.
15109
15110 @item monitor set debug 0
15111 @itemx monitor set debug 1
15112 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
15113
15114 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
15115 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
15116 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
15117 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
15118
15119 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
15120 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
15121 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15122 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
15123 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
15124 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
15125
15126 @item monitor exit
15127 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
15128 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
15129 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
15130 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
15131 of a multi-process mode debug session.
15132
15133 @end table
15134
15135 @node Remote Configuration
15136 @section Remote Configuration
15137
15138 @kindex set remote
15139 @kindex show remote
15140 This section documents the configuration options available when
15141 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
15142 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
15143 system-call-allowed}.
15144
15145 @table @code
15146 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
15147 @cindex address size for remote targets
15148 @cindex bits in remote address
15149 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
15150 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
15151 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
15152 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
15153
15154 @item show remoteaddresssize
15155 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
15156
15157 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
15158 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
15159 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
15160 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
15161 remote targets.
15162
15163 @item show remotebaud
15164 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
15165
15166 @item set remotebreak
15167 @cindex interrupt remote programs
15168 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
15169 @anchor{set remotebreak}
15170 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
15171 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
15172 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
15173 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
15174 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
15175
15176 @item show remotebreak
15177 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
15178 interrupt the remote program.
15179
15180 @item set remoteflow on
15181 @itemx set remoteflow off
15182 @kindex set remoteflow
15183 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
15184 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
15185
15186 @item show remoteflow
15187 @kindex show remoteflow
15188 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
15189
15190 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
15191 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
15192 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
15193 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
15194 @code{ascii}.
15195
15196 @item show remotelogbase
15197 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
15198 protocol.
15199
15200 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
15201 @cindex record serial communications on file
15202 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
15203 default is not to record at all.
15204
15205 @item show remotelogfile.
15206 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
15207 serial communications.
15208
15209 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
15210 @cindex timeout for serial communications
15211 @cindex remote timeout
15212 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
15213 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
15214
15215 @item show remotetimeout
15216 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
15217 responses.
15218
15219 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
15220 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
15221 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
15222 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
15223 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
15224 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
15225 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
15226 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
15227
15228 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
15229 @itemx show remote exec-file
15230 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
15231 @cindex executable file, for remote target
15232 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
15233 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
15234 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
15235 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
15236
15237 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
15238 @cindex interrupt remote programs
15239 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
15240 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
15241 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
15242 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
15243 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
15244 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
15245 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
15246 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
15247
15248 @item show interrupt-sequence
15249 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
15250 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
15251 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
15252 also known as Magic SysRq g.
15253
15254 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
15255 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
15256 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
15257 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
15258 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
15259 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
15260
15261 @item show interrupt-on-connect
15262 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
15263 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
15264
15265 @kindex set tcp
15266 @kindex show tcp
15267 @item set tcp auto-retry on
15268 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
15269 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
15270 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
15271 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
15272 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
15273 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
15274 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
15275 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
15276
15277 @item set tcp auto-retry off
15278 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
15279
15280 @item show tcp auto-retry
15281 Show the current auto-retry setting.
15282
15283 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
15284 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
15285 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
15286 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
15287 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
15288 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
15289 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
15290 value.
15291
15292 @item show tcp connect-timeout
15293 Show the current connection timeout setting.
15294 @end table
15295
15296 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
15297 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
15298 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
15299 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
15300 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
15301 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
15302 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
15303 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
15304 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
15305
15306 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
15307 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
15308 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
15309 @value{GDBN} developers.
15310
15311 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
15312 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
15313 are:
15314
15315 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
15316 @item Command Name
15317 @tab Remote Packet
15318 @tab Related Features
15319
15320 @item @code{fetch-register}
15321 @tab @code{p}
15322 @tab @code{info registers}
15323
15324 @item @code{set-register}
15325 @tab @code{P}
15326 @tab @code{set}
15327
15328 @item @code{binary-download}
15329 @tab @code{X}
15330 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
15331
15332 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
15333 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
15334 @tab @code{info auxv}
15335
15336 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
15337 @tab @code{qSymbol}
15338 @tab Detecting multiple threads
15339
15340 @item @code{attach}
15341 @tab @code{vAttach}
15342 @tab @code{attach}
15343
15344 @item @code{verbose-resume}
15345 @tab @code{vCont}
15346 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
15347
15348 @item @code{run}
15349 @tab @code{vRun}
15350 @tab @code{run}
15351
15352 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
15353 @tab @code{Z0}
15354 @tab @code{break}
15355
15356 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
15357 @tab @code{Z1}
15358 @tab @code{hbreak}
15359
15360 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
15361 @tab @code{Z2}
15362 @tab @code{watch}
15363
15364 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
15365 @tab @code{Z3}
15366 @tab @code{rwatch}
15367
15368 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
15369 @tab @code{Z4}
15370 @tab @code{awatch}
15371
15372 @item @code{target-features}
15373 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
15374 @tab @code{set architecture}
15375
15376 @item @code{library-info}
15377 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
15378 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
15379
15380 @item @code{memory-map}
15381 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
15382 @tab @code{info mem}
15383
15384 @item @code{read-spu-object}
15385 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
15386 @tab @code{info spu}
15387
15388 @item @code{write-spu-object}
15389 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
15390 @tab @code{info spu}
15391
15392 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
15393 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
15394 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
15395
15396 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
15397 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
15398 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
15399
15400 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
15401 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
15402 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
15403
15404 @item @code{search-memory}
15405 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
15406 @tab @code{find}
15407
15408 @item @code{supported-packets}
15409 @tab @code{qSupported}
15410 @tab Remote communications parameters
15411
15412 @item @code{pass-signals}
15413 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
15414 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
15415
15416 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
15417 @tab @code{vFile:close}
15418 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15419
15420 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
15421 @tab @code{vFile:open}
15422 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15423
15424 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
15425 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
15426 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15427
15428 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
15429 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
15430 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15431
15432 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
15433 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
15434 @tab @code{remote delete}
15435
15436 @item @code{noack-packet}
15437 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
15438 @tab Packet acknowledgment
15439
15440 @item @code{osdata}
15441 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
15442 @tab @code{info os}
15443
15444 @item @code{query-attached}
15445 @tab @code{qAttached}
15446 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
15447 @end multitable
15448
15449 @node Remote Stub
15450 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
15451
15452 @cindex debugging stub, example
15453 @cindex remote stub, example
15454 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
15455 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
15456 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
15457 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
15458 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
15459 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
15460 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
15461 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
15462
15463 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
15464 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
15465 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
15466 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
15467 program, you need:
15468
15469 @enumerate
15470 @item
15471 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
15472 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
15473 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
15474
15475 @item
15476 A C subroutine library to support your program's
15477 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
15478
15479 @item
15480 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
15481 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
15482 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
15483 documentation.
15484 @end enumerate
15485
15486 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
15487 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
15488 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
15489
15490 @table @emph
15491 @item On the host,
15492 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
15493 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
15494 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
15495
15496 @item On the target,
15497 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
15498 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
15499 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
15500
15501 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
15502 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
15503 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
15504 @end table
15505
15506 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
15507 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
15508 @sc{sparc} boards.
15509
15510 @cindex remote serial stub list
15511 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
15512
15513 @table @code
15514
15515 @item i386-stub.c
15516 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
15517 @cindex Intel
15518 @cindex i386
15519 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
15520
15521 @item m68k-stub.c
15522 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
15523 @cindex Motorola 680x0
15524 @cindex m680x0
15525 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
15526
15527 @item sh-stub.c
15528 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
15529 @cindex Renesas
15530 @cindex SH
15531 For Renesas SH architectures.
15532
15533 @item sparc-stub.c
15534 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
15535 @cindex Sparc
15536 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
15537
15538 @item sparcl-stub.c
15539 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
15540 @cindex Fujitsu
15541 @cindex SparcLite
15542 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
15543
15544 @end table
15545
15546 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
15547 recently added stubs.
15548
15549 @menu
15550 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
15551 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
15552 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
15553 @end menu
15554
15555 @node Stub Contents
15556 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
15557
15558 @cindex remote serial stub
15559 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
15560 subroutines:
15561
15562 @table @code
15563 @item set_debug_traps
15564 @findex set_debug_traps
15565 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
15566 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
15567 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
15568 beginning of your program.
15569
15570 @item handle_exception
15571 @findex handle_exception
15572 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
15573 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
15574 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
15575 run when a trap is triggered.
15576
15577 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
15578 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
15579 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
15580 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
15581 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
15582 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
15583 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
15584 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
15585 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
15586 machine.
15587
15588 @item breakpoint
15589 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
15590 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
15591 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
15592 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
15593 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
15594 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
15595 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
15596 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
15597 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
15598 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
15599 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
15600
15601 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
15602 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
15603 start of your debugging session.
15604 @end table
15605
15606 @node Bootstrapping
15607 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
15608
15609 @cindex remote stub, support routines
15610 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
15611 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
15612 debugging target machine.
15613
15614 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
15615 serial port.
15616
15617 @table @code
15618 @item int getDebugChar()
15619 @findex getDebugChar
15620 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
15621 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
15622 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
15623
15624 @item void putDebugChar(int)
15625 @findex putDebugChar
15626 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
15627 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
15628 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
15629 @end table
15630
15631 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
15632 @cindex interrupting remote targets
15633 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
15634 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
15635 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
15636 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
15637 remote system to stop.
15638
15639 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
15640 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
15641 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
15642 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
15643
15644 Other routines you need to supply are:
15645
15646 @table @code
15647 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
15648 @findex exceptionHandler
15649 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
15650 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
15651 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
15652 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
15653 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
15654 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
15655 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
15656 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
15657 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
15658 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
15659 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
15660 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
15661 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
15662
15663 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
15664 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
15665 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
15666 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
15667 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
15668
15669 @item void flush_i_cache()
15670 @findex flush_i_cache
15671 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
15672 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
15673 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
15674
15675 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
15676 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
15677 @end table
15678
15679 @noindent
15680 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
15681
15682 @table @code
15683 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
15684 @findex memset
15685 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
15686 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
15687 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
15688 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
15689 @end table
15690
15691 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
15692 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
15693 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
15694 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
15695
15696
15697 @node Debug Session
15698 @subsection Putting it All Together
15699
15700 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
15701 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
15702 steps.
15703
15704 @enumerate
15705 @item
15706 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
15707 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
15708 @display
15709 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
15710 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
15711 @end display
15712
15713 @item
15714 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
15715
15716 @smallexample
15717 set_debug_traps();
15718 breakpoint();
15719 @end smallexample
15720
15721 @item
15722 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
15723 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
15724
15725 @smallexample
15726 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
15727 @end smallexample
15728
15729 @noindent
15730 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
15731 function in your program, that function is called when
15732 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
15733 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
15734 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
15735
15736 @item
15737 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
15738 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
15739
15740 @item
15741 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
15742 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
15743
15744 @item
15745 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
15746 @c document that. FIXME.
15747 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
15748 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
15749
15750 @item
15751 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
15752 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15753
15754 @end enumerate
15755
15756 @node Configurations
15757 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
15758
15759 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
15760 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
15761 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
15762
15763 There are three major categories of configurations: native
15764 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
15765 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
15766 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
15767 are quite different from each other.
15768
15769 @menu
15770 * Native::
15771 * Embedded OS::
15772 * Embedded Processors::
15773 * Architectures::
15774 @end menu
15775
15776 @node Native
15777 @section Native
15778
15779 This section describes details specific to particular native
15780 configurations.
15781
15782 @menu
15783 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
15784 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
15785 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
15786 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
15787 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
15788 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
15789 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
15790 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
15791 @end menu
15792
15793 @node HP-UX
15794 @subsection HP-UX
15795
15796 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
15797 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
15798 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
15799
15800
15801 @node BSD libkvm Interface
15802 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
15803
15804 @cindex libkvm
15805 @cindex kernel memory image
15806 @cindex kernel crash dump
15807
15808 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
15809 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
15810 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
15811 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
15812 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
15813 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
15814 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
15815 @code{kvm} target:
15816
15817 @smallexample
15818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
15819 @end smallexample
15820
15821 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
15822 argument:
15823
15824 @smallexample
15825 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
15826 @end smallexample
15827
15828 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
15829 available:
15830
15831 @table @code
15832 @kindex kvm
15833 @item kvm pcb
15834 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
15835
15836 @item kvm proc
15837 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
15838 modern FreeBSD systems.
15839 @end table
15840
15841 @node SVR4 Process Information
15842 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
15843 @cindex /proc
15844 @cindex examine process image
15845 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
15846
15847 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
15848 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
15849 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
15850 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
15851 proc} is available to report information about the process running
15852 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
15853 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
15854 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
15855 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
15856
15857 @table @code
15858 @kindex info proc
15859 @cindex process ID
15860 @item info proc
15861 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
15862 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
15863 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
15864 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
15865 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
15866 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
15867 executable file's absolute file name.
15868
15869 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
15870 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
15871 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
15872 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
15873 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
15874 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
15875
15876 @item info proc mappings
15877 @cindex memory address space mappings
15878 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
15879 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
15880 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
15881 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
15882 memory access rights to that range.
15883
15884 @item info proc stat
15885 @itemx info proc status
15886 @cindex process detailed status information
15887 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
15888 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
15889 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
15890 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
15891 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
15892 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
15893 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
15894
15895 @item info proc all
15896 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
15897 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
15898
15899 @ignore
15900 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
15901 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
15902 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
15903 @kindex info proc times
15904 @item info proc times
15905 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
15906 its children.
15907
15908 @kindex info proc id
15909 @item info proc id
15910 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
15911 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
15912 @end ignore
15913
15914 @item set procfs-trace
15915 @kindex set procfs-trace
15916 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
15917 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
15918
15919 @item show procfs-trace
15920 @kindex show procfs-trace
15921 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
15922
15923 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
15924 @kindex set procfs-file
15925 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
15926 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
15927 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
15928 standard output.
15929
15930 @item show procfs-file
15931 @kindex show procfs-file
15932 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
15933
15934 @item proc-trace-entry
15935 @itemx proc-trace-exit
15936 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
15937 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
15938 @kindex proc-trace-entry
15939 @kindex proc-trace-exit
15940 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
15941 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
15942 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
15943 from the @code{syscall} interface.
15944
15945 @item info pidlist
15946 @kindex info pidlist
15947 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
15948 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
15949 processes and all the threads within each process.
15950
15951 @item info meminfo
15952 @kindex info meminfo
15953 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
15954 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
15955 @end table
15956
15957 @node DJGPP Native
15958 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
15959 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
15960 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
15961 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
15962
15963 @cindex DPMI
15964 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
15965 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
15966 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
15967 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
15968
15969 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
15970 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
15971 subsection describes those commands.
15972
15973 @table @code
15974 @kindex info dos
15975 @item info dos
15976 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
15977 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15978
15979 @kindex sysinfo
15980 @cindex MS-DOS system info
15981 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
15982 @item info dos sysinfo
15983 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
15984 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
15985 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
15986
15987 @cindex GDT
15988 @cindex LDT
15989 @cindex IDT
15990 @cindex segment descriptor tables
15991 @cindex descriptor tables display
15992 @item info dos gdt
15993 @itemx info dos ldt
15994 @itemx info dos idt
15995 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
15996 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
15997 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
15998 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
15999 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
16000 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
16001 rights.
16002
16003 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
16004 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
16005 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
16006 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
16007 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
16008
16009 @cindex garbled pointers
16010 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
16011 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
16012 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
16013 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
16014 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
16015 debugged program's data segment:
16016
16017 @smallexample
16018 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
16019 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
16020 @end smallexample
16021
16022 @noindent
16023 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
16024 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
16025
16026 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
16027 @item info dos pde
16028 @itemx info dos pte
16029 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
16030 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
16031 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
16032 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
16033 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
16034 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
16035 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
16036 that is currently in use.
16037
16038 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
16039 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
16040 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
16041 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
16042 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
16043 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
16044 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
16045
16046 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
16047 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
16048 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
16049 controller.
16050
16051 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
16052
16053 @cindex physical address from linear address
16054 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
16055 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
16056 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
16057 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
16058 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
16059 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
16060 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
16061
16062 @smallexample
16063 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
16064 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
16065 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
16066 @end smallexample
16067
16068 @noindent
16069 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
16070 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
16071 attributes of that page.
16072
16073 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
16074 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
16075 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
16076 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
16077 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
16078 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
16079
16080 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
16081 transfer buffer:
16082
16083 @smallexample
16084 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
16085 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
16086 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
16087 @end smallexample
16088
16089 @noindent
16090 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
16091 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
16092 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
16093 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
16094 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
16095
16096 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
16097 @end table
16098
16099 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
16100 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
16101 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
16102 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
16103
16104 @table @code
16105 @kindex set com1base
16106 @kindex set com1irq
16107 @kindex set com2base
16108 @kindex set com2irq
16109 @kindex set com3base
16110 @kindex set com3irq
16111 @kindex set com4base
16112 @kindex set com4irq
16113 @item set com1base @var{addr}
16114 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
16115 port.
16116
16117 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
16118 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
16119 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
16120
16121 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
16122 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
16123 other 3 COM ports.
16124
16125 @kindex show com1base
16126 @kindex show com1irq
16127 @kindex show com2base
16128 @kindex show com2irq
16129 @kindex show com3base
16130 @kindex show com3irq
16131 @kindex show com4base
16132 @kindex show com4irq
16133 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
16134 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
16135 lines used by the COM ports.
16136
16137 @item info serial
16138 @kindex info serial
16139 @cindex DOS serial port status
16140 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
16141 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
16142 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
16143 counts of various errors encountered so far.
16144 @end table
16145
16146
16147 @node Cygwin Native
16148 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
16149 @cindex MS Windows debugging
16150 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
16151 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
16152
16153 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
16154 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
16155
16156 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
16157 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
16158 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
16159 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
16160 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
16161 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
16162 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
16163 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
16164
16165 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
16166 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
16167 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
16168
16169 @table @code
16170 @kindex info w32
16171 @item info w32
16172 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
16173 information about the target system and important OS structures.
16174
16175 @item info w32 selector
16176 This command displays information returned by
16177 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
16178 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
16179 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
16180 Without argument, this command displays information
16181 about the six segment registers.
16182
16183 @kindex info dll
16184 @item info dll
16185 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
16186
16187 @kindex dll-symbols
16188 @item dll-symbols
16189 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
16190 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
16191
16192 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
16193 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
16194 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
16195 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
16196 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
16197 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
16198 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
16199 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
16200 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
16201 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
16202 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
16203
16204 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
16205 @item show cygwin-exceptions
16206 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
16207 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
16208
16209 @kindex set new-console
16210 @item set new-console @var{mode}
16211 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
16212 be started in a new console on next start.
16213 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
16214 be started in the same console as the debugger.
16215
16216 @kindex show new-console
16217 @item show new-console
16218 Displays whether a new console is used
16219 when the debuggee is started.
16220
16221 @kindex set new-group
16222 @item set new-group @var{mode}
16223 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
16224 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
16225 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
16226 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
16227
16228 @kindex show new-group
16229 @item show new-group
16230 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
16231
16232 @kindex set debugevents
16233 @item set debugevents
16234 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
16235 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
16236 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
16237 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
16238 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
16239
16240 @kindex set debugexec
16241 @item set debugexec
16242 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
16243 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
16244
16245 @kindex set debugexceptions
16246 @item set debugexceptions
16247 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
16248 debuggee seen by the debugger.
16249
16250 @kindex set debugmemory
16251 @item set debugmemory
16252 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
16253 and writes by the debugger.
16254
16255 @kindex set shell
16256 @item set shell
16257 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
16258 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
16259
16260 @kindex show shell
16261 @item show shell
16262 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
16263
16264 @end table
16265
16266 @menu
16267 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
16268 @end menu
16269
16270 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
16271 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
16272 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
16273 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
16274
16275 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
16276 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
16277 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
16278 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
16279 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
16280 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
16281 ``minimal symbols''.
16282
16283 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
16284 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
16285 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
16286 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
16287 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
16288 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
16289 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
16290 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
16291 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
16292 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
16293
16294 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
16295
16296 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
16297 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
16298 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
16299 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
16300 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
16301 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
16302 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
16303 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
16304 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
16305
16306 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
16307 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
16308 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
16309 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
16310 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
16311 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
16312
16313 @smallexample
16314 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
16315 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
16316
16317 Non-debugging symbols:
16318 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
16319 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
16320 @end smallexample
16321
16322 @smallexample
16323 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
16324 All functions matching regular expression "!":
16325
16326 Non-debugging symbols:
16327 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
16328 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
16329 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
16330 [etc...]
16331 @end smallexample
16332
16333 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
16334
16335 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
16336 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
16337 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
16338 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
16339 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
16340 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
16341 a function within a DLL without a running program.
16342
16343 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
16344 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
16345 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
16346 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
16347 problem:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
16351 $1 = 268572168
16352 @end smallexample
16353
16354 @smallexample
16355 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
16356 0x10021610: "\230y\""
16357 @end smallexample
16358
16359 And two possible solutions:
16360
16361 @smallexample
16362 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
16363 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
16364 @end smallexample
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
16368 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
16369 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
16370 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
16371 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
16372 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
16373 @end smallexample
16374
16375 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
16376 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
16377 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
16378 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
16379 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
16380
16381 @smallexample
16382 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
16383 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
16384 @end smallexample
16385
16386 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
16387 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
16388 safe.
16389
16390 @node Hurd Native
16391 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
16392 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
16393
16394 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
16395 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
16396
16397 @table @code
16398 @item set signals
16399 @itemx set sigs
16400 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
16401 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
16402 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
16403 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
16404 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
16405 @code{signals}.
16406
16407 @item show signals
16408 @itemx show sigs
16409 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
16410 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
16411 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
16412
16413 @item set signal-thread
16414 @itemx set sigthread
16415 @kindex set signal-thread
16416 @kindex set sigthread
16417 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
16418 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
16419 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
16420 signal-thread}.
16421
16422 @item show signal-thread
16423 @itemx show sigthread
16424 @kindex show signal-thread
16425 @kindex show sigthread
16426 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
16427 delivered a signal.
16428
16429 @item set stopped
16430 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
16431 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
16432 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
16433 continued by delivering a signal to it.
16434
16435 @item show stopped
16436 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
16437 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
16438 stopped.
16439
16440 @item set exceptions
16441 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
16442 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
16443 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
16444 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
16445 trapping on.
16446
16447 @item show exceptions
16448 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
16449 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
16450
16451 @item set task pause
16452 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
16453 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16454 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16455 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
16456 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
16457 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
16458 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
16459 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
16460 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
16461
16462 @item show task pause
16463 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
16464 Show the current state of task suspension.
16465
16466 @item set task detach-suspend-count
16467 @cindex task suspend count
16468 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16469 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
16470 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
16471
16472 @item show task detach-suspend-count
16473 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
16474
16475 @item set task exception-port
16476 @itemx set task excp
16477 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16478 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
16479 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
16480 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
16481
16482 @item set noninvasive
16483 @cindex noninvasive task options
16484 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
16485 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
16486 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
16487 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
16488
16489 @item info send-rights
16490 @itemx info receive-rights
16491 @itemx info port-rights
16492 @itemx info port-sets
16493 @itemx info dead-names
16494 @itemx info ports
16495 @itemx info psets
16496 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16497 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16498 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16499 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16500 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16501 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
16502 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
16503 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
16504 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
16505
16506 @item set thread pause
16507 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
16508 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16509 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16510 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
16511 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
16512 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
16513 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
16514 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
16515 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
16516 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
16517 only the current thread.
16518
16519 @item show thread pause
16520 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
16521 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
16522
16523 @item set thread run
16524 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
16525
16526 @item show thread run
16527 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
16528
16529 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
16530 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16531 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16532 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
16533 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
16534 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
16535 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
16536
16537 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
16538 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
16539 detaching.
16540
16541 @item set thread exception-port
16542 @itemx set thread excp
16543 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
16544 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
16545 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
16546
16547 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
16548 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
16549 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
16550 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
16551
16552 @item set thread default
16553 @itemx show thread default
16554 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16555 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
16556 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
16557 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
16558 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
16559 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
16560 the non-default commands.
16561 @end table
16562
16563
16564 @node Neutrino
16565 @subsection QNX Neutrino
16566 @cindex QNX Neutrino
16567
16568 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
16569 Neutrino target:
16570
16571 @table @code
16572 @item set debug nto-debug
16573 @kindex set debug nto-debug
16574 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
16575 Neutrino support.
16576
16577 @item show debug nto-debug
16578 @kindex show debug nto-debug
16579 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
16580 @end table
16581
16582 @node Darwin
16583 @subsection Darwin
16584 @cindex Darwin
16585
16586 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
16587
16588 @table @code
16589 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
16590 @kindex set debug darwin
16591 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
16592 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
16593
16594 @item show debug darwin
16595 @kindex show debug darwin
16596 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
16597
16598 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
16599 @kindex set debug mach-o
16600 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
16601 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
16602 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
16603 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
16604 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
16605 usage.
16606
16607 @item show debug mach-o
16608 @kindex show debug mach-o
16609 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
16610
16611 @item set mach-exceptions on
16612 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
16613 @kindex set mach-exceptions
16614 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
16615 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
16616 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
16617 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
16618
16619 @item show mach-exceptions
16620 @kindex show mach-exceptions
16621 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
16622 @end table
16623
16624
16625 @node Embedded OS
16626 @section Embedded Operating Systems
16627
16628 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
16629 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
16630 architectures.
16631
16632 @menu
16633 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
16634 @end menu
16635
16636 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
16637 various real-time operating systems.
16638
16639 @node VxWorks
16640 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
16641
16642 @cindex VxWorks
16643
16644 @table @code
16645
16646 @kindex target vxworks
16647 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
16648 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
16649 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
16650
16651 @end table
16652
16653 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
16654 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
16655
16656 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
16657 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
16658 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16659 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
16660 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
16661 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
16662 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
16663
16664 @table @code
16665 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
16666 @kindex vxworks-timeout
16667 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
16668 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16669 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
16670 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
16671 of a thin network line.
16672 @end table
16673
16674 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
16675 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
16676 procedures.
16677
16678 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
16679 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
16680 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
16681 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
16682 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
16683 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
16684 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
16685 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
16686 manual.
16687 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
16688
16689 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
16690 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16691 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
16692 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
16693
16694 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16695
16696 @smallexample
16697 (vxgdb)
16698 @end smallexample
16699
16700 @menu
16701 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
16702 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
16703 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
16704 @end menu
16705
16706 @node VxWorks Connection
16707 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
16708
16709 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
16710 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
16711
16712 @smallexample
16713 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
16714 @end smallexample
16715
16716 @need 750
16717 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16718
16719 @smallexample
16720 Attaching remote machine across net...
16721 Connected to tt.
16722 @end smallexample
16723
16724 @need 1000
16725 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
16726 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
16727 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
16728 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
16729 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
16730
16731 @smallexample
16732 prog.o: No such file or directory.
16733 @end smallexample
16734
16735 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
16736 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
16737 command again.
16738
16739 @node VxWorks Download
16740 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
16741
16742 @cindex download to VxWorks
16743 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
16744 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
16745 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
16746 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
16747 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
16748 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
16749 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
16750 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
16751 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
16752 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
16753 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
16754 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
16755 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
16756 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
16757 program, type this on VxWorks:
16758
16759 @smallexample
16760 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
16761 @end smallexample
16762
16763 @noindent
16764 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16765
16766 @smallexample
16767 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
16768 (vxgdb) load prog.o
16769 @end smallexample
16770
16771 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
16772
16773 @smallexample
16774 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
16775 @end smallexample
16776
16777 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
16778 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
16779 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
16780 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
16781 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
16782 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
16783 table.)
16784
16785 @node VxWorks Attach
16786 @subsubsection Running Tasks
16787
16788 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
16789 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
16790 follows:
16791
16792 @smallexample
16793 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
16794 @end smallexample
16795
16796 @noindent
16797 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
16798 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
16799 the time of attachment.
16800
16801 @node Embedded Processors
16802 @section Embedded Processors
16803
16804 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
16805 configurations.
16806
16807 @cindex send command to simulator
16808 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
16809 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
16810
16811 @table @code
16812 @item sim @var{command}
16813 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
16814 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
16815 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
16816 acceptable commands.
16817 @end table
16818
16819
16820 @menu
16821 * ARM:: ARM RDI
16822 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
16823 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
16824 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
16825 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
16826 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
16827 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
16828 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
16829 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
16830 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
16831 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
16832 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
16833 * CRIS:: CRIS
16834 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
16835 @end menu
16836
16837 @node ARM
16838 @subsection ARM
16839 @cindex ARM RDI
16840
16841 @table @code
16842 @kindex target rdi
16843 @item target rdi @var{dev}
16844 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
16845 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
16846 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
16847
16848 @kindex target rdp
16849 @item target rdp @var{dev}
16850 ARM Demon monitor.
16851
16852 @end table
16853
16854 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
16855
16856 @table @code
16857 @item set arm disassembler
16858 @kindex set arm
16859 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
16860 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
16861
16862 @item show arm disassembler
16863 @kindex show arm
16864 Show the current disassembly style.
16865
16866 @item set arm apcs32
16867 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
16868 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
16869
16870 @item show arm apcs32
16871 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
16872
16873 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
16874 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
16875 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
16876
16877 @table @code
16878 @item auto
16879 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
16880 @item softfpa
16881 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
16882 processors.
16883 @item fpa
16884 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
16885 @item softvfp
16886 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
16887 @item vfp
16888 VFP co-processor.
16889 @end table
16890
16891 @item show arm fpu
16892 Show the current type of the FPU.
16893
16894 @item set arm abi
16895 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
16896
16897 @item show arm abi
16898 Show the currently used ABI.
16899
16900 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16901 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
16902 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
16903 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
16904 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
16905 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
16906 register).
16907
16908 @item show arm fallback-mode
16909 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
16910
16911 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16912 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
16913 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
16914 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
16915 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
16916
16917 @item show arm force-mode
16918 Show the current forced instruction mode.
16919
16920 @item set debug arm
16921 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
16922 target support subsystem.
16923
16924 @item show debug arm
16925 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
16926 @end table
16927
16928 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
16929 using the RDI interface:
16930
16931 @table @code
16932 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16933 @kindex rdilogfile
16934 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
16935 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
16936 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
16937 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
16938 @file{rdi.log}.
16939
16940 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
16941 @kindex rdilogenable
16942 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
16943 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
16944 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
16945 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
16946 are logged to a file.
16947
16948 @item set rdiromatzero
16949 @kindex set rdiromatzero
16950 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
16951 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
16952 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
16953 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
16954 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
16955
16956 @item show rdiromatzero
16957 @kindex show rdiromatzero
16958 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
16959
16960 @item set rdiheartbeat
16961 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
16962 @cindex RDI heartbeat
16963 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
16964 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
16965 well as the Angel monitor.
16966
16967 @item show rdiheartbeat
16968 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
16969 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
16970 @end table
16971
16972
16973 @node M32R/D
16974 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
16975
16976 @table @code
16977 @kindex target m32r
16978 @item target m32r @var{dev}
16979 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
16980
16981 @kindex target m32rsdi
16982 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
16983 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
16984 @end table
16985
16986 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
16987
16988 @table @code
16989 @item set download-path @var{path}
16990 @kindex set download-path
16991 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
16992 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16993
16994 @item show download-path
16995 @kindex show download-path
16996 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16997
16998 @item set board-address @var{addr}
16999 @kindex set board-address
17000 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
17001 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
17002
17003 @item show board-address
17004 @kindex show board-address
17005 Show the current IP address of the target board.
17006
17007 @item set server-address @var{addr}
17008 @kindex set server-address
17009 @cindex download server address (M32R)
17010 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
17011 host machine.
17012
17013 @item show server-address
17014 @kindex show server-address
17015 Display the IP address of the download server.
17016
17017 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17018 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
17019 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
17020 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
17021 executable file is uploaded.
17022
17023 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17024 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
17025 Test the @code{upload} command.
17026 @end table
17027
17028 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
17029
17030 @table @code
17031 @item sdireset
17032 @kindex sdireset
17033 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
17034 This command resets the SDI connection.
17035
17036 @item sdistatus
17037 @kindex sdistatus
17038 This command shows the SDI connection status.
17039
17040 @item debug_chaos
17041 @kindex debug_chaos
17042 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
17043 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
17044
17045 @item use_debug_dma
17046 @kindex use_debug_dma
17047 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
17048
17049 @item use_mon_code
17050 @kindex use_mon_code
17051 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
17052
17053 @item use_ib_break
17054 @kindex use_ib_break
17055 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
17056
17057 @item use_dbt_break
17058 @kindex use_dbt_break
17059 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
17060 @end table
17061
17062 @node M68K
17063 @subsection M68k
17064
17065 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
17066 target command for the following ROM monitor.
17067
17068 @table @code
17069
17070 @kindex target dbug
17071 @item target dbug @var{dev}
17072 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
17073
17074 @end table
17075
17076 @node MicroBlaze
17077 @subsection MicroBlaze
17078 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
17079 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
17080
17081 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
17082 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
17083 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
17084 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
17085 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
17086 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
17087 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
17088 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
17089 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
17090 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
17091 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
17092
17093 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
17094
17095 @table @code
17096 @item target remote :1234
17097 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
17098 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
17099
17100 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
17101 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
17102 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
17103
17104 @item load
17105 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
17106
17107 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
17108 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
17109
17110 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
17111 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
17112 @end table
17113
17114 @node MIPS Embedded
17115 @subsection MIPS Embedded
17116
17117 @cindex MIPS boards
17118 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
17119 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
17120 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
17121
17122 @need 1000
17123 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
17124
17125 @table @code
17126 @item target mips @var{port}
17127 @kindex target mips @var{port}
17128 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
17129 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
17130 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
17131 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
17132 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
17133 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
17134
17135 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
17136 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
17137 debugger:
17138
17139 @smallexample
17140 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
17141 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
17142 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
17143 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
17144 (@value{GDBP}) run
17145 @end smallexample
17146
17147 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
17148 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
17149 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
17150 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
17151 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
17152
17153 @item target pmon @var{port}
17154 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
17155 PMON ROM monitor.
17156
17157 @item target ddb @var{port}
17158 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
17159 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
17160
17161 @item target lsi @var{port}
17162 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
17163 LSI variant of PMON.
17164
17165 @kindex target r3900
17166 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
17167 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
17168
17169 @kindex target array
17170 @item target array @var{dev}
17171 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
17172
17173 @end table
17174
17175
17176 @noindent
17177 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
17178
17179 @table @code
17180 @item set mipsfpu double
17181 @itemx set mipsfpu single
17182 @itemx set mipsfpu none
17183 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
17184 @itemx show mipsfpu
17185 @kindex set mipsfpu
17186 @kindex show mipsfpu
17187 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
17188 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
17189 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
17190 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
17191 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
17192 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
17193 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
17194 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
17195 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
17196 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
17197 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
17198 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
17199 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
17200
17201 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
17202 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
17203 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
17204
17205 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
17206 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
17207
17208 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
17209 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
17210 @itemx show timeout
17211 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
17212 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
17213 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
17214 @kindex set timeout
17215 @kindex show timeout
17216 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
17217 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
17218 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
17219 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
17220 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
17221 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
17222 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
17223 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
17224 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
17225 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
17226
17227 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
17228 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
17229 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
17230 to run before stopping.
17231
17232 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
17233 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17234 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
17235 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
17236 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
17237 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
17238
17239 @item show syn-garbage-limit
17240 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17241 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
17242 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
17243
17244 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
17245 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17246 @cindex remote monitor prompt
17247 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
17248 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
17249 @table @asis
17250 @item pmon target
17251 @samp{PMON}
17252 @item ddb target
17253 @samp{NEC010}
17254 @item lsi target
17255 @samp{PMON>}
17256 @end table
17257
17258 @item show monitor-prompt
17259 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17260 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
17261 remote monitor.
17262
17263 @item set monitor-warnings
17264 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17265 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
17266 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
17267 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
17268 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
17269
17270 @item show monitor-warnings
17271 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17272 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
17273
17274 @item pmon @var{command}
17275 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
17276 @cindex send PMON command
17277 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
17278 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
17279 @end table
17280
17281 @node OpenRISC 1000
17282 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
17283 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
17284
17285 @cindex or1k boards
17286 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
17287 about platform and commands.
17288
17289 @table @code
17290
17291 @kindex target jtag
17292 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
17293
17294 Connects to remote JTAG server.
17295 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
17296 connected via parallel port to the board.
17297
17298 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
17299
17300 @kindex or1ksim
17301 @item or1ksim @var{command}
17302 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
17303 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
17304
17305 @kindex info or1k spr
17306 @item info or1k spr
17307 Displays spr groups.
17308
17309 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
17310 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
17311 Displays register names in selected group.
17312
17313 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
17314 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
17315 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
17316 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
17317 Shows information about specified spr register.
17318
17319 @kindex spr
17320 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
17321 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
17322 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
17323 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
17324 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
17325 @end table
17326
17327 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
17328 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
17329 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
17330 triggers can be set using:
17331 @table @code
17332 @item $LEA/$LDATA
17333 Load effective address/data
17334 @item $SEA/$SDATA
17335 Store effective address/data
17336 @item $AEA/$ADATA
17337 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
17338 @item $FETCH
17339 Fetch data
17340 @end table
17341
17342 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
17343 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
17344
17345 @code{htrace} commands:
17346 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
17347 @table @code
17348 @kindex hwatch
17349 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
17350 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
17351 or Data. For example:
17352
17353 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
17354
17355 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
17356
17357 @kindex htrace
17358 @item htrace info
17359 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
17360
17361 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
17362 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
17363
17364 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
17365 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
17366
17367 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
17368 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
17369
17370 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
17371 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
17372 triggered.
17373
17374 @item htrace enable
17375 @itemx htrace disable
17376 Enables/disables the HW trace.
17377
17378 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
17379 Clears currently recorded trace data.
17380
17381 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
17382 will be written there.
17383
17384 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
17385 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
17386
17387 @item htrace mode continuous
17388 Set continuous trace mode.
17389
17390 @item htrace mode suspend
17391 Set suspend trace mode.
17392
17393 @end table
17394
17395 @node PowerPC Embedded
17396 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
17397
17398 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
17399
17400 @table @code
17401 @kindex set powerpc
17402 @item set powerpc soft-float
17403 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
17404 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
17405 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
17406 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
17407
17408 @item set powerpc vector-abi
17409 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
17410 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
17411 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
17412 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
17413 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
17414 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
17415 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
17416
17417 @kindex target dink32
17418 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
17419 DINK32 ROM monitor.
17420
17421 @kindex target ppcbug
17422 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
17423 @kindex target ppcbug1
17424 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
17425 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
17426
17427 @kindex target sds
17428 @item target sds @var{dev}
17429 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
17430 @end table
17431
17432 @cindex SDS protocol
17433 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
17434 by @value{GDBN}:
17435
17436 @table @code
17437 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
17438 @kindex set sdstimeout
17439 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
17440 default is 2 seconds.
17441
17442 @item show sdstimeout
17443 @kindex show sdstimeout
17444 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
17445
17446 @item sds @var{command}
17447 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
17448 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
17449 @end table
17450
17451
17452 @node PA
17453 @subsection HP PA Embedded
17454
17455 @table @code
17456
17457 @kindex target op50n
17458 @item target op50n @var{dev}
17459 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
17460
17461 @kindex target w89k
17462 @item target w89k @var{dev}
17463 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
17464
17465 @end table
17466
17467 @node Sparclet
17468 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
17469
17470 @cindex Sparclet
17471
17472 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
17473 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
17474 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17475 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
17476 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
17477
17478 @table @code
17479 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
17480 @kindex remotetimeout
17481 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
17482 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17483 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
17484 @end table
17485
17486 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
17487 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
17488 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
17489 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
17490 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
17491
17492 @smallexample
17493 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
17494 @end smallexample
17495
17496 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
17497
17498 @smallexample
17499 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
17500 @end smallexample
17501
17502 @cindex running, on Sparclet
17503 Once you have set
17504 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17505 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
17506 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
17507
17508 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17509
17510 @smallexample
17511 (gdbslet)
17512 @end smallexample
17513
17514 @menu
17515 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
17516 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
17517 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
17518 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
17519 @end menu
17520
17521 @node Sparclet File
17522 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
17523
17524 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
17525
17526 @smallexample
17527 (gdbslet) file prog
17528 @end smallexample
17529
17530 @need 1000
17531 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
17532 @value{GDBN} locates
17533 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
17534 path.
17535 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
17536 files will be searched as well.
17537 @value{GDBN} locates
17538 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
17539 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
17540 If it fails
17541 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
17542
17543 @smallexample
17544 prog: No such file or directory.
17545 @end smallexample
17546
17547 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
17548 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
17549 @code{target} command again.
17550
17551 @node Sparclet Connection
17552 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
17553
17554 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
17555 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
17556
17557 @smallexample
17558 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
17559 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
17560 main () at ../prog.c:3
17561 @end smallexample
17562
17563 @need 750
17564 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17565
17566 @smallexample
17567 Connected to ttya.
17568 @end smallexample
17569
17570 @node Sparclet Download
17571 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
17572
17573 @cindex download to Sparclet
17574 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
17575 you can use the @value{GDBN}
17576 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
17577 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
17578 command.
17579 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
17580 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
17581 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
17582 of each of the file's sections.
17583 For instance, if the program
17584 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
17585 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
17586
17587 @smallexample
17588 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
17589 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
17590 @end smallexample
17591
17592 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
17593 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
17594 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
17595
17596 @node Sparclet Execution
17597 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
17598
17599 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
17600 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
17601 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
17602 manual for the list of commands.
17603
17604 @smallexample
17605 (gdbslet) b main
17606 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
17607 (gdbslet) run
17608 Starting program: prog
17609 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
17610 3 char *symarg = 0;
17611 (gdbslet) step
17612 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
17613 (gdbslet)
17614 @end smallexample
17615
17616 @node Sparclite
17617 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
17618
17619 @table @code
17620
17621 @kindex target sparclite
17622 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
17623 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
17624 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
17625 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
17626 remote protocol.
17627
17628 @end table
17629
17630 @node Z8000
17631 @subsection Zilog Z8000
17632
17633 @cindex Z8000
17634 @cindex simulator, Z8000
17635 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
17636
17637 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
17638 a Z8000 simulator.
17639
17640 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
17641 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
17642 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
17643 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
17644
17645 @table @code
17646 @item target sim @var{args}
17647 @kindex sim
17648 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
17649 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
17650 options, specify them via @var{args}.
17651 @end table
17652
17653 @noindent
17654 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
17655 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
17656 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
17657 to run your program, and so on.
17658
17659 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
17660 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
17661 additional items of information as specially named registers:
17662
17663 @table @code
17664
17665 @item cycles
17666 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
17667
17668 @item insts
17669 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
17670
17671 @item time
17672 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
17673
17674 @end table
17675
17676 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
17677 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
17678 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
17679 simulated clock ticks.
17680
17681 @node AVR
17682 @subsection Atmel AVR
17683 @cindex AVR
17684
17685 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
17686 following AVR-specific commands:
17687
17688 @table @code
17689 @item info io_registers
17690 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
17691 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
17692 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
17693 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
17694 @end table
17695
17696 @node CRIS
17697 @subsection CRIS
17698 @cindex CRIS
17699
17700 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
17701 following CRIS-specific commands:
17702
17703 @table @code
17704 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
17705 @cindex CRIS version
17706 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
17707 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
17708 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
17709
17710 @item show cris-version
17711 Show the current CRIS version.
17712
17713 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
17714 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
17715 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
17716 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
17717 @code{R59}.
17718
17719 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
17720 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
17721
17722 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
17723 @cindex CRIS mode
17724 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
17725 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
17726 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
17727
17728 @item show cris-mode
17729 Show the current CRIS mode.
17730 @end table
17731
17732 @node Super-H
17733 @subsection Renesas Super-H
17734 @cindex Super-H
17735
17736 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
17737 commands:
17738
17739 @table @code
17740 @item regs
17741 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
17742 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
17743
17744 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
17745 @kindex set sh calling-convention
17746 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
17747 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
17748 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
17749 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
17750 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
17751 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
17752 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
17753 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
17754 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
17755 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
17756
17757 @item show sh calling-convention
17758 @kindex show sh calling-convention
17759 Show the current calling convention setting.
17760
17761 @end table
17762
17763
17764 @node Architectures
17765 @section Architectures
17766
17767 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
17768 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
17769
17770 @menu
17771 * i386::
17772 * A29K::
17773 * Alpha::
17774 * MIPS::
17775 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
17776 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17777 * PowerPC::
17778 @end menu
17779
17780 @node i386
17781 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
17782
17783 @table @code
17784 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
17785 @kindex set struct-convention
17786 @cindex struct return convention
17787 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
17788 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
17789 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
17790 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
17791 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
17792 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
17793 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
17794 be returned in a register.
17795
17796 @item show struct-convention
17797 @kindex show struct-convention
17798 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
17799 from functions.
17800 @end table
17801
17802 @node A29K
17803 @subsection A29K
17804
17805 @table @code
17806
17807 @kindex set rstack_high_address
17808 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
17809 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
17810 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
17811 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
17812 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
17813 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
17814 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
17815 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
17816 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
17817 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
17818 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
17819 hexadecimal.
17820
17821 @kindex show rstack_high_address
17822 @item show rstack_high_address
17823 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
17824 processors.
17825
17826 @end table
17827
17828 @node Alpha
17829 @subsection Alpha
17830
17831 See the following section.
17832
17833 @node MIPS
17834 @subsection MIPS
17835
17836 @cindex stack on Alpha
17837 @cindex stack on MIPS
17838 @cindex Alpha stack
17839 @cindex MIPS stack
17840 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
17841 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
17842 find the beginning of a function.
17843
17844 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
17845 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
17846 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
17847 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
17848 commands:
17849
17850 @table @code
17851 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
17852 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
17853 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
17854 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
17855 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
17856 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
17857 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
17858 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
17859
17860 @item show heuristic-fence-post
17861 Display the current limit.
17862 @end table
17863
17864 @noindent
17865 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
17866 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
17867
17868 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
17869 programs:
17870
17871 @table @code
17872 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
17873 @kindex set mips abi
17874 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
17875 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
17876 values of @var{arg} are:
17877
17878 @table @samp
17879 @item auto
17880 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
17881 default).
17882 @item o32
17883 @item o64
17884 @item n32
17885 @item n64
17886 @item eabi32
17887 @item eabi64
17888 @item auto
17889 @end table
17890
17891 @item show mips abi
17892 @kindex show mips abi
17893 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
17894
17895 @item set mipsfpu
17896 @itemx show mipsfpu
17897 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
17898
17899 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
17900 @kindex set mips mask-address
17901 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
17902 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
17903 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
17904 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
17905 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
17906
17907 @item show mips mask-address
17908 @kindex show mips mask-address
17909 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
17910 not.
17911
17912 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17913 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17914 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
17915 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
17916 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
17917 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
17918
17919 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17920 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17921 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
17922
17923 @item set debug mips
17924 @kindex set debug mips
17925 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
17926 target code in @value{GDBN}.
17927
17928 @item show debug mips
17929 @kindex show debug mips
17930 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
17931 @end table
17932
17933
17934 @node HPPA
17935 @subsection HPPA
17936 @cindex HPPA support
17937
17938 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
17939 following special commands:
17940
17941 @table @code
17942 @item set debug hppa
17943 @kindex set debug hppa
17944 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
17945 messages are to be displayed.
17946
17947 @item show debug hppa
17948 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
17949
17950 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
17951 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
17952 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
17953 given @var{address}.
17954
17955 @end table
17956
17957
17958 @node SPU
17959 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17960 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
17961 @cindex SPU
17962
17963 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
17964 it provides the following special commands:
17965
17966 @table @code
17967 @item info spu event
17968 @kindex info spu
17969 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
17970 and pending event status.
17971
17972 @item info spu signal
17973 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
17974 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
17975 notification channels.
17976
17977 @item info spu mailbox
17978 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
17979 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
17980 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
17981
17982 @item info spu dma
17983 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17984 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17985 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17986
17987 @item info spu proxydma
17988 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17989 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17990 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17991
17992 @end table
17993
17994 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
17995 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
17996 special commands:
17997
17998 @table @code
17999 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
18000 @kindex set spu
18001 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
18002 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
18003 function. The default is @code{off}.
18004
18005 @item show spu stop-on-load
18006 @kindex show spu
18007 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
18008
18009 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
18010 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
18011 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
18012 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
18013 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
18014 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
18015
18016 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
18017 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
18018
18019 @end table
18020
18021 @node PowerPC
18022 @subsection PowerPC
18023 @cindex PowerPC architecture
18024
18025 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
18026 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
18027 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
18028 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
18029 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
18030
18031 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
18032 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
18033 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
18034
18035 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
18036 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
18037
18038
18039 @node Controlling GDB
18040 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
18041
18042 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
18043 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
18044 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
18045 described here.
18046
18047 @menu
18048 * Prompt:: Prompt
18049 * Editing:: Command editing
18050 * Command History:: Command history
18051 * Screen Size:: Screen size
18052 * Numbers:: Numbers
18053 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
18054 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
18055 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
18056 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
18057 @end menu
18058
18059 @node Prompt
18060 @section Prompt
18061
18062 @cindex prompt
18063
18064 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
18065 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
18066 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
18067 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
18068 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
18069 which one you are talking to.
18070
18071 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
18072 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
18073 or a prompt that does not.
18074
18075 @table @code
18076 @kindex set prompt
18077 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
18078 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
18079
18080 @kindex show prompt
18081 @item show prompt
18082 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
18083 @end table
18084
18085 @node Editing
18086 @section Command Editing
18087 @cindex readline
18088 @cindex command line editing
18089
18090 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
18091 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
18092 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
18093 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
18094 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
18095 debugging sessions.
18096
18097 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
18098 command @code{set}.
18099
18100 @table @code
18101 @kindex set editing
18102 @cindex editing
18103 @item set editing
18104 @itemx set editing on
18105 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
18106
18107 @item set editing off
18108 Disable command line editing.
18109
18110 @kindex show editing
18111 @item show editing
18112 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
18113 @end table
18114
18115 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
18116 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
18117 encouraged to read that chapter.
18118
18119 @node Command History
18120 @section Command History
18121 @cindex command history
18122
18123 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
18124 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
18125 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
18126 history facility.
18127
18128 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
18129 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
18130 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
18131
18132 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18133 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
18134 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
18135 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18136 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18137 pressed on a line by itself.
18138
18139 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
18140 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18141 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18142 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18143
18144 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
18145 history.
18146
18147 @table @code
18148 @cindex history substitution
18149 @cindex history file
18150 @kindex set history filename
18151 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
18152 @item set history filename @var{fname}
18153 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
18154 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
18155 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
18156 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
18157 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
18158 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
18159 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
18160 is not set.
18161
18162 @cindex save command history
18163 @kindex set history save
18164 @item set history save
18165 @itemx set history save on
18166 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
18167 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
18168
18169 @item set history save off
18170 Stop recording command history in a file.
18171
18172 @cindex history size
18173 @kindex set history size
18174 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
18175 @item set history size @var{size}
18176 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
18177 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
18178 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
18179 @end table
18180
18181 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
18182 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
18183
18184 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
18185 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
18186 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
18187 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
18188 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
18189 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
18190 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
18191 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
18192
18193 The commands to control history expansion are:
18194
18195 @table @code
18196 @item set history expansion on
18197 @itemx set history expansion
18198 @kindex set history expansion
18199 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
18200
18201 @item set history expansion off
18202 Disable history expansion.
18203
18204 @c @group
18205 @kindex show history
18206 @item show history
18207 @itemx show history filename
18208 @itemx show history save
18209 @itemx show history size
18210 @itemx show history expansion
18211 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
18212 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
18213 @c @end group
18214 @end table
18215
18216 @table @code
18217 @kindex show commands
18218 @cindex show last commands
18219 @cindex display command history
18220 @item show commands
18221 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
18222
18223 @item show commands @var{n}
18224 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
18225
18226 @item show commands +
18227 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
18228 @end table
18229
18230 @node Screen Size
18231 @section Screen Size
18232 @cindex size of screen
18233 @cindex pauses in output
18234
18235 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
18236 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
18237 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
18238 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
18239 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
18240 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
18241 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
18242 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
18243
18244 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
18245 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
18246 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
18247 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
18248 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
18249 width} commands:
18250
18251 @table @code
18252 @kindex set height
18253 @kindex set width
18254 @kindex show width
18255 @kindex show height
18256 @item set height @var{lpp}
18257 @itemx show height
18258 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
18259 @itemx show width
18260 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
18261 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
18262 commands display the current settings.
18263
18264 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
18265 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
18266 file or to an editor buffer.
18267
18268 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
18269 from wrapping its output.
18270
18271 @item set pagination on
18272 @itemx set pagination off
18273 @kindex set pagination
18274 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
18275 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
18276
18277 @item show pagination
18278 @kindex show pagination
18279 Show the current pagination mode.
18280 @end table
18281
18282 @node Numbers
18283 @section Numbers
18284 @cindex number representation
18285 @cindex entering numbers
18286
18287 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
18288 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
18289 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
18290 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
18291 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
18292 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
18293 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
18294 both input and output with the commands described below.
18295
18296 @table @code
18297 @kindex set input-radix
18298 @item set input-radix @var{base}
18299 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
18300 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18301 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
18302 example, any of
18303
18304 @smallexample
18305 set input-radix 012
18306 set input-radix 10.
18307 set input-radix 0xa
18308 @end smallexample
18309
18310 @noindent
18311 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
18312 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
18313 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
18314 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
18315 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
18316 change the radix.
18317
18318 @kindex set output-radix
18319 @item set output-radix @var{base}
18320 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
18321 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18322 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
18323
18324 @kindex show input-radix
18325 @item show input-radix
18326 Display the current default base for numeric input.
18327
18328 @kindex show output-radix
18329 @item show output-radix
18330 Display the current default base for numeric display.
18331
18332 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
18333 @itemx show radix
18334 @kindex set radix
18335 @kindex show radix
18336 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
18337 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
18338 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
18339 default value of 10.
18340
18341 @end table
18342
18343 @node ABI
18344 @section Configuring the Current ABI
18345
18346 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
18347 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
18348 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
18349 current ABI.
18350
18351 @cindex OS ABI
18352 @kindex set osabi
18353 @kindex show osabi
18354
18355 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
18356 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
18357 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
18358 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
18359 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
18360 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
18361 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
18362 platform provides.
18363
18364 @table @code
18365 @item show osabi
18366 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
18367
18368 @item set osabi
18369 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
18370
18371 @item set osabi @var{abi}
18372 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
18373 @end table
18374
18375 @cindex float promotion
18376
18377 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
18378 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
18379 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
18380 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
18381 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
18382 @code{double} and then passed.
18383
18384 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
18385 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
18386 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
18387
18388 @table @code
18389 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
18390 @item set coerce-float-to-double
18391 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
18392 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
18393 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
18394
18395 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
18396 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
18397 functions.
18398
18399 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
18400 @item show coerce-float-to-double
18401 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
18402 @end table
18403
18404 @kindex set cp-abi
18405 @kindex show cp-abi
18406 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
18407 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
18408 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
18409 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
18410 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
18411 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
18412 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
18413 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
18414 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
18415 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
18416 ``auto''.
18417
18418 @table @code
18419 @item show cp-abi
18420 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
18421
18422 @item set cp-abi
18423 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
18424
18425 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
18426 @itemx set cp-abi auto
18427 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
18428 @end table
18429
18430 @node Messages/Warnings
18431 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
18432
18433 @cindex verbose operation
18434 @cindex optional warnings
18435 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
18436 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
18437 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
18438 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
18439
18440 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
18441 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
18442 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
18443
18444 @table @code
18445 @kindex set verbose
18446 @item set verbose on
18447 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
18448
18449 @item set verbose off
18450 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
18451
18452 @kindex show verbose
18453 @item show verbose
18454 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
18455 @end table
18456
18457 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
18458 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
18459 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
18460 Symbol Files}).
18461
18462 @table @code
18463
18464 @kindex set complaints
18465 @item set complaints @var{limit}
18466 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
18467 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
18468 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
18469 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
18470
18471 @kindex show complaints
18472 @item show complaints
18473 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
18474
18475 @end table
18476
18477 @anchor{confirmation requests}
18478 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
18479 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
18480 you try to run a program which is already running:
18481
18482 @smallexample
18483 (@value{GDBP}) run
18484 The program being debugged has been started already.
18485 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
18486 @end smallexample
18487
18488 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
18489 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
18490
18491 @table @code
18492
18493 @kindex set confirm
18494 @cindex flinching
18495 @cindex confirmation
18496 @cindex stupid questions
18497 @item set confirm off
18498 Disables confirmation requests.
18499
18500 @item set confirm on
18501 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
18502
18503 @kindex show confirm
18504 @item show confirm
18505 Displays state of confirmation requests.
18506
18507 @end table
18508
18509 @cindex command tracing
18510 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
18511 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
18512 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
18513 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
18514
18515 @table @code
18516 @kindex set trace-commands
18517 @cindex command scripts, debugging
18518 @item set trace-commands on
18519 Enable command tracing.
18520 @item set trace-commands off
18521 Disable command tracing.
18522 @item show trace-commands
18523 Display the current state of command tracing.
18524 @end table
18525
18526 @node Debugging Output
18527 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
18528 @cindex optional debugging messages
18529
18530 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
18531 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
18532 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
18533 section documents those commands.
18534
18535 @table @code
18536 @kindex set exec-done-display
18537 @item set exec-done-display
18538 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
18539 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
18540 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
18541 @kindex show exec-done-display
18542 @item show exec-done-display
18543 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
18544 notification.
18545 @kindex set debug
18546 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
18547 @cindex architecture debugging info
18548 @item set debug arch
18549 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
18550 @kindex show debug
18551 @item show debug arch
18552 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
18553 @item set debug aix-thread
18554 @cindex AIX threads
18555 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
18556 module.
18557 @item show debug aix-thread
18558 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
18559 @item set debug dwarf2-die
18560 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
18561 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
18562 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
18563 A value of zero turns off the display.
18564 @item show debug dwarf2-die
18565 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
18566 @item set debug displaced
18567 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
18568 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
18569 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
18570 @item show debug displaced
18571 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
18572 related to displaced stepping.
18573 @item set debug event
18574 @cindex event debugging info
18575 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
18576 default is off.
18577 @item show debug event
18578 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
18579 info.
18580 @item set debug expression
18581 @cindex expression debugging info
18582 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
18583 expression parsing. The default is off.
18584 @item show debug expression
18585 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
18586 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
18587 @item set debug frame
18588 @cindex frame debugging info
18589 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
18590 default is off.
18591 @item show debug frame
18592 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
18593 info.
18594 @item set debug gnu-nat
18595 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
18596 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
18597 @item show debug gnu-nat
18598 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
18599 @item set debug infrun
18600 @cindex inferior debugging info
18601 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
18602 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
18603 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
18604 @item show debug infrun
18605 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
18606 @item set debug lin-lwp
18607 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
18608 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
18609 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
18610 @item show debug lin-lwp
18611 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
18612 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
18613 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
18614 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
18615 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
18616 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
18617 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
18618 @item set debug observer
18619 @cindex observer debugging info
18620 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
18621 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
18622 @item show debug observer
18623 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
18624 @item set debug overload
18625 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
18626 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
18627 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
18628 is off.
18629 @item show debug overload
18630 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
18631 debugging info.
18632 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
18633 @cindex serial connections, debugging
18634 @cindex debug remote protocol
18635 @cindex remote protocol debugging
18636 @cindex display remote packets
18637 @item set debug remote
18638 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
18639 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
18640 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
18641 @item show debug remote
18642 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
18643 @item set debug serial
18644 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
18645 default is off.
18646 @item show debug serial
18647 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
18648 info.
18649 @item set debug solib-frv
18650 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
18651 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
18652 @item show debug solib-frv
18653 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
18654 messages.
18655 @item set debug target
18656 @cindex target debugging info
18657 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
18658 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
18659 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
18660 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
18661 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
18662 @item show debug target
18663 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
18664 info.
18665 @item set debug timestamp
18666 @cindex timestampping debugging info
18667 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
18668 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
18669 message.
18670 @item show debug timestamp
18671 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
18672 debugging info.
18673 @item set debugvarobj
18674 @cindex variable object debugging info
18675 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
18676 info. The default is off.
18677 @item show debugvarobj
18678 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
18679 debugging info.
18680 @item set debug xml
18681 @cindex XML parser debugging
18682 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
18683 @item show debug xml
18684 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
18685 @end table
18686
18687 @node Other Misc Settings
18688 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
18689 @cindex miscellaneous settings
18690
18691 @table @code
18692 @kindex set interactive-mode
18693 @item set interactive-mode
18694 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
18695 If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
18696 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
18697 based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
18698
18699 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
18700 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
18701 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
18702 inside a cygwin window.
18703
18704 @kindex show interactive-mode
18705 @item show interactive-mode
18706 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
18707 @end table
18708
18709 @node Extending GDB
18710 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
18711 @cindex extending GDB
18712
18713 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
18714 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
18715 Python scripting language.
18716
18717 @menu
18718 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
18719 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18720 @end menu
18721
18722 @node Sequences
18723 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
18724
18725 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
18726 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
18727 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
18728 files.
18729
18730 @menu
18731 * Define:: How to define your own commands
18732 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
18733 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
18734 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
18735 @end menu
18736
18737 @node Define
18738 @subsection User-defined Commands
18739
18740 @cindex user-defined command
18741 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
18742 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
18743 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
18744 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
18745 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
18746 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
18747
18748 @smallexample
18749 define adder
18750 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18751 end
18752 @end smallexample
18753
18754 @noindent
18755 To execute the command use:
18756
18757 @smallexample
18758 adder 1 2 3
18759 @end smallexample
18760
18761 @noindent
18762 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
18763 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
18764 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
18765 functions calls.
18766
18767 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
18768 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
18769 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
18770 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
18771
18772 @smallexample
18773 define adder
18774 if $argc == 2
18775 print $arg0 + $arg1
18776 end
18777 if $argc == 3
18778 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18779 end
18780 end
18781 @end smallexample
18782
18783 @table @code
18784
18785 @kindex define
18786 @item define @var{commandname}
18787 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
18788 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
18789 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
18790 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
18791 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
18792 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
18793
18794 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
18795 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
18796 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18797
18798 @kindex document
18799 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
18800 @item document @var{commandname}
18801 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
18802 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
18803 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
18804 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
18805 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
18806 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
18807
18808 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
18809 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
18810 does not change the documentation.
18811
18812 @kindex dont-repeat
18813 @cindex don't repeat command
18814 @item dont-repeat
18815 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
18816 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
18817 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
18818
18819 @kindex help user-defined
18820 @item help user-defined
18821 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
18822 (if any) for each.
18823
18824 @kindex show user
18825 @item show user
18826 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
18827 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
18828 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
18829 definitions for all user-defined commands.
18830
18831 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
18832 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
18833 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
18834 @item show max-user-call-depth
18835 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
18836 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
18837 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
18838 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
18839 @end table
18840
18841 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
18842 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
18843
18844 When user-defined commands are executed, the
18845 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
18846 stops execution of the user-defined command.
18847
18848 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
18849 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
18850 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
18851 messages when used in a user-defined command.
18852
18853 @node Hooks
18854 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
18855 @cindex command hooks
18856 @cindex hooks, for commands
18857 @cindex hooks, pre-command
18858
18859 @kindex hook
18860 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
18861 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
18862 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
18863 before that command.
18864
18865 @cindex hooks, post-command
18866 @kindex hookpost
18867 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
18868 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
18869 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
18870 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
18871 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
18872
18873 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
18874 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
18875
18876 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
18877 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
18878
18879 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
18880 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
18881 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
18882 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
18883 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
18884
18885 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
18886 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
18887 you could define:
18888
18889 @smallexample
18890 define hook-stop
18891 handle SIGALRM nopass
18892 end
18893
18894 define hook-run
18895 handle SIGALRM pass
18896 end
18897
18898 define hook-continue
18899 handle SIGALRM pass
18900 end
18901 @end smallexample
18902
18903 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
18904 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
18905 you could define:
18906
18907 @smallexample
18908 define hook-echo
18909 echo <<<---
18910 end
18911
18912 define hookpost-echo
18913 echo --->>>\n
18914 end
18915
18916 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
18917 <<<---Hello World--->>>
18918 (@value{GDBP})
18919
18920 @end smallexample
18921
18922 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
18923 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
18924 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
18925 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
18926 @c or not?
18927 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
18928 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
18929 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
18930
18931 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
18932 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
18933 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
18934
18935 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
18936 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
18937
18938 @node Command Files
18939 @subsection Command Files
18940
18941 @cindex command files
18942 @cindex scripting commands
18943 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
18944 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
18945 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
18946 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
18947 terminal.
18948
18949 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
18950 command:
18951
18952 @table @code
18953 @kindex source
18954 @cindex execute commands from a file
18955 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
18956 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
18957 @end table
18958
18959 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
18960 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
18961 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
18962 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
18963 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
18964
18965 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
18966 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
18967
18968 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
18969 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
18970 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
18971
18972 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
18973 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
18974 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
18975 when called from command files.
18976
18977 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
18978 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
18979 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
18980 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
18981 the next command.
18982
18983 @smallexample
18984 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
18985 @end smallexample
18986
18987 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
18988 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
18989 would be directed to @file{log}.
18990
18991 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
18992 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
18993 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
18994 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
18995 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
18996 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
18997 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
18998 conditionally, etc.
18999
19000 @table @code
19001 @kindex if
19002 @kindex else
19003 @item if
19004 @itemx else
19005 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
19006 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
19007 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
19008 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
19009 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
19010 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
19011 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
19012
19013 @kindex while
19014 @item while
19015 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
19016 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
19017 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
19018 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
19019 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
19020 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
19021
19022 @kindex loop_break
19023 @item loop_break
19024 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
19025 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
19026 line.
19027
19028 @kindex loop_continue
19029 @item loop_continue
19030 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
19031 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
19032 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
19033 the controlling expression.
19034
19035 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
19036 @item end
19037 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
19038 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
19039 @end table
19040
19041
19042 @node Output
19043 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
19044
19045 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
19046 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
19047 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
19048 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
19049 want.
19050
19051 @table @code
19052 @kindex echo
19053 @item echo @var{text}
19054 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
19055 @c because it is not in ANSI.
19056 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
19057 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
19058 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
19059 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
19060 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
19061 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
19062 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
19063 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
19064 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
19065
19066 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
19067 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
19068
19069 @smallexample
19070 echo This is some text\n\
19071 which is continued\n\
19072 onto several lines.\n
19073 @end smallexample
19074
19075 produces the same output as
19076
19077 @smallexample
19078 echo This is some text\n
19079 echo which is continued\n
19080 echo onto several lines.\n
19081 @end smallexample
19082
19083 @kindex output
19084 @item output @var{expression}
19085 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
19086 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
19087 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
19088 on expressions.
19089
19090 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
19091 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
19092 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
19093 Formats}, for more information.
19094
19095 @kindex printf
19096 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
19097 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
19098 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
19099 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
19100 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
19101 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
19102 executing the code below:
19103
19104 @smallexample
19105 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
19106 @end smallexample
19107
19108 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
19109 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
19110 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
19111 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
19112 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
19113 printed.
19114
19115 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
19116
19117 @smallexample
19118 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
19119 @end smallexample
19120
19121 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
19122 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
19123 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
19124
19125 @itemize @bullet
19126 @item
19127 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
19128
19129 @item
19130 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
19131 width.
19132
19133 @item
19134 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
19135 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
19136
19137 @item
19138 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
19139 supported.
19140
19141 @item
19142 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
19143
19144 @item
19145 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
19146 @end itemize
19147
19148 @noindent
19149 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
19150 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
19151 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
19152 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
19153
19154 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
19155 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
19156 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
19157 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
19158 supported.
19159
19160 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
19161 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
19162 together with a floating point specifier.
19163 letters:
19164
19165 @itemize @bullet
19166 @item
19167 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
19168
19169 @item
19170 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
19171
19172 @item
19173 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
19174 @end itemize
19175
19176 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
19177 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
19178 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
19179
19180 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
19181 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
19182
19183 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
19184 @smallexample
19185 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
19186 @end smallexample
19187
19188 @end table
19189
19190 @node Python
19191 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
19192 @cindex python scripting
19193 @cindex scripting with python
19194
19195 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
19196 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
19197 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
19198
19199 @menu
19200 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
19201 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
19202 @end menu
19203
19204 @node Python Commands
19205 @subsection Python Commands
19206 @cindex python commands
19207 @cindex commands to access python
19208
19209 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
19210 and one related setting:
19211
19212 @table @code
19213 @kindex python
19214 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
19215 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
19216
19217 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
19218 argument as a Python command. For example:
19219
19220 @smallexample
19221 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
19222 23
19223 @end smallexample
19224
19225 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
19226 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
19227 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
19228 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
19229 containing @code{end}. For example:
19230
19231 @smallexample
19232 (@value{GDBP}) python
19233 Type python script
19234 End with a line saying just "end".
19235 >print 23
19236 >end
19237 23
19238 @end smallexample
19239
19240 @kindex maint set python print-stack
19241 @item maint set python print-stack
19242 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
19243 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
19244 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
19245 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
19246 disabled.
19247 @end table
19248
19249 @node Python API
19250 @subsection Python API
19251 @cindex python api
19252 @cindex programming in python
19253
19254 @cindex python stdout
19255 @cindex python pagination
19256 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
19257 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
19258 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
19259 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
19260 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
19261
19262 @menu
19263 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
19264 * Exception Handling::
19265 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
19266 * Values From Inferior::
19267 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
19268 * Pretty Printing:: Pretty-printing values.
19269 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
19270 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
19271 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
19272 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
19273 * Frames In Python:: Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
19274 @end menu
19275
19276 @node Basic Python
19277 @subsubsection Basic Python
19278
19279 @cindex python functions
19280 @cindex python module
19281 @cindex gdb module
19282 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
19283 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
19284 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
19285 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
19286
19287 @findex gdb.execute
19288 @defun execute command [from_tty]
19289 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19290 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
19291 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
19292 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
19293
19294 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
19295 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
19296 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
19297 @end defun
19298
19299 @findex gdb.parameter
19300 @defun parameter parameter
19301 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
19302 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
19303 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
19304 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
19305
19306 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
19307 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
19308 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
19309 @end defun
19310
19311 @findex gdb.history
19312 @defun history number
19313 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
19314 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
19315 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
19316 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
19317 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
19318 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
19319 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
19320 raised.
19321
19322 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
19323 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
19324 @end defun
19325
19326 @findex gdb.write
19327 @defun write string
19328 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
19329 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
19330 call this function.
19331 @end defun
19332
19333 @findex gdb.flush
19334 @defun flush
19335 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
19336 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
19337 function.
19338 @end defun
19339
19340 @node Exception Handling
19341 @subsubsection Exception Handling
19342 @cindex python exceptions
19343 @cindex exceptions, python
19344
19345 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
19346 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
19347 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
19348 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
19349 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
19350 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
19351 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
19352
19353 @smallexample
19354 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
19355 Traceback (most recent call last):
19356 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
19357 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
19358 @end smallexample
19359
19360 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
19361 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
19362 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
19363 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
19364 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
19365 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
19366 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
19367 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
19368 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
19369 traceback.
19370
19371 @node Auto-loading
19372 @subsubsection Auto-loading
19373 @cindex auto-loading, Python
19374
19375 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
19376 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
19377 @value{GDBN} will look for a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
19378 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
19379 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
19380 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
19381 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
19382
19383 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
19384 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
19385 then @value{GDBN} will use the file named
19386 @file{@var{debug-file-directory}/@var{real-name}}, where
19387 @var{real-name} is the object file's real name, as described above.
19388
19389 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
19390 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
19391 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
19392 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
19393 is the object file's real name, as described above.
19394
19395 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the ``current
19396 objfile''. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
19397 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
19398 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
19399
19400 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
19401 debugging commands and scripts. You can enable or disable this
19402 feature, and view its current state.
19403
19404 @table @code
19405 @kindex maint set python auto-load
19406 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
19407 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
19408
19409 @kindex show python auto-load
19410 @item show python auto-load
19411 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
19412 @end table
19413
19414 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded.
19415 So, your @samp{-gdb.py} file should take care to ensure that it may be
19416 evaluated multiple times without error.
19417
19418 @node Values From Inferior
19419 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
19420 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
19421 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
19422
19423 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
19424 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
19425 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
19426 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
19427 fetching values when necessary.
19428
19429 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
19430 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
19431 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
19432
19433 @smallexample
19434 bar = some_val + 2
19435 @end smallexample
19436
19437 @noindent
19438 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
19439 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
19440
19441 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
19442 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
19443 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
19444 can access its @code{foo} element with:
19445
19446 @smallexample
19447 bar = some_val['foo']
19448 @end smallexample
19449
19450 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
19451
19452 The following attributes are provided:
19453
19454 @table @code
19455 @defivar Value address
19456 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
19457 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
19458 this attribute holds @code{None}.
19459 @end defivar
19460
19461 @cindex optimized out value in Python
19462 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
19463 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
19464 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
19465 @end defivar
19466
19467 @defivar Value type
19468 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
19469 @code{gdb.Type} object.
19470 @end defivar
19471 @end table
19472
19473 The following methods are provided:
19474
19475 @table @code
19476 @defmethod Value cast type
19477 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
19478 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
19479 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
19480 reason, this method throws an exception.
19481 @end defmethod
19482
19483 @defmethod Value dereference
19484 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
19485 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
19486 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
19487
19488 @smallexample
19489 int *foo;
19490 @end smallexample
19491
19492 @noindent
19493 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
19494 @code{foo} points to like this:
19495
19496 @smallexample
19497 bar = foo.dereference ()
19498 @end smallexample
19499
19500 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
19501 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
19502 @end defmethod
19503
19504 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
19505 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
19506 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
19507 throw an exception.
19508
19509 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
19510 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
19511 language.
19512
19513 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
19514 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
19515 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
19516 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
19517 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
19518
19519 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
19520 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
19521 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
19522 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
19523 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
19524 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
19525 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
19526 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
19527 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
19528
19529 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
19530 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
19531
19532 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
19533 fetched and converted to the given length.
19534 @end defmethod
19535 @end table
19536
19537 @node Types In Python
19538 @subsubsection Types In Python
19539 @cindex types in Python
19540 @cindex Python, working with types
19541
19542 @tindex gdb.Type
19543 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
19544 @code{gdb.Type}.
19545
19546 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
19547 module:
19548
19549 @findex gdb.lookup_type
19550 @defun lookup_type name [block]
19551 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
19552 type to look up. It must be a string.
19553
19554 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
19555 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
19556 @end defun
19557
19558 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
19559
19560 @table @code
19561 @defivar Type code
19562 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
19563 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
19564 @end defivar
19565
19566 @defivar Type sizeof
19567 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
19568 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
19569 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
19570 @end defivar
19571
19572 @defivar Type tag
19573 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
19574 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
19575 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
19576 @code{None} is returned.
19577 @end defivar
19578 @end table
19579
19580 The following methods are provided:
19581
19582 @table @code
19583 @defmethod Type fields
19584 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
19585 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
19586 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
19587 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
19588 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
19589 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
19590
19591 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
19592 @table @code
19593 @item bitpos
19594 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
19595 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
19596 position of the field.
19597
19598 @item name
19599 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
19600
19601 @item artificial
19602 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
19603 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
19604 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
19605
19606 @item bitsize
19607 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
19608 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
19609 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
19610
19611 @item type
19612 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
19613 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
19614 @end table
19615 @end defmethod
19616
19617 @defmethod Type const
19618 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
19619 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
19620 @end defmethod
19621
19622 @defmethod Type volatile
19623 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
19624 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
19625 @end defmethod
19626
19627 @defmethod Type unqualified
19628 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
19629 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
19630 @code{volatile}.
19631 @end defmethod
19632
19633 @defmethod Type reference
19634 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
19635 type.
19636 @end defmethod
19637
19638 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
19639 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
19640 after removing all layers of typedefs.
19641 @end defmethod
19642
19643 @defmethod Type target
19644 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
19645 of this type.
19646
19647 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
19648 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
19649 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
19650 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
19651 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
19652 target type is the aliased type.
19653
19654 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
19655 exception.
19656 @end defmethod
19657
19658 @defmethod Type template_argument n
19659 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
19660 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
19661 @var{n}th template argument.
19662
19663 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
19664 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
19665
19666 @var{name} is searched for globally.
19667 @end defmethod
19668 @end table
19669
19670
19671 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
19672 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
19673 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
19674
19675 @table @code
19676 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
19677 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
19678 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
19679 The type is a pointer.
19680
19681 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19682 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19683 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19684 The type is an array.
19685
19686 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19687 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19688 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19689 The type is a structure.
19690
19691 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
19692 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
19693 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
19694 The type is a union.
19695
19696 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19697 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19698 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19699 The type is an enum.
19700
19701 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19702 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19703 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19704 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
19705
19706 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19707 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19708 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19709 The type is a function.
19710
19711 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
19712 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
19713 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
19714 The type is an integer type.
19715
19716 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
19717 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
19718 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
19719 A floating point type.
19720
19721 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
19722 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
19723 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
19724 The special type @code{void}.
19725
19726 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
19727 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
19728 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
19729 A Pascal set type.
19730
19731 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19732 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19733 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19734 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
19735
19736 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
19737 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
19738 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
19739 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
19740 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
19741
19742 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19743 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19744 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19745 A string of bits.
19746
19747 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19748 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19749 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19750 An unknown or erroneous type.
19751
19752 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19753 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19754 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19755 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
19756
19757 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19758 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19759 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19760 A pointer-to-member-function.
19761
19762 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19763 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19764 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19765 A pointer-to-member.
19766
19767 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
19768 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
19769 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
19770 A reference type.
19771
19772 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19773 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19774 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19775 A character type.
19776
19777 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19778 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19779 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19780 A boolean type.
19781
19782 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19783 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19784 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19785 A complex float type.
19786
19787 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19788 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19789 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19790 A typedef to some other type.
19791
19792 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19793 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19794 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19795 A C@t{++} namespace.
19796
19797 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
19798 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
19799 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
19800 A decimal floating point type.
19801
19802 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
19803 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
19804 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
19805 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
19806 convenience functions.
19807 @end table
19808
19809 @node Pretty Printing
19810 @subsubsection Pretty Printing
19811
19812 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values
19813 using Python code. The pretty-printer API allows application-specific
19814 code to greatly simplify the display of complex objects. This
19815 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
19816
19817 For example, here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a
19818 pretty-printer:
19819
19820 @smallexample
19821 (@value{GDBP}) print s
19822 $1 = @{
19823 static npos = 4294967295,
19824 _M_dataplus = @{
19825 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
19826 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{<No data fields>@}, <No data fields>@},
19827 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>, std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
19828 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
19829 @}
19830 @}
19831 @end smallexample
19832
19833 After a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} has been installed, only
19834 the contents are printed:
19835
19836 @smallexample
19837 (@value{GDBP}) print s
19838 $2 = "abcd"
19839 @end smallexample
19840
19841 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
19842 specific interface, defined here.
19843
19844 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
19845 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
19846 children of the pretty-printer's value.
19847
19848 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
19849 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
19850 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
19851 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
19852 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
19853
19854 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
19855 as though the value has no children.
19856 @end defop
19857
19858 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
19859 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
19860 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
19861 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
19862 printed.
19863
19864 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
19865 string.
19866
19867 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
19868
19869 @table @samp
19870 @item array
19871 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
19872 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
19873 @code{set print array}.
19874
19875 @item map
19876 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
19877 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
19878 values.
19879
19880 @item string
19881 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
19882 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
19883 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
19884 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
19885 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
19886 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
19887 @end table
19888 @end defop
19889
19890 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
19891 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
19892 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
19893
19894 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
19895 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
19896 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
19897 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
19898 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
19899 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
19900 the result of @code{children}.
19901
19902 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
19903
19904 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
19905 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
19906 another pretty-printer.
19907
19908 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
19909 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
19910 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
19911 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
19912 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
19913
19914 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
19915 @end defop
19916
19917 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
19918 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
19919
19920 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
19921 functions that have been registered via addition as a pretty-printer.
19922 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
19923 attribute.
19924
19925 A function on one of these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
19926 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
19927 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). If a function
19928 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
19929 @code{None}.
19930
19931 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
19932 @code{gdb.Objfile} and iteratively calls each function in the list for
19933 that @code{gdb.Objfile} until it receives a pretty-printer object.
19934 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
19935 @code{gdb.pretty-printers} list, again calling each function until an
19936 object is returned.
19937
19938 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
19939 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
19940 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
19941 object is returned.
19942
19943 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
19944 written:
19945
19946 @smallexample
19947 class StdStringPrinter:
19948 "Print a std::string"
19949
19950 def __init__ (self, val):
19951 self.val = val
19952
19953 def to_string (self):
19954 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
19955
19956 def display_hint (self):
19957 return 'string'
19958 @end smallexample
19959
19960 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
19961 example above might be written.
19962
19963 @smallexample
19964 def str_lookup_function (val):
19965
19966 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
19967 regex = re.compile ("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
19968 if lookup_tag == None:
19969 return None
19970 if regex.match (lookup_tag):
19971 return StdStringPrinter (val)
19972
19973 return None
19974 @end smallexample
19975
19976 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
19977 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
19978 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
19979 returns @code{None}.
19980
19981 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
19982 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
19983 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
19984 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
19985 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
19986 different names.
19987
19988 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
19989 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
19990 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
19991 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
19992 the current objfile.
19993
19994 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
19995 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
19996 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
19997 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
19998 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
19999 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
20000 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
20001 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
20002 inferior.
20003
20004 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
20005 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
20006
20007 @smallexample
20008 def register_printers (objfile):
20009 objfile.pretty_printers.add (str_lookup_function)
20010 @end smallexample
20011
20012 @noindent
20013 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
20014
20015 @smallexample
20016 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
20017 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers (gdb.current_objfile ())
20018 @end smallexample
20019
20020 @node Commands In Python
20021 @subsubsection Commands In Python
20022
20023 @cindex commands in python
20024 @cindex python commands
20025 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
20026 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
20027 class, most commonly using a subclass.
20028
20029 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
20030 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
20031 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
20032 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
20033
20034 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
20035 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
20036 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
20037 an exception is raised.
20038
20039 There is no support for multi-line commands.
20040
20041 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
20042 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
20043 new command in the help system.
20044
20045 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
20046 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
20047 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
20048 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
20049 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
20050 error will occur when completion is attempted.
20051
20052 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
20053 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
20054 registered.
20055
20056 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
20057 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
20058 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
20059 not documented.'' is used.
20060 @end defmethod
20061
20062 @cindex don't repeat Python command
20063 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
20064 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
20065 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
20066 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
20067 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
20068 @end defmethod
20069
20070 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
20071 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
20072
20073 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
20074 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
20075
20076 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
20077 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
20078 that the command came from elsewhere.
20079
20080 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
20081 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
20082 @end defmethod
20083
20084 @cindex completion of Python commands
20085 @defmethod Command complete text word
20086 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
20087 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
20088 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
20089 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
20090 complete}).
20091
20092 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
20093 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
20094 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
20095 using a word-breaking heuristic.
20096
20097 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
20098 @itemize @bullet
20099 @item
20100 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
20101 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
20102 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
20103 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
20104 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
20105 sequence are ignored.
20106
20107 @item
20108 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
20109 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
20110 function is invoked, and its result is used.
20111
20112 @item
20113 All other results are treated as though there were no available
20114 completions.
20115 @end itemize
20116 @end defmethod
20117
20118 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
20119 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
20120 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
20121 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
20122 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
20123 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20124
20125 @table @code
20126 @findex COMMAND_NONE
20127 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
20128 @item COMMAND_NONE
20129 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
20130 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
20131
20132 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
20133 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
20134 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
20135 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
20136 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
20137 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20138 commands in this category.
20139
20140 @findex COMMAND_DATA
20141 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
20142 @item COMMAND_DATA
20143 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
20144 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
20145 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
20146 in this category.
20147
20148 @findex COMMAND_STACK
20149 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
20150 @item COMMAND_STACK
20151 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
20152 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
20153 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
20154 list of commands in this category.
20155
20156 @findex COMMAND_FILES
20157 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
20158 @item COMMAND_FILES
20159 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
20160 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
20161 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20162 commands in this category.
20163
20164 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
20165 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
20166 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
20167 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
20168 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
20169 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
20170 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
20171 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20172 commands in this category.
20173
20174 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
20175 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
20176 @item COMMAND_STATUS
20177 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
20178 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
20179 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
20180 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
20181
20182 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20183 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20184 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20185 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
20186 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
20187 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
20188 this category.
20189
20190 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20191 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20192 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20193 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
20194 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
20195 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20196 commands in this category.
20197
20198 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
20199 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
20200 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
20201 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
20202 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
20203 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
20204 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
20205 category.
20206
20207 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20208 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20209 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20210 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
20211 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
20212 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20213 commands in this category.
20214 @end table
20215
20216 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
20217 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
20218 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
20219 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20220
20221 @table @code
20222 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
20223 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
20224 @item COMPLETE_NONE
20225 This constant means that no completion should be done.
20226
20227 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
20228 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
20229 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
20230 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
20231
20232 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
20233 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
20234 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
20235 This constant means that location completion should be done.
20236 @xref{Specify Location}.
20237
20238 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
20239 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
20240 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
20241 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
20242 command names.
20243
20244 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20245 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20246 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20247 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
20248 as the source.
20249 @end table
20250
20251 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
20252 implemented in Python:
20253
20254 @smallexample
20255 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20256 """Greet the whole world."""
20257
20258 def __init__ (self):
20259 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20260
20261 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
20262 print "Hello, World!"
20263
20264 HelloWorld ()
20265 @end smallexample
20266
20267 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
20268 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
20269 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
20270 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
20271
20272 @node Functions In Python
20273 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
20274
20275 @cindex writing convenience functions
20276 @cindex convenience functions in python
20277 @cindex python convenience functions
20278 @tindex gdb.Function
20279 @tindex Function
20280 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
20281 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
20282 class @code{gdb.Function}.
20283
20284 @defmethod Function __init__ name
20285 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
20286 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
20287 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
20288 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
20289 the given @var{name}.
20290
20291 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
20292 string for the new class.
20293 @end defmethod
20294
20295 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
20296 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
20297 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
20298 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
20299 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
20300 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
20301 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
20302 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
20303
20304 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
20305 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
20306 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
20307 @end defmethod
20308
20309 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
20310 be implemented in Python:
20311
20312 @smallexample
20313 class Greet (gdb.Function):
20314 """Return string to greet someone.
20315 Takes a name as argument."""
20316
20317 def __init__ (self):
20318 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
20319
20320 def invoke (self, name):
20321 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
20322
20323 Greet ()
20324 @end smallexample
20325
20326 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
20327 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
20328 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
20329 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
20330
20331 @node Objfiles In Python
20332 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
20333
20334 @cindex objfiles in python
20335 @tindex gdb.Objfile
20336 @tindex Objfile
20337 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
20338 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
20339 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
20340 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
20341 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
20342
20343 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
20344 @code{gdb} module:
20345
20346 @findex gdb.current_objfile
20347 @defun current_objfile
20348 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
20349 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
20350 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
20351 this function returns @code{None}.
20352 @end defun
20353
20354 @findex gdb.objfiles
20355 @defun objfiles
20356 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
20357 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
20358 @end defun
20359
20360 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
20361 class.
20362
20363 @defivar Objfile filename
20364 The file name of the objfile as a string.
20365 @end defivar
20366
20367 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
20368 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
20369 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
20370 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
20371 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
20372 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing}, for more
20373 information.
20374 @end defivar
20375
20376 @node Frames In Python
20377 @subsubsection Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20378
20379 @cindex frames in python
20380 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
20381 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
20382 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
20383 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
20384 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
20385 exception.
20386
20387 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
20388 operator, like:
20389
20390 @smallexample
20391 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
20392 True
20393 @end smallexample
20394
20395 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
20396
20397 @findex gdb.selected_frame
20398 @defun selected_frame
20399 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
20400 @end defun
20401
20402 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
20403 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
20404 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
20405 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
20406 @end defun
20407
20408 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
20409
20410 @table @code
20411 @defmethod Frame is_valid
20412 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
20413 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
20414 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
20415 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
20416 @end defmethod
20417
20418 @defmethod Frame name
20419 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
20420 obtained.
20421 @end defmethod
20422
20423 @defmethod Frame type
20424 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
20425 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
20426 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
20427 @end defmethod
20428
20429 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
20430 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
20431 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
20432 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
20433 function to a string.
20434 @end defmethod
20435
20436 @defmethod Frame pc
20437 Returns the frame's resume address.
20438 @end defmethod
20439
20440 @defmethod Frame older
20441 Return the frame that called this frame.
20442 @end defmethod
20443
20444 @defmethod Frame newer
20445 Return the frame called by this frame.
20446 @end defmethod
20447
20448 @defmethod Frame read_var variable
20449 Return the value of the given variable in this frame. @var{variable} must
20450 be a string.
20451 @end defmethod
20452 @end table
20453
20454 @node Interpreters
20455 @chapter Command Interpreters
20456 @cindex command interpreters
20457
20458 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
20459 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
20460 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
20461
20462 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
20463 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
20464 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
20465 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
20466
20467 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
20468 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
20469 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
20470 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
20471
20472 @table @code
20473 @item console
20474 @cindex console interpreter
20475 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
20476 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
20477 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
20478
20479 @item mi
20480 @cindex mi interpreter
20481 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
20482 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
20483 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
20484 Interface}.
20485
20486 @item mi2
20487 @cindex mi2 interpreter
20488 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
20489
20490 @item mi1
20491 @cindex mi1 interpreter
20492 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
20493
20494 @end table
20495
20496 @cindex invoke another interpreter
20497 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
20498 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
20499 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
20500 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
20501 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
20502 the IDE inoperable!
20503
20504 @kindex interpreter-exec
20505 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
20506 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
20507 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
20508 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
20509
20510 @smallexample
20511 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
20512 @end smallexample
20513
20514 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
20515 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
20516
20517 @node TUI
20518 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
20519 @cindex TUI
20520 @cindex Text User Interface
20521
20522 @menu
20523 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
20524 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
20525 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
20526 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
20527 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
20528 @end menu
20529
20530 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
20531 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
20532 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
20533 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
20534 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
20535 is available.
20536
20537 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
20538 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
20539 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
20540 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
20541 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
20542 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
20543
20544 @node TUI Overview
20545 @section TUI Overview
20546
20547 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
20548
20549 @table @emph
20550 @item command
20551 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
20552 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
20553 managed using readline.
20554
20555 @item source
20556 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
20557 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
20558
20559 @item assembly
20560 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
20561
20562 @item register
20563 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
20564 when their values change.
20565 @end table
20566
20567 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
20568 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
20569 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
20570 indicates the breakpoint type:
20571
20572 @table @code
20573 @item B
20574 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
20575
20576 @item b
20577 Breakpoint which was never hit.
20578
20579 @item H
20580 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
20581
20582 @item h
20583 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
20584 @end table
20585
20586 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
20587
20588 @table @code
20589 @item +
20590 Breakpoint is enabled.
20591
20592 @item -
20593 Breakpoint is disabled.
20594 @end table
20595
20596 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
20597 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
20598 changes.
20599
20600 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
20601 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
20602 layouts:
20603
20604 @itemize @bullet
20605 @item
20606 source only,
20607
20608 @item
20609 assembly only,
20610
20611 @item
20612 source and assembly,
20613
20614 @item
20615 source and registers, or
20616
20617 @item
20618 assembly and registers.
20619 @end itemize
20620
20621 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
20622
20623 @table @emph
20624 @item target
20625 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
20626 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20627
20628 @item process
20629 Gives the current process or thread number.
20630 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
20631
20632 @item function
20633 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
20634 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
20635 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
20636 the string @code{??} is displayed.
20637
20638 @item line
20639 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
20640 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
20641
20642 @item pc
20643 Indicates the current program counter address.
20644 @end table
20645
20646 @node TUI Keys
20647 @section TUI Key Bindings
20648 @cindex TUI key bindings
20649
20650 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
20651 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
20652 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
20653
20654 @table @kbd
20655 @kindex C-x C-a
20656 @item C-x C-a
20657 @kindex C-x a
20658 @itemx C-x a
20659 @kindex C-x A
20660 @itemx C-x A
20661 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
20662 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
20663 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
20664 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
20665 The screen is then refreshed.
20666
20667 @kindex C-x 1
20668 @item C-x 1
20669 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
20670 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
20671 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
20672
20673 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
20674
20675 @kindex C-x 2
20676 @item C-x 2
20677 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
20678 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
20679 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
20680 previous layout and the new one.
20681
20682 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
20683
20684 @kindex C-x o
20685 @item C-x o
20686 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
20687 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
20688 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
20689
20690 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
20691
20692 @kindex C-x s
20693 @item C-x s
20694 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
20695 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
20696 @end table
20697
20698 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
20699
20700 @table @asis
20701 @kindex PgUp
20702 @item @key{PgUp}
20703 Scroll the active window one page up.
20704
20705 @kindex PgDn
20706 @item @key{PgDn}
20707 Scroll the active window one page down.
20708
20709 @kindex Up
20710 @item @key{Up}
20711 Scroll the active window one line up.
20712
20713 @kindex Down
20714 @item @key{Down}
20715 Scroll the active window one line down.
20716
20717 @kindex Left
20718 @item @key{Left}
20719 Scroll the active window one column left.
20720
20721 @kindex Right
20722 @item @key{Right}
20723 Scroll the active window one column right.
20724
20725 @kindex C-L
20726 @item @kbd{C-L}
20727 Refresh the screen.
20728 @end table
20729
20730 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
20731 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
20732 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
20733 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
20734 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
20735
20736 @node TUI Single Key Mode
20737 @section TUI Single Key Mode
20738 @cindex TUI single key mode
20739
20740 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
20741 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
20742 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
20743
20744 @table @kbd
20745 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20746 @item c
20747 continue
20748
20749 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20750 @item d
20751 down
20752
20753 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20754 @item f
20755 finish
20756
20757 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20758 @item n
20759 next
20760
20761 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20762 @item q
20763 exit the SingleKey mode.
20764
20765 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20766 @item r
20767 run
20768
20769 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20770 @item s
20771 step
20772
20773 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20774 @item u
20775 up
20776
20777 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20778 @item v
20779 info locals
20780
20781 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20782 @item w
20783 where
20784 @end table
20785
20786 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
20787 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
20788 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
20789 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
20790 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
20791 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
20792
20793
20794 @node TUI Commands
20795 @section TUI-specific Commands
20796 @cindex TUI commands
20797
20798 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
20799 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
20800 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
20801 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
20802
20803 @table @code
20804 @item info win
20805 @kindex info win
20806 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
20807
20808 @item layout next
20809 @kindex layout
20810 Display the next layout.
20811
20812 @item layout prev
20813 Display the previous layout.
20814
20815 @item layout src
20816 Display the source window only.
20817
20818 @item layout asm
20819 Display the assembly window only.
20820
20821 @item layout split
20822 Display the source and assembly window.
20823
20824 @item layout regs
20825 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
20826
20827 @item focus next
20828 @kindex focus
20829 Make the next window active for scrolling.
20830
20831 @item focus prev
20832 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
20833
20834 @item focus src
20835 Make the source window active for scrolling.
20836
20837 @item focus asm
20838 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
20839
20840 @item focus regs
20841 Make the register window active for scrolling.
20842
20843 @item focus cmd
20844 Make the command window active for scrolling.
20845
20846 @item refresh
20847 @kindex refresh
20848 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
20849
20850 @item tui reg float
20851 @kindex tui reg
20852 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
20853
20854 @item tui reg general
20855 Show the general registers in the register window.
20856
20857 @item tui reg next
20858 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
20859 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
20860 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
20861 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
20862
20863 @item tui reg system
20864 Show the system registers in the register window.
20865
20866 @item update
20867 @kindex update
20868 Update the source window and the current execution point.
20869
20870 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
20871 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
20872 @kindex winheight
20873 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
20874 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
20875 decrease it.
20876
20877 @item tabset @var{nchars}
20878 @kindex tabset
20879 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
20880 @end table
20881
20882 @node TUI Configuration
20883 @section TUI Configuration Variables
20884 @cindex TUI configuration variables
20885
20886 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
20887
20888 @table @code
20889 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
20890 @kindex set tui border-kind
20891 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
20892 The possible values are the following:
20893 @table @code
20894 @item space
20895 Use a space character to draw the border.
20896
20897 @item ascii
20898 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
20899
20900 @item acs
20901 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
20902 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
20903 @end table
20904
20905 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
20906 @kindex set tui border-mode
20907 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
20908 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
20909 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
20910 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
20911 @table @code
20912 @item normal
20913 Use normal attributes to display the border.
20914
20915 @item standout
20916 Use standout mode.
20917
20918 @item reverse
20919 Use reverse video mode.
20920
20921 @item half
20922 Use half bright mode.
20923
20924 @item half-standout
20925 Use half bright and standout mode.
20926
20927 @item bold
20928 Use extra bright or bold mode.
20929
20930 @item bold-standout
20931 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
20932 @end table
20933 @end table
20934
20935 @node Emacs
20936 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
20937
20938 @cindex Emacs
20939 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
20940 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
20941 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
20942 @value{GDBN}.
20943
20944 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
20945 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
20946 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
20947 created Emacs buffer.
20948 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
20949
20950 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
20951 things:
20952
20953 @itemize @bullet
20954 @item
20955 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
20956 the GUD buffer.
20957
20958 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
20959 and output done by the program you are debugging.
20960
20961 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
20962 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
20963 in this way.
20964
20965 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
20966 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
20967 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
20968 stop.
20969
20970 @item
20971 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
20972
20973 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
20974 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
20975 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
20976 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
20977 and the source.
20978
20979 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
20980 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
20981 @end itemize
20982
20983 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
20984 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
20985 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
20986 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
20987
20988 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
20989 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
20990 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
20991 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
20992 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
20993 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
20994 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
20995 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
20996 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
20997
20998 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
20999 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
21000 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
21001 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
21002
21003 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
21004 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
21005 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
21006 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
21007 one you want.
21008
21009 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
21010 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
21011
21012 @table @kbd
21013 @item C-h m
21014 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
21015
21016 @item C-c C-s
21017 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
21018 update the display window to show the current file and location.
21019
21020 @item C-c C-n
21021 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
21022 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
21023 to show the current file and location.
21024
21025 @item C-c C-i
21026 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
21027 display window accordingly.
21028
21029 @item C-c C-f
21030 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
21031 @code{finish} command.
21032
21033 @item C-c C-r
21034 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
21035 command.
21036
21037 @item C-c <
21038 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
21039 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
21040 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
21041
21042 @item C-c >
21043 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
21044 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
21045 @end table
21046
21047 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
21048 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
21049
21050 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
21051 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
21052 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
21053 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
21054 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
21055 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
21056 speedbar displays watch expressions.
21057
21058 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
21059 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
21060 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
21061 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
21062 frame.
21063
21064 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
21065 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
21066 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
21067 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
21068 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
21069 to correspond properly with the code.
21070
21071 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
21072 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
21073 Emacs Manual}).
21074
21075 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
21076 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
21077 @ignore
21078 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
21079 @kindex Epoch
21080 @kindex inspect
21081
21082 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
21083 called the @code{epoch}
21084 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
21085 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
21086 each value is printed in its own window.
21087 @end ignore
21088
21089
21090 @node GDB/MI
21091 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
21092
21093 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
21094
21095 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
21096 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
21097 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
21098 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
21099 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
21100 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
21101
21102 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
21103 in the form of a reference manual.
21104
21105 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
21106 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
21107 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
21108
21109 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
21110
21111 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
21112 This chapter uses the following notation:
21113
21114 @itemize @bullet
21115 @item
21116 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
21117
21118 @item
21119 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
21120 it may or may not be given.
21121
21122 @item
21123 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
21124 may repeat zero or more times.
21125
21126 @item
21127 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
21128 may repeat one or more times.
21129
21130 @item
21131 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
21132 @end itemize
21133
21134 @ignore
21135 @heading Dependencies
21136 @end ignore
21137
21138 @menu
21139 * GDB/MI General Design::
21140 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
21141 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
21142 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
21143 * GDB/MI Output Records::
21144 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
21145 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
21146 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
21147 * GDB/MI Program Context::
21148 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
21149 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
21150 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
21151 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
21152 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
21153 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
21154 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
21155 * GDB/MI File Commands::
21156 @ignore
21157 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
21158 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
21159 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
21160 @end ignore
21161 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
21162 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
21163 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
21164 @end menu
21165
21166 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21167 @node GDB/MI General Design
21168 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
21169 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
21170
21171 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
21172 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
21173 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
21174 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
21175 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
21176 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
21177 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
21178 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
21179 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
21180 a command and reported as part of that command response.
21181
21182 The important examples of notifications are:
21183 @itemize @bullet
21184
21185 @item
21186 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
21187 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
21188 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
21189 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
21190 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
21191 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
21192 command itself was successfully executed.
21193
21194 @item
21195 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
21196 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
21197 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
21198 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
21199 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
21200 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
21201
21202 @item
21203 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
21204 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
21205 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
21206 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
21207 orthogonal frontend design.
21208
21209 @end itemize
21210
21211 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
21212 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
21213 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
21214 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
21215 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
21216 the user interface.
21217
21218
21219 @menu
21220 * Context management::
21221 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
21222 * Thread groups::
21223 @end menu
21224
21225 @node Context management
21226 @subsection Context management
21227
21228 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
21229 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
21230 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
21231 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
21232 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
21233 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
21234 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
21235 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
21236 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
21237
21238 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
21239 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
21240 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
21241 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
21242 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
21243 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
21244 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
21245 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
21246 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
21247 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
21248 for thread and frame to operate on.
21249
21250 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
21251 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
21252 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
21253 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
21254 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
21255 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
21256 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
21257 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
21258 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
21259 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
21260
21261 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
21262 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
21263 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
21264 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
21265 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
21266 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
21267 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
21268 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
21269 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
21270 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
21271 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
21272 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
21273 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
21274 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
21275 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
21276 @samp{--frame} options.
21277
21278 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
21279 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
21280
21281 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
21282 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
21283 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
21284 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
21285 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
21286 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
21287 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
21288 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
21289 @code{-list-target-features} command.
21290
21291 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
21292 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
21293 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
21294 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
21295 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
21296 are running.
21297
21298 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
21299 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
21300 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
21301 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
21302 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
21303 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
21304 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
21305 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
21306 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
21307 @samp{--thread} option).
21308
21309 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
21310 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
21311 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
21312 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
21313
21314 @node Thread groups
21315 @subsection Thread groups
21316 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
21317 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
21318 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
21319 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
21320 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
21321
21322 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
21323 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
21324 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
21325 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
21326 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
21327 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
21328 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
21329 into processes.
21330
21331 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
21332 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
21333 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
21334 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
21335 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
21336 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
21337 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
21338 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
21339 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
21340 the members of specific thread group.
21341
21342 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
21343 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
21344 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
21345 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
21346 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
21347 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
21348 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
21349 after attaching to that thread group.
21350
21351 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21352 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
21353 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
21354
21355 @menu
21356 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
21357 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
21358 @end menu
21359
21360 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
21361 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
21362
21363 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
21364 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
21365 @table @code
21366 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
21367 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
21368
21369 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
21370 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
21371 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
21372
21373 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
21374 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
21375 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
21376
21377 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
21378 "any sequence of digits"
21379
21380 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
21381 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
21382
21383 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
21384 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
21385
21386 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
21387 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
21388
21389 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
21390 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
21391 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
21392
21393 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
21394 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
21395
21396 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
21397 @code{CR | CR-LF}
21398 @end table
21399
21400 @noindent
21401 Notes:
21402
21403 @itemize @bullet
21404 @item
21405 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
21406 output is described below.
21407
21408 @item
21409 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
21410 finishes.
21411
21412 @item
21413 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
21414 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
21415 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
21416 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
21417 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
21418 @end itemize
21419
21420 Pragmatics:
21421
21422 @itemize @bullet
21423 @item
21424 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
21425
21426 @item
21427 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
21428 @end itemize
21429
21430 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
21431 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
21432
21433 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
21434 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
21435 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
21436 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
21437 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
21438 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
21439
21440 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
21441 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
21442 @var{token}.
21443
21444 @table @code
21445 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
21446 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
21447
21448 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
21449 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
21450
21451 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
21452 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
21453
21454 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
21455 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
21456
21457 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
21458 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
21459
21460 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
21461 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
21462
21463 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
21464 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
21465
21466 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
21467 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
21468
21469 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
21470 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
21471
21472 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
21473 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
21474 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
21475
21476 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
21477 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
21478
21479 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
21480 @code{ @var{string} }
21481
21482 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
21483 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
21484
21485 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
21486 @code{@var{c-string}}
21487
21488 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
21489 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
21490
21491 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
21492 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
21493 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
21494
21495 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
21496 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
21497
21498 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
21499 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
21500
21501 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
21502 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
21503
21504 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
21505 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
21506
21507 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
21508 @code{CR | CR-LF}
21509
21510 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
21511 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
21512 @end table
21513
21514 @noindent
21515 Notes:
21516
21517 @itemize @bullet
21518 @item
21519 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
21520
21521 @item
21522 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
21523 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
21524 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
21525 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
21526 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
21527 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
21528 prior command.
21529
21530 @item
21531 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21532 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
21533 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
21534 prefixed by @samp{+}.
21535
21536 @item
21537 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21538 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
21539 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
21540 @samp{*}.
21541
21542 @item
21543 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21544 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
21545 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
21546 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
21547
21548 @item
21549 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21550 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
21551 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
21552 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
21553
21554 @item
21555 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21556 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
21557 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
21558
21559 @item
21560 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21561 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
21562 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
21563 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
21564
21565 @item
21566 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21567 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
21568 @var{values}.
21569
21570
21571 @end itemize
21572
21573 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
21574 details about the various output records.
21575
21576 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21577 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
21578 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
21579
21580 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
21581 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
21582
21583 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
21584 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
21585 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
21586 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
21587 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
21588 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
21589
21590 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
21591 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
21592 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
21593
21594 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21595 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
21596 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
21597 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
21598
21599 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
21600 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
21601
21602 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
21603 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
21604 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
21605 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
21606 might change.
21607
21608 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
21609 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
21610 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
21611 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
21612
21613 @itemize @bullet
21614 @item
21615 New MI commands may be added.
21616
21617 @item
21618 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
21619
21620 @item
21621 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
21622 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
21623
21624 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
21625 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
21626
21627 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
21628 @c resolve inconsistencies.
21629 @end itemize
21630
21631 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
21632 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
21633 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
21634 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
21635 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
21636
21637 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
21638 @c version?
21639
21640 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
21641 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
21642 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
21643 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
21644 @cindex mailing lists
21645
21646 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21647 @node GDB/MI Output Records
21648 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
21649
21650 @menu
21651 * GDB/MI Result Records::
21652 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
21653 * GDB/MI Async Records::
21654 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
21655 @end menu
21656
21657 @node GDB/MI Result Records
21658 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
21659
21660 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21661 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
21662 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
21663 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
21664
21665 @table @code
21666 @findex ^done
21667 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
21668 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
21669 values.
21670
21671 @item "^running"
21672 @findex ^running
21673 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
21674 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
21675 running.
21676
21677 @item "^connected"
21678 @findex ^connected
21679 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
21680
21681 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
21682 @findex ^error
21683 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
21684 error message.
21685
21686 @item "^exit"
21687 @findex ^exit
21688 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
21689
21690 @end table
21691
21692 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
21693 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
21694
21695 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
21696 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21697 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
21698 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
21699 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
21700
21701 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
21702 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
21703 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
21704 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
21705 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
21706
21707 @table @code
21708 @item "~" @var{string-output}
21709 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
21710 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
21711
21712 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
21713 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
21714 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
21715 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
21716
21717 @item "&" @var{string-output}
21718 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
21719 internals.
21720 @end table
21721
21722 @node GDB/MI Async Records
21723 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
21724
21725 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21726 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
21727 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
21728 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
21729 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
21730 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
21731
21732 The following is the list of possible async records:
21733
21734 @table @code
21735
21736 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
21737 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
21738 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
21739 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
21740 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
21741 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
21742 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
21743 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
21744 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
21745 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
21746
21747 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
21748 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
21749 following values:
21750
21751 @table @code
21752 @item breakpoint-hit
21753 A breakpoint was reached.
21754 @item watchpoint-trigger
21755 A watchpoint was triggered.
21756 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
21757 A read watchpoint was triggered.
21758 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
21759 An access watchpoint was triggered.
21760 @item function-finished
21761 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
21762 @item location-reached
21763 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
21764 @item watchpoint-scope
21765 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
21766 @item end-stepping-range
21767 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
21768 similar CLI command was accomplished.
21769 @item exited-signalled
21770 The inferior exited because of a signal.
21771 @item exited
21772 The inferior exited.
21773 @item exited-normally
21774 The inferior exited normally.
21775 @item signal-received
21776 A signal was received by the inferior.
21777 @end table
21778
21779 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
21780 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
21781 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
21782 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
21783 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
21784 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
21785 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
21786 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
21787 several threads in the list.
21788
21789 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
21790 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
21791 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
21792 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
21793 thread group.
21794
21795 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
21796 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
21797 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
21798 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
21799 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
21800
21801 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
21802 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
21803 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
21804 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
21805 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
21806 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
21807 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
21808
21809 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
21810 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
21811 that thread.
21812
21813 @item =library-loaded,...
21814 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
21815 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
21816 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
21817 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
21818 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
21819 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
21820 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
21821 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
21822 library are loaded.
21823
21824 @item =library-unloaded,...
21825 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
21826 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
21827 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
21828
21829 @end table
21830
21831 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
21832 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
21833
21834 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
21835 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
21836 fields:
21837
21838 @table @code
21839 @item level
21840 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
21841 zero. This field is always present.
21842
21843 @item func
21844 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
21845 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
21846
21847 @item addr
21848 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
21849
21850 @item file
21851 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
21852 address. This field may be absent.
21853
21854 @item line
21855 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
21856 may be absent.
21857
21858 @item from
21859 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
21860 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
21861
21862 @end table
21863
21864
21865 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21866 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
21867 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
21868 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
21869
21870 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
21871 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
21872 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
21873 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
21874
21875 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
21876 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
21877
21878 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
21879
21880 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
21881 information of the breakpoint.
21882
21883 @smallexample
21884 -> -break-insert main
21885 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
21886 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21887 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
21888 <- (gdb)
21889 @end smallexample
21890
21891 @subheading Program Execution
21892
21893 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
21894 reason that execution stopped.
21895
21896 @smallexample
21897 -> -exec-run
21898 <- ^running
21899 <- (gdb)
21900 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21901 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
21902 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
21903 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
21904 <- (gdb)
21905 -> -exec-continue
21906 <- ^running
21907 <- (gdb)
21908 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
21909 <- (gdb)
21910 @end smallexample
21911
21912 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
21913
21914 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
21915
21916 @smallexample
21917 -> (gdb)
21918 <- -gdb-exit
21919 <- ^exit
21920 @end smallexample
21921
21922 @subheading A Bad Command
21923
21924 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
21925
21926 @smallexample
21927 -> -rubbish
21928 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
21929 <- (gdb)
21930 @end smallexample
21931
21932
21933 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21934 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
21935 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
21936
21937 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
21938 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
21939
21940 @subheading Motivation
21941
21942 The motivation for this collection of commands.
21943
21944 @subheading Introduction
21945
21946 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
21947
21948 @subheading Commands
21949
21950 For each command in the block, the following is described:
21951
21952 @subsubheading Synopsis
21953
21954 @smallexample
21955 -command @var{args}@dots{}
21956 @end smallexample
21957
21958 @subsubheading Result
21959
21960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21961
21962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
21963
21964 @subsubheading Example
21965
21966 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
21967 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
21968
21969
21970 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21971 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
21972 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
21973
21974 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
21975 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
21976 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
21977 breakpoints.
21978
21979 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
21980 @findex -break-after
21981
21982 @subsubheading Synopsis
21983
21984 @smallexample
21985 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
21986 @end smallexample
21987
21988 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
21989 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
21990 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
21991 @samp{-break-list} command below.
21992
21993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21994
21995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
21996
21997 @subsubheading Example
21998
21999 @smallexample
22000 (gdb)
22001 -break-insert main
22002 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
22003 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
22004 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
22005 (gdb)
22006 -break-after 1 3
22007 ~
22008 ^done
22009 (gdb)
22010 -break-list
22011 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22012 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22013 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22014 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22015 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22016 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22017 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22018 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22019 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22020 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
22021 (gdb)
22022 @end smallexample
22023
22024 @ignore
22025 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
22026 @findex -break-catch
22027 @end ignore
22028
22029 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
22030 @findex -break-commands
22031
22032 @subsubheading Synopsis
22033
22034 @smallexample
22035 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
22036 @end smallexample
22037
22038 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
22039 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
22040 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
22041 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
22042 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
22043 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
22044
22045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22046
22047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
22048
22049 @subsubheading Example
22050
22051 @smallexample
22052 (gdb)
22053 -break-insert main
22054 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
22055 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
22056 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
22057 (gdb)
22058 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
22059 ^done
22060 (gdb)
22061 @end smallexample
22062
22063 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
22064 @findex -break-condition
22065
22066 @subsubheading Synopsis
22067
22068 @smallexample
22069 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
22073 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
22074 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
22075 command below).
22076
22077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22078
22079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
22080
22081 @subsubheading Example
22082
22083 @smallexample
22084 (gdb)
22085 -break-condition 1 1
22086 ^done
22087 (gdb)
22088 -break-list
22089 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22090 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22091 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22092 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22093 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22094 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22095 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22096 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22097 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22098 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
22099 (gdb)
22100 @end smallexample
22101
22102 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
22103 @findex -break-delete
22104
22105 @subsubheading Synopsis
22106
22107 @smallexample
22108 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
22109 @end smallexample
22110
22111 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
22112 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
22113
22114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22115
22116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
22117
22118 @subsubheading Example
22119
22120 @smallexample
22121 (gdb)
22122 -break-delete 1
22123 ^done
22124 (gdb)
22125 -break-list
22126 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
22127 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22128 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22129 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22130 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22131 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22132 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22133 body=[]@}
22134 (gdb)
22135 @end smallexample
22136
22137 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
22138 @findex -break-disable
22139
22140 @subsubheading Synopsis
22141
22142 @smallexample
22143 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
22144 @end smallexample
22145
22146 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
22147 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
22148
22149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22150
22151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
22152
22153 @subsubheading Example
22154
22155 @smallexample
22156 (gdb)
22157 -break-disable 2
22158 ^done
22159 (gdb)
22160 -break-list
22161 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22162 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22163 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22164 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22165 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22166 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22167 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22168 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
22169 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22170 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
22171 (gdb)
22172 @end smallexample
22173
22174 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
22175 @findex -break-enable
22176
22177 @subsubheading Synopsis
22178
22179 @smallexample
22180 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
22181 @end smallexample
22182
22183 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
22184
22185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22186
22187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
22188
22189 @subsubheading Example
22190
22191 @smallexample
22192 (gdb)
22193 -break-enable 2
22194 ^done
22195 (gdb)
22196 -break-list
22197 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22198 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22199 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22200 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22201 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22202 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22203 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22204 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22205 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22206 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
22207 (gdb)
22208 @end smallexample
22209
22210 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
22211 @findex -break-info
22212
22213 @subsubheading Synopsis
22214
22215 @smallexample
22216 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
22217 @end smallexample
22218
22219 @c REDUNDANT???
22220 Get information about a single breakpoint.
22221
22222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22223
22224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
22225
22226 @subsubheading Example
22227 N.A.
22228
22229 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
22230 @findex -break-insert
22231
22232 @subsubheading Synopsis
22233
22234 @smallexample
22235 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
22236 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
22237 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
22238 @end smallexample
22239
22240 @noindent
22241 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
22242
22243 @itemize @bullet
22244 @item function
22245 @c @item +offset
22246 @c @item -offset
22247 @c @item linenum
22248 @item filename:linenum
22249 @item filename:function
22250 @item *address
22251 @end itemize
22252
22253 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
22254
22255 @table @samp
22256 @item -t
22257 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
22258 @item -h
22259 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
22260 @item -c @var{condition}
22261 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
22262 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
22263 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
22264 @item -f
22265 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
22266 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
22267 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
22268 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
22269 cannot be parsed.
22270 @item -d
22271 Create a disabled breakpoint.
22272 @end table
22273
22274 @subsubheading Result
22275
22276 The result is in the form:
22277
22278 @smallexample
22279 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
22280 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
22281 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
22282 times="@var{times}"@}
22283 @end smallexample
22284
22285 @noindent
22286 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
22287 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
22288 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
22289 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
22290 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
22291 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
22292 which use the same output).
22293
22294 Note: this format is open to change.
22295 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
22296
22297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22298
22299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
22300 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
22301
22302 @subsubheading Example
22303
22304 @smallexample
22305 (gdb)
22306 -break-insert main
22307 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
22308 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
22309 (gdb)
22310 -break-insert -t foo
22311 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
22312 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
22313 (gdb)
22314 -break-list
22315 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22316 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22317 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22318 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22319 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22320 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22321 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22322 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22323 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
22324 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
22325 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
22326 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
22327 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
22328 (gdb)
22329 -break-insert -r foo.*
22330 ~int foo(int, int);
22331 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
22332 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
22333 (gdb)
22334 @end smallexample
22335
22336 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
22337 @findex -break-list
22338
22339 @subsubheading Synopsis
22340
22341 @smallexample
22342 -break-list
22343 @end smallexample
22344
22345 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
22346
22347 @table @samp
22348 @item Number
22349 number of the breakpoint
22350 @item Type
22351 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
22352 @item Disposition
22353 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
22354 or @samp{nokeep}
22355 @item Enabled
22356 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
22357 @item Address
22358 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
22359 @item What
22360 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
22361 name, line number
22362 @item Times
22363 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
22364 @end table
22365
22366 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
22367 @code{body} field is an empty list.
22368
22369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22370
22371 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
22372
22373 @subsubheading Example
22374
22375 @smallexample
22376 (gdb)
22377 -break-list
22378 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22379 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22380 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22381 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22382 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22383 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22384 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22385 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22386 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
22387 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22388 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
22389 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
22390 (gdb)
22391 @end smallexample
22392
22393 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
22394
22395 @smallexample
22396 (gdb)
22397 -break-list
22398 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
22399 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22400 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22401 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22402 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22403 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22404 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22405 body=[]@}
22406 (gdb)
22407 @end smallexample
22408
22409 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
22410 @findex -break-watch
22411
22412 @subsubheading Synopsis
22413
22414 @smallexample
22415 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
22416 @end smallexample
22417
22418 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
22419 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
22420 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
22421 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
22422 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
22423 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
22424 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
22425 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
22426
22427 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
22428 breakpoints inserted.
22429
22430 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22431
22432 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
22433 @samp{rwatch}.
22434
22435 @subsubheading Example
22436
22437 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
22438
22439 @smallexample
22440 (gdb)
22441 -break-watch x
22442 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
22443 (gdb)
22444 -exec-continue
22445 ^running
22446 (gdb)
22447 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
22448 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
22449 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
22450 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
22451 (gdb)
22452 @end smallexample
22453
22454 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
22455 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
22456 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
22457
22458 @smallexample
22459 (gdb)
22460 -break-watch C
22461 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
22462 (gdb)
22463 -exec-continue
22464 ^running
22465 (gdb)
22466 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
22467 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
22468 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
22469 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22470 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
22471 (gdb)
22472 -exec-continue
22473 ^running
22474 (gdb)
22475 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
22476 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
22477 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
22478 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22479 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
22480 (gdb)
22481 @end smallexample
22482
22483 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
22484 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
22485 deleted.
22486
22487 @smallexample
22488 (gdb)
22489 -break-watch C
22490 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
22491 (gdb)
22492 -break-list
22493 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22494 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22495 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22496 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22497 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22498 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22499 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22500 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22501 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22502 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22503 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
22504 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
22505 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
22506 (gdb)
22507 -exec-continue
22508 ^running
22509 (gdb)
22510 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
22511 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
22512 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
22513 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22514 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
22515 (gdb)
22516 -break-list
22517 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22518 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22519 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22520 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22521 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22522 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22523 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22524 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22525 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22526 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22527 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
22528 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
22529 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
22530 (gdb)
22531 -exec-continue
22532 ^running
22533 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
22534 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
22535 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
22536 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22537 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
22538 (gdb)
22539 -break-list
22540 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22541 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22542 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22543 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22544 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22545 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22546 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22547 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22548 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22549 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22550 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
22551 times="1"@}]@}
22552 (gdb)
22553 @end smallexample
22554
22555 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22556 @node GDB/MI Program Context
22557 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
22558
22559 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
22560 @findex -exec-arguments
22561
22562
22563 @subsubheading Synopsis
22564
22565 @smallexample
22566 -exec-arguments @var{args}
22567 @end smallexample
22568
22569 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
22570 @samp{-exec-run}.
22571
22572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22573
22574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
22575
22576 @subsubheading Example
22577
22578 @smallexample
22579 (gdb)
22580 -exec-arguments -v word
22581 ^done
22582 (gdb)
22583 @end smallexample
22584
22585
22586 @ignore
22587 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
22588 @findex -exec-show-arguments
22589
22590 @subsubheading Synopsis
22591
22592 @smallexample
22593 -exec-show-arguments
22594 @end smallexample
22595
22596 Print the arguments of the program.
22597
22598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22599
22600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
22601
22602 @subsubheading Example
22603 N.A.
22604 @end ignore
22605
22606
22607 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
22608 @findex -environment-cd
22609
22610 @subsubheading Synopsis
22611
22612 @smallexample
22613 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
22614 @end smallexample
22615
22616 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
22617
22618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22619
22620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
22621
22622 @subsubheading Example
22623
22624 @smallexample
22625 (gdb)
22626 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
22627 ^done
22628 (gdb)
22629 @end smallexample
22630
22631
22632 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
22633 @findex -environment-directory
22634
22635 @subsubheading Synopsis
22636
22637 @smallexample
22638 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
22639 @end smallexample
22640
22641 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
22642 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
22643 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
22644 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
22645 occurs as normal.
22646 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
22647 multiple directories in a single command
22648 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
22649 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
22650 If blanks are needed as
22651 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
22652 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
22653 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
22654 character must not be used
22655 in any directory name.
22656 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
22657
22658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22659
22660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
22661
22662 @subsubheading Example
22663
22664 @smallexample
22665 (gdb)
22666 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
22667 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
22668 (gdb)
22669 -environment-directory ""
22670 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
22671 (gdb)
22672 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
22673 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
22674 (gdb)
22675 -environment-directory -r
22676 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
22677 (gdb)
22678 @end smallexample
22679
22680
22681 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
22682 @findex -environment-path
22683
22684 @subsubheading Synopsis
22685
22686 @smallexample
22687 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
22688 @end smallexample
22689
22690 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
22691 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
22692 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
22693 supplied in addition to the
22694 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
22695 occurs as normal.
22696 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
22697 multiple directories in a single command
22698 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
22699 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
22700 If blanks are needed as
22701 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
22702 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
22703 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
22704 character must not be used
22705 in any directory name.
22706 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
22707
22708
22709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22710
22711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
22712
22713 @subsubheading Example
22714
22715 @smallexample
22716 (gdb)
22717 -environment-path
22718 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
22719 (gdb)
22720 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
22721 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
22722 (gdb)
22723 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
22724 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
22725 (gdb)
22726 @end smallexample
22727
22728
22729 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
22730 @findex -environment-pwd
22731
22732 @subsubheading Synopsis
22733
22734 @smallexample
22735 -environment-pwd
22736 @end smallexample
22737
22738 Show the current working directory.
22739
22740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22741
22742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
22743
22744 @subsubheading Example
22745
22746 @smallexample
22747 (gdb)
22748 -environment-pwd
22749 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
22750 (gdb)
22751 @end smallexample
22752
22753 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22754 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
22755 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
22756
22757
22758 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
22759 @findex -thread-info
22760
22761 @subsubheading Synopsis
22762
22763 @smallexample
22764 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
22765 @end smallexample
22766
22767 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
22768 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
22769 threads. When printing information about all threads,
22770 also reports the current thread.
22771
22772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22773
22774 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
22775 about all threads.
22776
22777 @subsubheading Example
22778
22779 @smallexample
22780 -thread-info
22781 ^done,threads=[
22782 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
22783 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
22784 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
22785 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
22786 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
22787 current-thread-id="1"
22788 (gdb)
22789 @end smallexample
22790
22791 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
22792
22793 @table @code
22794 @item stopped
22795 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
22796 threads.
22797
22798 @item running
22799 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
22800 threads.
22801
22802 @end table
22803
22804 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
22805 @findex -thread-list-ids
22806
22807 @subsubheading Synopsis
22808
22809 @smallexample
22810 -thread-list-ids
22811 @end smallexample
22812
22813 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
22814 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
22815
22816 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
22817 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
22818
22819 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22820
22821 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
22822
22823 @subsubheading Example
22824
22825 @smallexample
22826 (gdb)
22827 -thread-list-ids
22828 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
22829 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
22830 (gdb)
22831 @end smallexample
22832
22833
22834 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
22835 @findex -thread-select
22836
22837 @subsubheading Synopsis
22838
22839 @smallexample
22840 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
22841 @end smallexample
22842
22843 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
22844 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
22845
22846 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
22847 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
22848
22849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22850
22851 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
22852
22853 @subsubheading Example
22854
22855 @smallexample
22856 (gdb)
22857 -exec-next
22858 ^running
22859 (gdb)
22860 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
22861 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
22862 (gdb)
22863 -thread-list-ids
22864 ^done,
22865 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
22866 number-of-threads="3"
22867 (gdb)
22868 -thread-select 3
22869 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
22870 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
22871 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
22872 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
22873 (gdb)
22874 @end smallexample
22875
22876 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22877 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
22878 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
22879
22880 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
22881 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
22882 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
22883 other cases.
22884
22885 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
22886 @findex -exec-continue
22887
22888 @subsubheading Synopsis
22889
22890 @smallexample
22891 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
22892 @end smallexample
22893
22894 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
22895 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
22896 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
22897 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
22898 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
22899 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
22900 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
22901 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
22902 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
22903 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
22904 thread group are resumed.
22905
22906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22907
22908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
22909
22910 @subsubheading Example
22911
22912 @smallexample
22913 -exec-continue
22914 ^running
22915 (gdb)
22916 @@Hello world
22917 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
22918 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
22919 line="13"@}
22920 (gdb)
22921 @end smallexample
22922
22923
22924 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
22925 @findex -exec-finish
22926
22927 @subsubheading Synopsis
22928
22929 @smallexample
22930 -exec-finish
22931 @end smallexample
22932
22933 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
22934 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
22935
22936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22937
22938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
22939
22940 @subsubheading Example
22941
22942 Function returning @code{void}.
22943
22944 @smallexample
22945 -exec-finish
22946 ^running
22947 (gdb)
22948 @@hello from foo
22949 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
22950 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
22951 (gdb)
22952 @end smallexample
22953
22954 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
22955 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
22956 value itself.
22957
22958 @smallexample
22959 -exec-finish
22960 ^running
22961 (gdb)
22962 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
22963 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
22964 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22965 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
22966 (gdb)
22967 @end smallexample
22968
22969
22970 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
22971 @findex -exec-interrupt
22972
22973 @subsubheading Synopsis
22974
22975 @smallexample
22976 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
22977 @end smallexample
22978
22979 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
22980 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
22981 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
22982 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
22983 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
22984
22985 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
22986 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
22987 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
22988 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
22989
22990 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
22991 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
22992 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
22993 threads in that group will be interrupted.
22994
22995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22996
22997 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
22998
22999 @subsubheading Example
23000
23001 @smallexample
23002 (gdb)
23003 111-exec-continue
23004 111^running
23005
23006 (gdb)
23007 222-exec-interrupt
23008 222^done
23009 (gdb)
23010 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
23011 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
23012 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
23013 (gdb)
23014
23015 (gdb)
23016 -exec-interrupt
23017 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
23018 (gdb)
23019 @end smallexample
23020
23021 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
23022 @findex -exec-jump
23023
23024 @subsubheading Synopsis
23025
23026 @smallexample
23027 -exec-jump @var{location}
23028 @end smallexample
23029
23030 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
23031 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
23032 different forms of @var{location}.
23033
23034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23035
23036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
23037
23038 @subsubheading Example
23039
23040 @smallexample
23041 -exec-jump foo.c:10
23042 *running,thread-id="all"
23043 ^running
23044 @end smallexample
23045
23046
23047 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
23048 @findex -exec-next
23049
23050 @subsubheading Synopsis
23051
23052 @smallexample
23053 -exec-next
23054 @end smallexample
23055
23056 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
23057 of the next source line is reached.
23058
23059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23060
23061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
23062
23063 @subsubheading Example
23064
23065 @smallexample
23066 -exec-next
23067 ^running
23068 (gdb)
23069 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
23070 (gdb)
23071 @end smallexample
23072
23073
23074 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
23075 @findex -exec-next-instruction
23076
23077 @subsubheading Synopsis
23078
23079 @smallexample
23080 -exec-next-instruction
23081 @end smallexample
23082
23083 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
23084 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
23085 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
23086 printed as well.
23087
23088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23089
23090 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
23091
23092 @subsubheading Example
23093
23094 @smallexample
23095 (gdb)
23096 -exec-next-instruction
23097 ^running
23098
23099 (gdb)
23100 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23101 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
23102 (gdb)
23103 @end smallexample
23104
23105
23106 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
23107 @findex -exec-return
23108
23109 @subsubheading Synopsis
23110
23111 @smallexample
23112 -exec-return
23113 @end smallexample
23114
23115 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
23116 Displays the new current frame.
23117
23118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23119
23120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
23121
23122 @subsubheading Example
23123
23124 @smallexample
23125 (gdb)
23126 200-break-insert callee4
23127 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
23128 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
23129 (gdb)
23130 000-exec-run
23131 000^running
23132 (gdb)
23133 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
23134 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
23135 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23136 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
23137 (gdb)
23138 205-break-delete
23139 205^done
23140 (gdb)
23141 111-exec-return
23142 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
23143 args=[@{name="strarg",
23144 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
23145 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23146 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
23147 (gdb)
23148 @end smallexample
23149
23150
23151 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
23152 @findex -exec-run
23153
23154 @subsubheading Synopsis
23155
23156 @smallexample
23157 -exec-run
23158 @end smallexample
23159
23160 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
23161 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
23162 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
23163 the program has exited exceptionally.
23164
23165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23166
23167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
23168
23169 @subsubheading Examples
23170
23171 @smallexample
23172 (gdb)
23173 -break-insert main
23174 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
23175 (gdb)
23176 -exec-run
23177 ^running
23178 (gdb)
23179 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
23180 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
23181 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
23182 (gdb)
23183 @end smallexample
23184
23185 @noindent
23186 Program exited normally:
23187
23188 @smallexample
23189 (gdb)
23190 -exec-run
23191 ^running
23192 (gdb)
23193 x = 55
23194 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
23195 (gdb)
23196 @end smallexample
23197
23198 @noindent
23199 Program exited exceptionally:
23200
23201 @smallexample
23202 (gdb)
23203 -exec-run
23204 ^running
23205 (gdb)
23206 x = 55
23207 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
23208 (gdb)
23209 @end smallexample
23210
23211 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
23212 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
23213
23214 @smallexample
23215 (gdb)
23216 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
23217 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
23218 @end smallexample
23219
23220
23221 @c @subheading -exec-signal
23222
23223
23224 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
23225 @findex -exec-step
23226
23227 @subsubheading Synopsis
23228
23229 @smallexample
23230 -exec-step
23231 @end smallexample
23232
23233 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
23234 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
23235 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
23236 function.
23237
23238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23239
23240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
23241
23242 @subsubheading Example
23243
23244 Stepping into a function:
23245
23246 @smallexample
23247 -exec-step
23248 ^running
23249 (gdb)
23250 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23251 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
23252 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
23253 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
23254 (gdb)
23255 @end smallexample
23256
23257 Regular stepping:
23258
23259 @smallexample
23260 -exec-step
23261 ^running
23262 (gdb)
23263 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
23264 (gdb)
23265 @end smallexample
23266
23267
23268 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
23269 @findex -exec-step-instruction
23270
23271 @subsubheading Synopsis
23272
23273 @smallexample
23274 -exec-step-instruction
23275 @end smallexample
23276
23277 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
23278 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
23279 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
23280 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
23281 well.
23282
23283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23284
23285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
23286
23287 @subsubheading Example
23288
23289 @smallexample
23290 (gdb)
23291 -exec-step-instruction
23292 ^running
23293
23294 (gdb)
23295 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23296 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
23297 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
23298 (gdb)
23299 -exec-step-instruction
23300 ^running
23301
23302 (gdb)
23303 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
23304 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
23305 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
23306 (gdb)
23307 @end smallexample
23308
23309
23310 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
23311 @findex -exec-until
23312
23313 @subsubheading Synopsis
23314
23315 @smallexample
23316 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
23317 @end smallexample
23318
23319 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
23320 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
23321 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
23322 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
23323
23324 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23325
23326 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
23327
23328 @subsubheading Example
23329
23330 @smallexample
23331 (gdb)
23332 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
23333 ^running
23334 (gdb)
23335 x = 55
23336 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
23337 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
23338 (gdb)
23339 @end smallexample
23340
23341 @ignore
23342 @subheading -file-clear
23343 Is this going away????
23344 @end ignore
23345
23346 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23347 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
23348 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
23349
23350
23351 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
23352 @findex -stack-info-frame
23353
23354 @subsubheading Synopsis
23355
23356 @smallexample
23357 -stack-info-frame
23358 @end smallexample
23359
23360 Get info on the selected frame.
23361
23362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23363
23364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
23365 (without arguments).
23366
23367 @subsubheading Example
23368
23369 @smallexample
23370 (gdb)
23371 -stack-info-frame
23372 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
23373 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23374 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
23375 (gdb)
23376 @end smallexample
23377
23378 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
23379 @findex -stack-info-depth
23380
23381 @subsubheading Synopsis
23382
23383 @smallexample
23384 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
23385 @end smallexample
23386
23387 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
23388 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
23389
23390 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23391
23392 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23393
23394 @subsubheading Example
23395
23396 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
23397
23398 @smallexample
23399 (gdb)
23400 -stack-info-depth
23401 ^done,depth="12"
23402 (gdb)
23403 -stack-info-depth 4
23404 ^done,depth="4"
23405 (gdb)
23406 -stack-info-depth 12
23407 ^done,depth="12"
23408 (gdb)
23409 -stack-info-depth 11
23410 ^done,depth="11"
23411 (gdb)
23412 -stack-info-depth 13
23413 ^done,depth="12"
23414 (gdb)
23415 @end smallexample
23416
23417 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
23418 @findex -stack-list-arguments
23419
23420 @subsubheading Synopsis
23421
23422 @smallexample
23423 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
23424 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
23425 @end smallexample
23426
23427 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
23428 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
23429 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
23430 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
23431 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
23432 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
23433 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
23434 which case only existing frames will be returned.
23435
23436 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23437 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23438 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23439 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
23440 structures and unions.
23441
23442 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
23443 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
23444
23445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23446
23447 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
23448 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
23449 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
23450
23451 @subsubheading Example
23452
23453 @smallexample
23454 (gdb)
23455 -stack-list-frames
23456 ^done,
23457 stack=[
23458 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
23459 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23460 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
23461 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
23462 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23463 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
23464 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
23465 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23466 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
23467 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
23468 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23469 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
23470 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
23471 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
23472 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
23473 (gdb)
23474 -stack-list-arguments 0
23475 ^done,
23476 stack-args=[
23477 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
23478 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
23479 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
23480 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
23481 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
23482 (gdb)
23483 -stack-list-arguments 1
23484 ^done,
23485 stack-args=[
23486 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
23487 frame=@{level="1",
23488 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
23489 frame=@{level="2",args=[
23490 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23491 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
23492 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
23493 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23494 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
23495 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
23496 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
23497 (gdb)
23498 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
23499 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
23500 (gdb)
23501 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
23502 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
23503 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23504 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
23505 (gdb)
23506 @end smallexample
23507
23508 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
23509
23510
23511 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
23512 @findex -stack-list-frames
23513
23514 @subsubheading Synopsis
23515
23516 @smallexample
23517 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
23518 @end smallexample
23519
23520 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
23521 following info:
23522
23523 @table @samp
23524 @item @var{level}
23525 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
23526 @item @var{addr}
23527 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
23528 @item @var{func}
23529 Function name.
23530 @item @var{file}
23531 File name of the source file where the function lives.
23532 @item @var{line}
23533 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
23534 @end table
23535
23536 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
23537 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
23538 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
23539 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
23540 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
23541 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
23542 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
23543
23544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23545
23546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
23547
23548 @subsubheading Example
23549
23550 Full stack backtrace:
23551
23552 @smallexample
23553 (gdb)
23554 -stack-list-frames
23555 ^done,stack=
23556 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
23557 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
23558 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23559 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23560 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23561 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23562 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23563 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23564 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23565 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23566 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23567 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23568 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23569 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23570 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23571 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23572 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23573 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23574 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23575 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23576 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23577 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23578 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
23579 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
23580 (gdb)
23581 @end smallexample
23582
23583 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
23584
23585 @smallexample
23586 (gdb)
23587 -stack-list-frames 3 5
23588 ^done,stack=
23589 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23590 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23591 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23592 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23593 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23594 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
23595 (gdb)
23596 @end smallexample
23597
23598 Show a single frame:
23599
23600 @smallexample
23601 (gdb)
23602 -stack-list-frames 3 3
23603 ^done,stack=
23604 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23605 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
23606 (gdb)
23607 @end smallexample
23608
23609
23610 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
23611 @findex -stack-list-locals
23612
23613 @subsubheading Synopsis
23614
23615 @smallexample
23616 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
23617 @end smallexample
23618
23619 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
23620 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23621 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23622 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23623 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
23624 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
23625 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
23626 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
23627 more detail.
23628
23629 This command is deprecated in favor of the
23630 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
23631
23632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23633
23634 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
23635
23636 @subsubheading Example
23637
23638 @smallexample
23639 (gdb)
23640 -stack-list-locals 0
23641 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
23642 (gdb)
23643 -stack-list-locals --all-values
23644 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
23645 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
23646 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
23647 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
23648 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
23649 (gdb)
23650 @end smallexample
23651
23652 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
23653 @findex -stack-list-variables
23654
23655 @subsubheading Synopsis
23656
23657 @smallexample
23658 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
23659 @end smallexample
23660
23661 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
23662 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23663 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23664 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23665 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
23666 structures and unions.
23667
23668 @subsubheading Example
23669
23670 @smallexample
23671 (gdb)
23672 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
23673 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
23674 (gdb)
23675 @end smallexample
23676
23677
23678 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
23679 @findex -stack-select-frame
23680
23681 @subsubheading Synopsis
23682
23683 @smallexample
23684 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
23685 @end smallexample
23686
23687 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
23688 the stack.
23689
23690 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
23691 option to every command.
23692
23693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23694
23695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
23696 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
23697
23698 @subsubheading Example
23699
23700 @smallexample
23701 (gdb)
23702 -stack-select-frame 2
23703 ^done
23704 (gdb)
23705 @end smallexample
23706
23707 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23708 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
23709 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
23710
23711 @ignore
23712
23713 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
23714
23715 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
23716 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
23717 used by @code{Insight}.
23718
23719 The two main reasons for that are:
23720
23721 @enumerate 1
23722 @item
23723 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
23724
23725 @item
23726 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
23727 now).
23728 @end enumerate
23729
23730 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
23731 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
23732 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
23733 hints about their use.
23734
23735 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
23736 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
23737 least, the following operations:
23738
23739 @itemize @bullet
23740 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
23741 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
23742 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
23743 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
23744 @end itemize
23745
23746 @end ignore
23747
23748 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
23749
23750 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
23751
23752 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
23753 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
23754 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
23755 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
23756 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
23757 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
23758 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
23759 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
23760 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
23761 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
23762 object, or to change display format.
23763
23764 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
23765 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
23766 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
23767 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
23768 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
23769 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
23770 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
23771 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
23772 child will be created.
23773
23774 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
23775 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
23776 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
23777 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
23778 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
23779
23780 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
23781 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
23782 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
23783 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
23784 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
23785 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
23786 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
23787 variables that frontend has created.
23788
23789 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
23790 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
23791 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
23792 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
23793 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
23794 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
23795 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
23796 implicitly updated.
23797
23798 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
23799 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
23800 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
23801 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
23802 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
23803 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
23804 frame. Consider this example:
23805
23806 @smallexample
23807 void do_work(...)
23808 @{
23809 struct work_state state;
23810
23811 if (...)
23812 do_work(...);
23813 @}
23814 @end smallexample
23815
23816 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
23817 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
23818 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
23819 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
23820 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
23821
23822 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
23823 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
23824 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
23825 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
23826 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
23827 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
23828
23829 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
23830 access this functionality:
23831
23832 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
23833 @item @strong{Operation}
23834 @tab @strong{Description}
23835
23836 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
23837 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
23838 @item @code{-var-create}
23839 @tab create a variable object
23840 @item @code{-var-delete}
23841 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
23842 @item @code{-var-set-format}
23843 @tab set the display format of this variable
23844 @item @code{-var-show-format}
23845 @tab show the display format of this variable
23846 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
23847 @tab tells how many children this object has
23848 @item @code{-var-list-children}
23849 @tab return a list of the object's children
23850 @item @code{-var-info-type}
23851 @tab show the type of this variable object
23852 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
23853 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
23854 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
23855 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
23856 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
23857 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
23858 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
23859 @tab get the value of this variable
23860 @item @code{-var-assign}
23861 @tab set the value of this variable
23862 @item @code{-var-update}
23863 @tab update the variable and its children
23864 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
23865 @tab set frozeness attribute
23866 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
23867 @tab set range of children to display on update
23868 @end multitable
23869
23870 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
23871 how it can be used.
23872
23873 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
23874
23875 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
23876 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
23877
23878 @smallexample
23879 -enable-pretty-printing
23880 @end smallexample
23881
23882 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
23883 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
23884 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
23885 request that this functionality be enabled.
23886
23887 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
23888
23889 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
23890 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
23891
23892 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
23893 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
23894
23895 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
23896 @findex -var-create
23897
23898 @subsubheading Synopsis
23899
23900 @smallexample
23901 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
23902 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
23903 @end smallexample
23904
23905 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
23906 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
23907 register.
23908
23909 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
23910 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
23911 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
23912 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
23913 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
23914
23915 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
23916 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
23917 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
23918 object must be created.
23919
23920 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
23921 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
23922
23923 @itemize @bullet
23924 @item
23925 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
23926
23927 @item
23928 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
23929
23930 @item
23931 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
23932 @end itemize
23933
23934 @cindex dynamic varobj
23935 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
23936 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
23937 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
23938 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
23939 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
23940 compatibility for existing clients.
23941
23942 @subsubheading Result
23943
23944 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
23945 are:
23946
23947 @table @samp
23948 @item name
23949 The name of the varobj.
23950
23951 @item numchild
23952 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
23953 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
23954 @samp{has_more} attribute.
23955
23956 @item value
23957 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
23958 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
23959 will not be interesting.
23960
23961 @item type
23962 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
23963 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
23964
23965 @item thread-id
23966 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
23967 thread's identifier.
23968
23969 @item has_more
23970 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
23971 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
23972
23973 @item dynamic
23974 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
23975 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
23976 then this attribute will not be present.
23977
23978 @item displayhint
23979 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
23980 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
23981 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing}.
23982 @end table
23983
23984 Typical output will look like this:
23985
23986 @smallexample
23987 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
23988 has_more="@var{has_more}"
23989 @end smallexample
23990
23991
23992 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
23993 @findex -var-delete
23994
23995 @subsubheading Synopsis
23996
23997 @smallexample
23998 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
23999 @end smallexample
24000
24001 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
24002 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
24003
24004 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
24005
24006
24007 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
24008 @findex -var-set-format
24009
24010 @subsubheading Synopsis
24011
24012 @smallexample
24013 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
24014 @end smallexample
24015
24016 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
24017 @var{format-spec}.
24018
24019 @anchor{-var-set-format}
24020 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
24021
24022 @smallexample
24023 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
24024 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
24025 @end smallexample
24026
24027 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
24028 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
24029 for pointers, etc.).
24030
24031 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
24032 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
24033
24034 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
24035 @findex -var-show-format
24036
24037 @subsubheading Synopsis
24038
24039 @smallexample
24040 -var-show-format @var{name}
24041 @end smallexample
24042
24043 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
24044
24045 @smallexample
24046 @var{format} @expansion{}
24047 @var{format-spec}
24048 @end smallexample
24049
24050
24051 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
24052 @findex -var-info-num-children
24053
24054 @subsubheading Synopsis
24055
24056 @smallexample
24057 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
24058 @end smallexample
24059
24060 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
24061
24062 @smallexample
24063 numchild=@var{n}
24064 @end smallexample
24065
24066 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
24067 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
24068 be available.
24069
24070
24071 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
24072 @findex -var-list-children
24073
24074 @subsubheading Synopsis
24075
24076 @smallexample
24077 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
24078 @end smallexample
24079 @anchor{-var-list-children}
24080
24081 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
24082 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
24083 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
24084 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
24085 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
24086 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
24087 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
24088 and unions.
24089
24090 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
24091 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
24092 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
24093 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
24094 reported.
24095
24096 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
24097 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
24098 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
24099 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
24100 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
24101 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
24102 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
24103 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
24104 the visible items.
24105
24106 For each child the following results are returned:
24107
24108 @table @var
24109
24110 @item name
24111 Name of the variable object created for this child.
24112
24113 @item exp
24114 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
24115 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
24116
24117 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
24118 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
24119
24120 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
24121 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
24122 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
24123 type and value are not present.
24124
24125 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
24126 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
24127 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
24128
24129 @item numchild
24130 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
24131 0.
24132
24133 @item type
24134 The type of the child.
24135
24136 @item value
24137 If values were requested, this is the value.
24138
24139 @item thread-id
24140 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
24141 Otherwise this result is not present.
24142
24143 @item frozen
24144 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
24145 @end table
24146
24147 The result may have its own attributes:
24148
24149 @table @samp
24150 @item displayhint
24151 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
24152 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
24153 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing}.
24154
24155 @item has_more
24156 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
24157 remaining after the end of the selected range.
24158 @end table
24159
24160 @subsubheading Example
24161
24162 @smallexample
24163 (gdb)
24164 -var-list-children n
24165 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
24166 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
24167 (gdb)
24168 -var-list-children --all-values n
24169 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
24170 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
24171 @end smallexample
24172
24173
24174 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
24175 @findex -var-info-type
24176
24177 @subsubheading Synopsis
24178
24179 @smallexample
24180 -var-info-type @var{name}
24181 @end smallexample
24182
24183 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
24184 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
24185 @value{GDBN} CLI:
24186
24187 @smallexample
24188 type=@var{typename}
24189 @end smallexample
24190
24191
24192 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
24193 @findex -var-info-expression
24194
24195 @subsubheading Synopsis
24196
24197 @smallexample
24198 -var-info-expression @var{name}
24199 @end smallexample
24200
24201 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
24202 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
24203 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
24204
24205 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
24206 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
24207
24208 @smallexample
24209 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
24210 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
24211 @end smallexample
24212
24213 @noindent
24214 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
24215
24216 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
24217 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
24218 is of limited use.
24219
24220 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
24221 @findex -var-info-path-expression
24222
24223 @subsubheading Synopsis
24224
24225 @smallexample
24226 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
24227 @end smallexample
24228
24229 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
24230 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
24231 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
24232 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
24233 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
24234 watchpoint from a variable object.
24235
24236 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
24237 and will give an error when invoked on one.
24238
24239 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
24240 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
24241 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
24242 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
24243 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
24244 @smallexample
24245 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
24246 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
24247 @end smallexample
24248
24249 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
24250 @findex -var-show-attributes
24251
24252 @subsubheading Synopsis
24253
24254 @smallexample
24255 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
24256 @end smallexample
24257
24258 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
24259
24260 @smallexample
24261 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
24262 @end smallexample
24263
24264 @noindent
24265 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
24266
24267 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
24268 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
24269
24270 @subsubheading Synopsis
24271
24272 @smallexample
24273 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
24274 @end smallexample
24275
24276 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
24277 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
24278 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
24279 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
24280 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
24281 the current display format will be used. The current display format
24282 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
24283
24284 @smallexample
24285 value=@var{value}
24286 @end smallexample
24287
24288 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
24289 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
24290
24291 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
24292 @findex -var-assign
24293
24294 @subsubheading Synopsis
24295
24296 @smallexample
24297 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
24298 @end smallexample
24299
24300 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
24301 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
24302 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
24303 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
24304
24305 @subsubheading Example
24306
24307 @smallexample
24308 (gdb)
24309 -var-assign var1 3
24310 ^done,value="3"
24311 (gdb)
24312 -var-update *
24313 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
24314 (gdb)
24315 @end smallexample
24316
24317 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
24318 @findex -var-update
24319
24320 @subsubheading Synopsis
24321
24322 @smallexample
24323 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
24324 @end smallexample
24325
24326 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
24327 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
24328 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
24329 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
24330 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
24331 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
24332 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
24333 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
24334 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
24335 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
24336 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
24337 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
24338 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
24339
24340 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
24341 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
24342 diagnostic.
24343
24344 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
24345 only the selected range of children will be reported.
24346
24347 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
24348 @samp{changelist}.
24349
24350 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
24351
24352 @table @samp
24353 @item name
24354 The name of the varobj.
24355
24356 @item value
24357 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
24358 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
24359
24360 @item in_scope
24361 @anchor{-var-update}
24362 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
24363
24364 @table @code
24365 @item "true"
24366 The variable object's current value is valid.
24367
24368 @item "false"
24369 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
24370 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
24371 scope.
24372
24373 @item "invalid"
24374 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
24375 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
24376 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
24377 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
24378 objects.
24379 @end table
24380
24381 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
24382 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
24383
24384 @item type_changed
24385 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
24386 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
24387 be @samp{false}.
24388
24389 @item new_type
24390 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
24391 hold the new type.
24392
24393 @item new_num_children
24394 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
24395 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
24396
24397 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
24398 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
24399 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
24400 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
24401 children which may be available.
24402
24403 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
24404 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
24405 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
24406 only happen at the end of the update range).
24407
24408 @item displayhint
24409 The display hint, if any.
24410
24411 @item has_more
24412 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
24413 available outside the varobj's update range.
24414
24415 @item dynamic
24416 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
24417 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
24418 then this attribute will not be present.
24419
24420 @item new_children
24421 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
24422 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
24423 be listed in this attribute.
24424 @end table
24425
24426 @subsubheading Example
24427
24428 @smallexample
24429 (gdb)
24430 -var-assign var1 3
24431 ^done,value="3"
24432 (gdb)
24433 -var-update --all-values var1
24434 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
24435 type_changed="false"@}]
24436 (gdb)
24437 @end smallexample
24438
24439 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
24440 @findex -var-set-frozen
24441 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
24442
24443 @subsubheading Synopsis
24444
24445 @smallexample
24446 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
24447 @end smallexample
24448
24449 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
24450 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
24451 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
24452 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
24453 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
24454 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
24455 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
24456 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
24457 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
24458 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
24459 @code{-var-update} does.
24460
24461 @subsubheading Example
24462
24463 @smallexample
24464 (gdb)
24465 -var-set-frozen V 1
24466 ^done
24467 (gdb)
24468 @end smallexample
24469
24470 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
24471 @findex -var-set-update-range
24472 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
24473
24474 @subsubheading Synopsis
24475
24476 @smallexample
24477 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
24478 @end smallexample
24479
24480 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
24481 @code{-var-update}.
24482
24483 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
24484 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
24485 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
24486 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
24487
24488 @subsubheading Example
24489
24490 @smallexample
24491 (gdb)
24492 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
24493 ^done
24494 @end smallexample
24495
24496 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
24497 @findex -var-set-visualizer
24498 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
24499
24500 @subsubheading Synopsis
24501
24502 @smallexample
24503 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
24504 @end smallexample
24505
24506 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
24507
24508 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
24509 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
24510
24511 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
24512 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
24513 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
24514 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
24515 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
24516 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
24517 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
24518
24519 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
24520 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
24521 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
24522 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
24523
24524 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
24525 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
24526 can be used to check this.
24527
24528 @subsubheading Example
24529
24530 Resetting the visualizer:
24531
24532 @smallexample
24533 (gdb)
24534 -var-set-visualizer V None
24535 ^done
24536 @end smallexample
24537
24538 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
24539
24540 @smallexample
24541 (gdb)
24542 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
24543 ^done
24544 @end smallexample
24545
24546 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
24547 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
24548
24549 @smallexample
24550 (gdb)
24551 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
24552 ^done
24553 @end smallexample
24554
24555 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24556 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
24557 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
24558
24559 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
24560 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
24561 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
24562 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
24563
24564 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
24565 @c @subheading -data-assign
24566 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
24567 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
24568 @c set variable
24569 @c @subsubheading Example
24570 @c N.A.
24571
24572 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
24573 @findex -data-disassemble
24574
24575 @subsubheading Synopsis
24576
24577 @smallexample
24578 -data-disassemble
24579 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
24580 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
24581 -- @var{mode}
24582 @end smallexample
24583
24584 @noindent
24585 Where:
24586
24587 @table @samp
24588 @item @var{start-addr}
24589 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
24590 @item @var{end-addr}
24591 is the end address
24592 @item @var{filename}
24593 is the name of the file to disassemble
24594 @item @var{linenum}
24595 is the line number to disassemble around
24596 @item @var{lines}
24597 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
24598 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
24599 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
24600 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
24601 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
24602 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
24603 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
24604 are displayed.
24605 @item @var{mode}
24606 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
24607 disassembly).
24608 @end table
24609
24610 @subsubheading Result
24611
24612 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
24613
24614 @itemize @bullet
24615 @item Address
24616 @item Func-name
24617 @item Offset
24618 @item Instruction
24619 @end itemize
24620
24621 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
24622 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
24623
24624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24625
24626 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
24627
24628 @subsubheading Example
24629
24630 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
24631
24632 @smallexample
24633 (gdb)
24634 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
24635 ^done,
24636 asm_insns=[
24637 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24638 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24639 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24640 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
24641 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
24642 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
24643 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
24644 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
24645 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
24646 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
24647 (gdb)
24648 @end smallexample
24649
24650 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
24651 @code{main}.
24652
24653 @smallexample
24654 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
24655 ^done,asm_insns=[
24656 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
24657 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
24658 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24659 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24660 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24661 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
24662 [@dots{}]
24663 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
24664 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
24665 (gdb)
24666 @end smallexample
24667
24668 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
24669
24670 @smallexample
24671 (gdb)
24672 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
24673 ^done,asm_insns=[
24674 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
24675 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
24676 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24677 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24678 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24679 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
24680 (gdb)
24681 @end smallexample
24682
24683 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
24684
24685 @smallexample
24686 (gdb)
24687 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
24688 ^done,asm_insns=[
24689 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
24690 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
24691 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
24692 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
24693 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
24694 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
24695 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
24696 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
24697 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
24698 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
24699 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
24700 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
24701 (gdb)
24702 @end smallexample
24703
24704
24705 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
24706 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
24707
24708 @subsubheading Synopsis
24709
24710 @smallexample
24711 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
24712 @end smallexample
24713
24714 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
24715 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
24716 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
24717
24718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24719
24720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
24721 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
24722 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
24723
24724 @subsubheading Example
24725
24726 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
24727 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
24728 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
24729 output.
24730
24731 @smallexample
24732 211-data-evaluate-expression A
24733 211^done,value="1"
24734 (gdb)
24735 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
24736 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
24737 (gdb)
24738 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
24739 411^done,value="4"
24740 (gdb)
24741 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
24742 511^done,value="4"
24743 (gdb)
24744 @end smallexample
24745
24746
24747 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
24748 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
24749
24750 @subsubheading Synopsis
24751
24752 @smallexample
24753 -data-list-changed-registers
24754 @end smallexample
24755
24756 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
24757
24758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24759
24760 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
24761 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
24762
24763 @subsubheading Example
24764
24765 On a PPC MBX board:
24766
24767 @smallexample
24768 (gdb)
24769 -exec-continue
24770 ^running
24771
24772 (gdb)
24773 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
24774 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
24775 line="5"@}
24776 (gdb)
24777 -data-list-changed-registers
24778 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
24779 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
24780 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
24781 (gdb)
24782 @end smallexample
24783
24784
24785 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
24786 @findex -data-list-register-names
24787
24788 @subsubheading Synopsis
24789
24790 @smallexample
24791 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
24792 @end smallexample
24793
24794 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
24795 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
24796 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
24797 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
24798 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
24799 include empty register names.
24800
24801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24802
24803 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
24804 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
24805 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
24806
24807 @subsubheading Example
24808
24809 For the PPC MBX board:
24810 @smallexample
24811 (gdb)
24812 -data-list-register-names
24813 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
24814 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
24815 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
24816 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
24817 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
24818 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
24819 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
24820 (gdb)
24821 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
24822 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
24823 (gdb)
24824 @end smallexample
24825
24826 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
24827 @findex -data-list-register-values
24828
24829 @subsubheading Synopsis
24830
24831 @smallexample
24832 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
24833 @end smallexample
24834
24835 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
24836 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
24837 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
24838 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
24839
24840 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
24841
24842 @table @code
24843 @item x
24844 Hexadecimal
24845 @item o
24846 Octal
24847 @item t
24848 Binary
24849 @item d
24850 Decimal
24851 @item r
24852 Raw
24853 @item N
24854 Natural
24855 @end table
24856
24857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24858
24859 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
24860 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
24861
24862 @subsubheading Example
24863
24864 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
24865 don't appear in the actual output):
24866
24867 @smallexample
24868 (gdb)
24869 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
24870 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
24871 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
24872 (gdb)
24873 -data-list-register-values x
24874 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
24875 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
24876 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
24877 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
24878 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
24879 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
24880 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
24881 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
24882 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
24883 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
24884 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
24885 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
24886 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
24887 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
24888 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
24889 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
24890 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
24891 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
24892 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
24893 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
24894 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
24895 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
24896 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
24897 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
24898 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
24899 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
24900 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
24901 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
24902 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
24903 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
24904 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
24905 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
24906 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
24907 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
24908 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
24909 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
24910 (gdb)
24911 @end smallexample
24912
24913
24914 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
24915 @findex -data-read-memory
24916
24917 @subsubheading Synopsis
24918
24919 @smallexample
24920 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
24921 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
24922 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
24923 @end smallexample
24924
24925 @noindent
24926 where:
24927
24928 @table @samp
24929 @item @var{address}
24930 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
24931 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
24932 quoted using the C convention.
24933
24934 @item @var{word-format}
24935 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
24936 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
24937 ,Output Formats}).
24938
24939 @item @var{word-size}
24940 The size of each memory word in bytes.
24941
24942 @item @var{nr-rows}
24943 The number of rows in the output table.
24944
24945 @item @var{nr-cols}
24946 The number of columns in the output table.
24947
24948 @item @var{aschar}
24949 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
24950 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
24951 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
24952 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
24953
24954 @item @var{byte-offset}
24955 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
24956 @end table
24957
24958 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
24959 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
24960 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
24961 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
24962 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
24963 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
24964 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
24965 @samp{addr}.
24966
24967 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
24968 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
24969 @samp{prev-page}.
24970
24971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24972
24973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
24974 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
24975
24976 @subsubheading Example
24977
24978 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
24979 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
24980 word. Display each word in hex.
24981
24982 @smallexample
24983 (gdb)
24984 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
24985 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
24986 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
24987 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
24988 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
24989 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
24990 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
24991 (gdb)
24992 @end smallexample
24993
24994 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
24995 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
24996
24997 @smallexample
24998 (gdb)
24999 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
25000 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
25001 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
25002 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
25003 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
25004 (gdb)
25005 @end smallexample
25006
25007 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
25008 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
25009 used as the non-printable character.
25010
25011 @smallexample
25012 (gdb)
25013 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
25014 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
25015 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
25016 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
25017 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25018 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25019 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25020 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
25021 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
25022 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
25023 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
25024 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
25025 (gdb)
25026 @end smallexample
25027
25028 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25029 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
25030 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
25031
25032 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
25033
25034 @c @subheading -trace-actions
25035
25036 @c @subheading -trace-delete
25037
25038 @c @subheading -trace-disable
25039
25040 @c @subheading -trace-dump
25041
25042 @c @subheading -trace-enable
25043
25044 @c @subheading -trace-exists
25045
25046 @c @subheading -trace-find
25047
25048 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
25049
25050 @c @subheading -trace-info
25051
25052 @c @subheading -trace-insert
25053
25054 @c @subheading -trace-list
25055
25056 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
25057
25058 @c @subheading -trace-save
25059
25060 @c @subheading -trace-start
25061
25062 @c @subheading -trace-stop
25063
25064
25065 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25066 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
25067 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
25068
25069
25070 @ignore
25071 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
25072 @findex -symbol-info-address
25073
25074 @subsubheading Synopsis
25075
25076 @smallexample
25077 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
25078 @end smallexample
25079
25080 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
25081
25082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25083
25084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
25085
25086 @subsubheading Example
25087 N.A.
25088
25089
25090 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
25091 @findex -symbol-info-file
25092
25093 @subsubheading Synopsis
25094
25095 @smallexample
25096 -symbol-info-file
25097 @end smallexample
25098
25099 Show the file for the symbol.
25100
25101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25102
25103 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
25104 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
25105
25106 @subsubheading Example
25107 N.A.
25108
25109
25110 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
25111 @findex -symbol-info-function
25112
25113 @subsubheading Synopsis
25114
25115 @smallexample
25116 -symbol-info-function
25117 @end smallexample
25118
25119 Show which function the symbol lives in.
25120
25121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25122
25123 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
25124
25125 @subsubheading Example
25126 N.A.
25127
25128
25129 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
25130 @findex -symbol-info-line
25131
25132 @subsubheading Synopsis
25133
25134 @smallexample
25135 -symbol-info-line
25136 @end smallexample
25137
25138 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
25139
25140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25141
25142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
25143 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
25144
25145 @subsubheading Example
25146 N.A.
25147
25148
25149 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
25150 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
25151
25152 @subsubheading Synopsis
25153
25154 @smallexample
25155 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
25156 @end smallexample
25157
25158 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
25159
25160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25161
25162 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
25163
25164 @subsubheading Example
25165 N.A.
25166
25167
25168 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
25169 @findex -symbol-list-functions
25170
25171 @subsubheading Synopsis
25172
25173 @smallexample
25174 -symbol-list-functions
25175 @end smallexample
25176
25177 List the functions in the executable.
25178
25179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25180
25181 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
25182 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
25183
25184 @subsubheading Example
25185 N.A.
25186 @end ignore
25187
25188
25189 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
25190 @findex -symbol-list-lines
25191
25192 @subsubheading Synopsis
25193
25194 @smallexample
25195 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
25196 @end smallexample
25197
25198 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
25199 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
25200 ascending PC order.
25201
25202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25203
25204 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
25205
25206 @subsubheading Example
25207 @smallexample
25208 (gdb)
25209 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
25210 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
25211 (gdb)
25212 @end smallexample
25213
25214
25215 @ignore
25216 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
25217 @findex -symbol-list-types
25218
25219 @subsubheading Synopsis
25220
25221 @smallexample
25222 -symbol-list-types
25223 @end smallexample
25224
25225 List all the type names.
25226
25227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25228
25229 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
25230 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
25231
25232 @subsubheading Example
25233 N.A.
25234
25235
25236 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
25237 @findex -symbol-list-variables
25238
25239 @subsubheading Synopsis
25240
25241 @smallexample
25242 -symbol-list-variables
25243 @end smallexample
25244
25245 List all the global and static variable names.
25246
25247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25248
25249 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
25250
25251 @subsubheading Example
25252 N.A.
25253
25254
25255 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
25256 @findex -symbol-locate
25257
25258 @subsubheading Synopsis
25259
25260 @smallexample
25261 -symbol-locate
25262 @end smallexample
25263
25264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25265
25266 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
25267
25268 @subsubheading Example
25269 N.A.
25270
25271
25272 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
25273 @findex -symbol-type
25274
25275 @subsubheading Synopsis
25276
25277 @smallexample
25278 -symbol-type @var{variable}
25279 @end smallexample
25280
25281 Show type of @var{variable}.
25282
25283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25284
25285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
25286 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
25287
25288 @subsubheading Example
25289 N.A.
25290 @end ignore
25291
25292
25293 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25294 @node GDB/MI File Commands
25295 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
25296
25297 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
25298 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
25299
25300 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
25301 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
25302
25303 @subsubheading Synopsis
25304
25305 @smallexample
25306 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
25307 @end smallexample
25308
25309 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
25310 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
25311 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
25312 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
25313 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
25314 notification.
25315
25316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25317
25318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
25319
25320 @subsubheading Example
25321
25322 @smallexample
25323 (gdb)
25324 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
25325 ^done
25326 (gdb)
25327 @end smallexample
25328
25329
25330 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
25331 @findex -file-exec-file
25332
25333 @subsubheading Synopsis
25334
25335 @smallexample
25336 -file-exec-file @var{file}
25337 @end smallexample
25338
25339 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
25340 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
25341 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
25342 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
25343 notification.
25344
25345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25346
25347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
25348
25349 @subsubheading Example
25350
25351 @smallexample
25352 (gdb)
25353 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
25354 ^done
25355 (gdb)
25356 @end smallexample
25357
25358
25359 @ignore
25360 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
25361 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
25362
25363 @subsubheading Synopsis
25364
25365 @smallexample
25366 -file-list-exec-sections
25367 @end smallexample
25368
25369 List the sections of the current executable file.
25370
25371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25372
25373 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
25374 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
25375 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
25376
25377 @subsubheading Example
25378 N.A.
25379 @end ignore
25380
25381
25382 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
25383 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
25384
25385 @subsubheading Synopsis
25386
25387 @smallexample
25388 -file-list-exec-source-file
25389 @end smallexample
25390
25391 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
25392 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
25393 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
25394 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
25395
25396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25397
25398 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
25399
25400 @subsubheading Example
25401
25402 @smallexample
25403 (gdb)
25404 123-file-list-exec-source-file
25405 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
25406 (gdb)
25407 @end smallexample
25408
25409
25410 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
25411 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
25412
25413 @subsubheading Synopsis
25414
25415 @smallexample
25416 -file-list-exec-source-files
25417 @end smallexample
25418
25419 List the source files for the current executable.
25420
25421 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
25422 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
25423
25424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25425
25426 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
25427 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
25428
25429 @subsubheading Example
25430 @smallexample
25431 (gdb)
25432 -file-list-exec-source-files
25433 ^done,files=[
25434 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
25435 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
25436 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
25437 (gdb)
25438 @end smallexample
25439
25440 @ignore
25441 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
25442 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
25443
25444 @subsubheading Synopsis
25445
25446 @smallexample
25447 -file-list-shared-libraries
25448 @end smallexample
25449
25450 List the shared libraries in the program.
25451
25452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25453
25454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
25455
25456 @subsubheading Example
25457 N.A.
25458
25459
25460 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
25461 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
25462
25463 @subsubheading Synopsis
25464
25465 @smallexample
25466 -file-list-symbol-files
25467 @end smallexample
25468
25469 List symbol files.
25470
25471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25472
25473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
25474
25475 @subsubheading Example
25476 N.A.
25477 @end ignore
25478
25479
25480 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
25481 @findex -file-symbol-file
25482
25483 @subsubheading Synopsis
25484
25485 @smallexample
25486 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
25487 @end smallexample
25488
25489 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
25490 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
25491 produced, except for a completion notification.
25492
25493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25494
25495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
25496
25497 @subsubheading Example
25498
25499 @smallexample
25500 (gdb)
25501 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
25502 ^done
25503 (gdb)
25504 @end smallexample
25505
25506 @ignore
25507 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25508 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
25509 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
25510
25511 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
25512
25513 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
25514
25515 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
25516
25517 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
25518
25519 @c @subheading -overlay-map
25520
25521 @c @subheading -overlay-off
25522
25523 @c @subheading -overlay-on
25524
25525 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
25526
25527 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25528 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
25529 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
25530
25531 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
25532
25533 @c @subheading -signal-handle
25534
25535 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
25536
25537 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
25538 @end ignore
25539
25540
25541 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25542 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
25543 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
25544
25545
25546 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
25547 @findex -target-attach
25548
25549 @subsubheading Synopsis
25550
25551 @smallexample
25552 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
25553 @end smallexample
25554
25555 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
25556 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
25557 group, the id previously returned by
25558 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
25559
25560 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25561
25562 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
25563
25564 @subsubheading Example
25565 @smallexample
25566 (gdb)
25567 -target-attach 34
25568 =thread-created,id="1"
25569 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
25570 ^done
25571 (gdb)
25572 @end smallexample
25573
25574 @ignore
25575 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
25576 @findex -target-compare-sections
25577
25578 @subsubheading Synopsis
25579
25580 @smallexample
25581 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
25582 @end smallexample
25583
25584 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
25585 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
25586
25587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25588
25589 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
25590
25591 @subsubheading Example
25592 N.A.
25593 @end ignore
25594
25595
25596 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
25597 @findex -target-detach
25598
25599 @subsubheading Synopsis
25600
25601 @smallexample
25602 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
25603 @end smallexample
25604
25605 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
25606 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
25607 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
25608
25609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25610
25611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
25612
25613 @subsubheading Example
25614
25615 @smallexample
25616 (gdb)
25617 -target-detach
25618 ^done
25619 (gdb)
25620 @end smallexample
25621
25622
25623 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
25624 @findex -target-disconnect
25625
25626 @subsubheading Synopsis
25627
25628 @smallexample
25629 -target-disconnect
25630 @end smallexample
25631
25632 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
25633 generally not resumed.
25634
25635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25636
25637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
25638
25639 @subsubheading Example
25640
25641 @smallexample
25642 (gdb)
25643 -target-disconnect
25644 ^done
25645 (gdb)
25646 @end smallexample
25647
25648
25649 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
25650 @findex -target-download
25651
25652 @subsubheading Synopsis
25653
25654 @smallexample
25655 -target-download
25656 @end smallexample
25657
25658 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
25659 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
25660
25661 @table @samp
25662 @item section
25663 The name of the section.
25664 @item section-sent
25665 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
25666 @item section-size
25667 The size of the section.
25668 @item total-sent
25669 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
25670 @item total-size
25671 The size of the overall executable to download.
25672 @end table
25673
25674 @noindent
25675 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
25676 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
25677
25678 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
25679 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
25680
25681 @table @samp
25682 @item section
25683 The name of the section.
25684 @item section-size
25685 The size of the section.
25686 @item total-size
25687 The size of the overall executable to download.
25688 @end table
25689
25690 @noindent
25691 At the end, a summary is printed.
25692
25693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25694
25695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
25696
25697 @subsubheading Example
25698
25699 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
25700 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
25701
25702 @smallexample
25703 (gdb)
25704 -target-download
25705 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
25706 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
25707 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
25708 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
25709 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
25710 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
25711 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
25712 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
25713 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
25714 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
25715 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
25716 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
25717 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
25718 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
25719 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
25720 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
25721 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
25722 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
25723 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
25724 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
25725 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
25726 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
25727 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
25728 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
25729 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
25730 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
25731 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
25732 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
25733 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
25734 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
25735 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
25736 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
25737 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
25738 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
25739 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
25740 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
25741 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
25742 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
25743 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
25744 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
25745 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
25746 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
25747 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
25748 write-rate="429"
25749 (gdb)
25750 @end smallexample
25751
25752
25753 @ignore
25754 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
25755 @findex -target-exec-status
25756
25757 @subsubheading Synopsis
25758
25759 @smallexample
25760 -target-exec-status
25761 @end smallexample
25762
25763 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
25764 not, for instance).
25765
25766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25767
25768 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
25769
25770 @subsubheading Example
25771 N.A.
25772
25773
25774 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
25775 @findex -target-list-available-targets
25776
25777 @subsubheading Synopsis
25778
25779 @smallexample
25780 -target-list-available-targets
25781 @end smallexample
25782
25783 List the possible targets to connect to.
25784
25785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25786
25787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
25788
25789 @subsubheading Example
25790 N.A.
25791
25792
25793 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
25794 @findex -target-list-current-targets
25795
25796 @subsubheading Synopsis
25797
25798 @smallexample
25799 -target-list-current-targets
25800 @end smallexample
25801
25802 Describe the current target.
25803
25804 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25805
25806 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
25807 other things).
25808
25809 @subsubheading Example
25810 N.A.
25811
25812
25813 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
25814 @findex -target-list-parameters
25815
25816 @subsubheading Synopsis
25817
25818 @smallexample
25819 -target-list-parameters
25820 @end smallexample
25821
25822 @c ????
25823 @end ignore
25824
25825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25826
25827 No equivalent.
25828
25829 @subsubheading Example
25830 N.A.
25831
25832
25833 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
25834 @findex -target-select
25835
25836 @subsubheading Synopsis
25837
25838 @smallexample
25839 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
25840 @end smallexample
25841
25842 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
25843
25844 @table @samp
25845 @item @var{type}
25846 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
25847 @item @var{parameters}
25848 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
25849 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
25850 @end table
25851
25852 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
25853 which the target program is, in the following form:
25854
25855 @smallexample
25856 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
25857 args=[@var{arg list}]
25858 @end smallexample
25859
25860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25861
25862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
25863
25864 @subsubheading Example
25865
25866 @smallexample
25867 (gdb)
25868 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
25869 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
25870 (gdb)
25871 @end smallexample
25872
25873 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25874 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
25875 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
25876
25877
25878 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
25879 @findex -target-file-put
25880
25881 @subsubheading Synopsis
25882
25883 @smallexample
25884 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
25885 @end smallexample
25886
25887 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
25888 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
25889
25890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25891
25892 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
25893
25894 @subsubheading Example
25895
25896 @smallexample
25897 (gdb)
25898 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
25899 ^done
25900 (gdb)
25901 @end smallexample
25902
25903
25904 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
25905 @findex -target-file-get
25906
25907 @subsubheading Synopsis
25908
25909 @smallexample
25910 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
25911 @end smallexample
25912
25913 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
25914 on the host system.
25915
25916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25917
25918 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
25919
25920 @subsubheading Example
25921
25922 @smallexample
25923 (gdb)
25924 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
25925 ^done
25926 (gdb)
25927 @end smallexample
25928
25929
25930 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
25931 @findex -target-file-delete
25932
25933 @subsubheading Synopsis
25934
25935 @smallexample
25936 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
25937 @end smallexample
25938
25939 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
25940
25941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25942
25943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
25944
25945 @subsubheading Example
25946
25947 @smallexample
25948 (gdb)
25949 -target-file-delete remotefile
25950 ^done
25951 (gdb)
25952 @end smallexample
25953
25954
25955 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25956 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
25957 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
25958
25959 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
25960
25961 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
25962 @findex -gdb-exit
25963
25964 @subsubheading Synopsis
25965
25966 @smallexample
25967 -gdb-exit
25968 @end smallexample
25969
25970 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
25971
25972 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25973
25974 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
25975
25976 @subsubheading Example
25977
25978 @smallexample
25979 (gdb)
25980 -gdb-exit
25981 ^exit
25982 @end smallexample
25983
25984
25985 @ignore
25986 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
25987 @findex -exec-abort
25988
25989 @subsubheading Synopsis
25990
25991 @smallexample
25992 -exec-abort
25993 @end smallexample
25994
25995 Kill the inferior running program.
25996
25997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25998
25999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
26000
26001 @subsubheading Example
26002 N.A.
26003 @end ignore
26004
26005
26006 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
26007 @findex -gdb-set
26008
26009 @subsubheading Synopsis
26010
26011 @smallexample
26012 -gdb-set
26013 @end smallexample
26014
26015 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
26016 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
26017
26018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26019
26020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
26021
26022 @subsubheading Example
26023
26024 @smallexample
26025 (gdb)
26026 -gdb-set $foo=3
26027 ^done
26028 (gdb)
26029 @end smallexample
26030
26031
26032 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
26033 @findex -gdb-show
26034
26035 @subsubheading Synopsis
26036
26037 @smallexample
26038 -gdb-show
26039 @end smallexample
26040
26041 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
26042
26043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26044
26045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
26046
26047 @subsubheading Example
26048
26049 @smallexample
26050 (gdb)
26051 -gdb-show annotate
26052 ^done,value="0"
26053 (gdb)
26054 @end smallexample
26055
26056 @c @subheading -gdb-source
26057
26058
26059 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
26060 @findex -gdb-version
26061
26062 @subsubheading Synopsis
26063
26064 @smallexample
26065 -gdb-version
26066 @end smallexample
26067
26068 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
26069
26070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26071
26072 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
26073 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
26074
26075 @subsubheading Example
26076
26077 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
26078 @c box in TeX.
26079 @smallexample
26080 (gdb)
26081 -gdb-version
26082 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
26083 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
26084 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
26085 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
26086 ~ certain conditions.
26087 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
26088 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
26089 ~ details.
26090 ~This GDB was configured as
26091 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
26092 ^done
26093 (gdb)
26094 @end smallexample
26095
26096 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
26097 @findex -list-features
26098
26099 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
26100 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
26101 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
26102 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
26103 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
26104 startup.
26105
26106 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
26107 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
26108 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
26109 is given below.
26110
26111 Example output:
26112
26113 @smallexample
26114 (gdb) -list-features
26115 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
26116 @end smallexample
26117
26118 The current list of features is:
26119
26120 @table @samp
26121 @item frozen-varobjs
26122 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
26123 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
26124 of @code{-varobj-create}.
26125 @item pending-breakpoints
26126 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
26127 @item python
26128 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
26129 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
26130 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
26131 @item thread-info
26132 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
26133
26134 @end table
26135
26136 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
26137 @findex -list-target-features
26138
26139 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
26140 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
26141 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
26142 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
26143 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
26144 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
26145 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
26146 Example output:
26147
26148 @smallexample
26149 (gdb) -list-features
26150 ^done,result=["async"]
26151 @end smallexample
26152
26153 The current list of features is:
26154
26155 @table @samp
26156 @item async
26157 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
26158 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
26159 while the target is running.
26160
26161 @end table
26162
26163 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
26164 @findex -list-thread-groups
26165
26166 @subheading Synopsis
26167
26168 @smallexample
26169 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
26170 @end smallexample
26171
26172 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
26173 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
26174 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
26175 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
26176 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
26177 the same time, but it may change in future.
26178
26179 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
26180 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
26181 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
26182 is not allowed.
26183
26184 @subheading Example
26185
26186 @smallexample
26187 @value{GDBP}
26188 -list-thread-groups
26189 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
26190 -list-thread-groups 17
26191 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26192 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
26193 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26194 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26195 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
26196 @end smallexample
26197
26198 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
26199 @findex -interpreter-exec
26200
26201 @subheading Synopsis
26202
26203 @smallexample
26204 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
26205 @end smallexample
26206 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
26207
26208 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
26209
26210 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26211
26212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
26213
26214 @subheading Example
26215
26216 @smallexample
26217 (gdb)
26218 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
26219 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
26220 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
26221 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
26222 ^done
26223 (gdb)
26224 @end smallexample
26225
26226 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
26227 @findex -inferior-tty-set
26228
26229 @subheading Synopsis
26230
26231 @smallexample
26232 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
26233 @end smallexample
26234
26235 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
26236
26237 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26238
26239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
26240
26241 @subheading Example
26242
26243 @smallexample
26244 (gdb)
26245 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
26246 ^done
26247 (gdb)
26248 @end smallexample
26249
26250 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
26251 @findex -inferior-tty-show
26252
26253 @subheading Synopsis
26254
26255 @smallexample
26256 -inferior-tty-show
26257 @end smallexample
26258
26259 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
26260
26261 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26262
26263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
26264
26265 @subheading Example
26266
26267 @smallexample
26268 (gdb)
26269 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
26270 ^done
26271 (gdb)
26272 -inferior-tty-show
26273 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
26274 (gdb)
26275 @end smallexample
26276
26277 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
26278 @findex -enable-timings
26279
26280 @subheading Synopsis
26281
26282 @smallexample
26283 -enable-timings [yes | no]
26284 @end smallexample
26285
26286 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
26287 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
26288 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
26289 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
26290
26291 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
26292
26293 No equivalent.
26294
26295 @subheading Example
26296
26297 @smallexample
26298 (gdb)
26299 -enable-timings
26300 ^done
26301 (gdb)
26302 -break-insert main
26303 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26304 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26305 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
26306 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
26307 (gdb)
26308 -enable-timings no
26309 ^done
26310 (gdb)
26311 -exec-run
26312 ^running
26313 (gdb)
26314 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26315 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
26316 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
26317 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
26318 (gdb)
26319 @end smallexample
26320
26321 @node Annotations
26322 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
26323
26324 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
26325 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
26326 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
26327 relatively high level.
26328
26329 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
26330 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
26331
26332 @ignore
26333 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
26334 @end ignore
26335
26336 @menu
26337 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
26338 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
26339 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
26340 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
26341 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
26342 * Annotations for Running::
26343 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
26344 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
26345 @end menu
26346
26347 @node Annotations Overview
26348 @section What is an Annotation?
26349 @cindex annotations
26350
26351 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
26352 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
26353 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
26354 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
26355 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
26356 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
26357 cannot contain newline characters.
26358
26359 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
26360 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
26361 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
26362 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
26363 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
26364 means those three characters as output.
26365
26366 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
26367 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
26368 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
26369 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
26370 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
26371 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
26372 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
26373 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
26374 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
26375
26376 @table @code
26377 @kindex set annotate
26378 @item set annotate @var{level}
26379 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
26380 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
26381
26382 @item show annotate
26383 @kindex show annotate
26384 Show the current annotation level.
26385 @end table
26386
26387 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
26388
26389 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
26390
26391 @smallexample
26392 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
26393 GNU gdb 6.0
26394 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
26395 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
26396 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
26397 under certain conditions.
26398 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
26399 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
26400 for details.
26401 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
26402
26403 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
26404 (@value{GDBP})
26405 ^Z^Zprompt
26406 @kbd{quit}
26407
26408 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
26409 $
26410 @end smallexample
26411
26412 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
26413 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
26414 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
26415 output from @value{GDBN}.
26416
26417 @node Server Prefix
26418 @section The Server Prefix
26419 @cindex server prefix
26420
26421 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
26422 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
26423 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
26424 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
26425 a transparent manner.
26426
26427 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
26428 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
26429 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
26430 @code{print} command.
26431
26432 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
26433 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
26434
26435 @node Prompting
26436 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
26437
26438 @cindex annotations for prompts
26439 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
26440 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
26441 over, etc.
26442
26443 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
26444 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
26445 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
26446 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
26447 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
26448 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
26449 features the following annotations:
26450
26451 @smallexample
26452 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
26453 ^Z^Zprompt
26454 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
26455 @end smallexample
26456
26457 The input types are
26458
26459 @table @code
26460 @findex pre-prompt annotation
26461 @findex prompt annotation
26462 @findex post-prompt annotation
26463 @item prompt
26464 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
26465
26466 @findex pre-commands annotation
26467 @findex commands annotation
26468 @findex post-commands annotation
26469 @item commands
26470 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
26471 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
26472
26473 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
26474 @findex overload-choice annotation
26475 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
26476 @item overload-choice
26477 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
26478
26479 @findex pre-query annotation
26480 @findex query annotation
26481 @findex post-query annotation
26482 @item query
26483 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
26484
26485 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
26486 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
26487 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
26488 @item prompt-for-continue
26489 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
26490 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
26491 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
26492 presence of annotations.
26493 @end table
26494
26495 @node Errors
26496 @section Errors
26497 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
26498
26499 @findex quit annotation
26500 @smallexample
26501 ^Z^Zquit
26502 @end smallexample
26503
26504 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
26505
26506 @findex error annotation
26507 @smallexample
26508 ^Z^Zerror
26509 @end smallexample
26510
26511 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
26512
26513 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
26514 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
26515 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
26516 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
26517 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
26518 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
26519 to the top level.
26520
26521 @findex error-begin annotation
26522 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
26523
26524 @smallexample
26525 ^Z^Zerror-begin
26526 @end smallexample
26527
26528 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
26529 message.
26530
26531 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
26532 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
26533 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
26534
26535 @node Invalidation
26536 @section Invalidation Notices
26537
26538 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
26539 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
26540 changed.
26541
26542 @table @code
26543 @findex frames-invalid annotation
26544 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
26545
26546 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
26547 have changed.
26548
26549 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
26550 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
26551
26552 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
26553 deleted a breakpoint.
26554 @end table
26555
26556 @node Annotations for Running
26557 @section Running the Program
26558 @cindex annotations for running programs
26559
26560 @findex starting annotation
26561 @findex stopping annotation
26562 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
26563 @code{step} or @code{continue},
26564
26565 @smallexample
26566 ^Z^Zstarting
26567 @end smallexample
26568
26569 is output. When the program stops,
26570
26571 @smallexample
26572 ^Z^Zstopped
26573 @end smallexample
26574
26575 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
26576 annotations describe how the program stopped.
26577
26578 @table @code
26579 @findex exited annotation
26580 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
26581 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
26582 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
26583
26584 @findex signalled annotation
26585 @findex signal-name annotation
26586 @findex signal-name-end annotation
26587 @findex signal-string annotation
26588 @findex signal-string-end annotation
26589 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
26590 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
26591 annotation continues:
26592
26593 @smallexample
26594 @var{intro-text}
26595 ^Z^Zsignal-name
26596 @var{name}
26597 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
26598 @var{middle-text}
26599 ^Z^Zsignal-string
26600 @var{string}
26601 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
26602 @var{end-text}
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 @noindent
26606 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
26607 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
26608 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
26609 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
26610 user's benefit and have no particular format.
26611
26612 @findex signal annotation
26613 @item ^Z^Zsignal
26614 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
26615 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
26616 terminated with it.
26617
26618 @findex breakpoint annotation
26619 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
26620 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
26621
26622 @findex watchpoint annotation
26623 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
26624 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
26625 @end table
26626
26627 @node Source Annotations
26628 @section Displaying Source
26629 @cindex annotations for source display
26630
26631 @findex source annotation
26632 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
26633
26634 @smallexample
26635 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
26636 @end smallexample
26637
26638 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
26639 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
26640 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
26641 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
26642 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
26643 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
26644 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
26645 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
26646 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
26647 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
26648 depend on the language).
26649
26650 @node JIT Interface
26651 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
26652 @cindex just-in-time compilation
26653 @cindex JIT compilation interface
26654
26655 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
26656 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
26657 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
26658 performance while maintaining platform independence.
26659
26660 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
26661 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
26662 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
26663 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
26664 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
26665 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
26666
26667 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
26668 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
26669 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
26670 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
26671 LLVM JIT.
26672
26673 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
26674 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
26675 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
26676 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
26677 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
26678 out about additional code.
26679
26680 @menu
26681 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
26682 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
26683 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
26684 @end menu
26685
26686 @node Declarations
26687 @section JIT Declarations
26688
26689 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
26690 implement the interface:
26691
26692 @smallexample
26693 typedef enum
26694 @{
26695 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
26696 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
26697 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
26698 @} jit_actions_t;
26699
26700 struct jit_code_entry
26701 @{
26702 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
26703 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
26704 const char *symfile_addr;
26705 uint64_t symfile_size;
26706 @};
26707
26708 struct jit_descriptor
26709 @{
26710 uint32_t version;
26711 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
26712 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
26713 uint32_t action_flag;
26714 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
26715 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
26716 @};
26717
26718 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
26719 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
26720
26721 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
26722 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
26723 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
26724 @end smallexample
26725
26726 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
26727 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
26728 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
26729
26730 @node Registering Code
26731 @section Registering Code
26732
26733 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
26734
26735 @itemize @bullet
26736 @item
26737 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
26738 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
26739
26740 @item
26741 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
26742 file.
26743
26744 @item
26745 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
26746
26747 @item
26748 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
26749
26750 @item
26751 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
26752 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
26753 @end itemize
26754
26755 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
26756 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
26757 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
26758 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
26759
26760 @node Unregistering Code
26761 @section Unregistering Code
26762
26763 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
26764
26765 @itemize @bullet
26766 @item
26767 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
26768
26769 @item
26770 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
26771
26772 @item
26773 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
26774 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
26775 @end itemize
26776
26777 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
26778 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
26779
26780 @node GDB Bugs
26781 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
26782 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
26783 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
26784
26785 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
26786
26787 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
26788 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
26789 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
26790 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
26791
26792 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
26793 information that enables us to fix the bug.
26794
26795 @menu
26796 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
26797 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
26798 @end menu
26799
26800 @node Bug Criteria
26801 @section Have You Found a Bug?
26802 @cindex bug criteria
26803
26804 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
26805
26806 @itemize @bullet
26807 @cindex fatal signal
26808 @cindex debugger crash
26809 @cindex crash of debugger
26810 @item
26811 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
26812 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
26813
26814 @cindex error on valid input
26815 @item
26816 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
26817 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
26818 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
26819
26820 @cindex invalid input
26821 @item
26822 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
26823 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
26824 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
26825 for traditional practice''.
26826
26827 @item
26828 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
26829 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
26830 @end itemize
26831
26832 @node Bug Reporting
26833 @section How to Report Bugs
26834 @cindex bug reports
26835 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
26836
26837 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
26838 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
26839 contact that organization first.
26840
26841 You can find contact information for many support companies and
26842 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
26843 distribution.
26844 @c should add a web page ref...
26845
26846 @ifset BUGURL
26847 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
26848 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
26849 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
26850 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
26851 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
26852 be used.
26853
26854 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
26855 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
26856 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
26857 @samp{bug-gdb}.
26858
26859 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
26860 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
26861 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
26862 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
26863 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
26864 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
26865 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
26866 bug reports to the mailing list.
26867 @end ifset
26868 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
26869 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
26870 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
26871 @end ifclear
26872 @end ifset
26873
26874 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
26875 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
26876 fact or leave it out, state it!
26877
26878 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
26879 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
26880 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
26881 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
26882 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
26883 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
26884 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
26885 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
26886 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
26887
26888 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
26889 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
26890 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
26891 self-contained.
26892
26893 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
26894 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
26895 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
26896 bugs properly.
26897
26898 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
26899
26900 @itemize @bullet
26901 @item
26902 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
26903 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
26904 version}.
26905
26906 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
26907 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
26908
26909 @item
26910 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
26911 version number.
26912
26913 @item
26914 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
26915 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
26916
26917 @item
26918 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
26919 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
26920 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
26921 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
26922 those compilers.
26923
26924 @item
26925 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
26926 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
26927 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
26928 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
26929
26930 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
26931 and then we might not encounter the bug.
26932
26933 @item
26934 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
26935 reproduce the bug.
26936
26937 @item
26938 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
26939 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
26940
26941 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
26942 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
26943 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
26944 a chance to make a mistake.
26945
26946 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
26947 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
26948 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
26949 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
26950 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
26951 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
26952 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
26953 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
26954
26955 @pindex script
26956 @cindex recording a session script
26957 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
26958 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
26959 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
26960 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
26961
26962 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
26963 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
26964
26965 @item
26966 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
26967 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
26968 it by context, not by line number.
26969
26970 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
26971 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
26972
26973 @end itemize
26974
26975 Here are some things that are not necessary:
26976
26977 @itemize @bullet
26978 @item
26979 A description of the envelope of the bug.
26980
26981 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
26982 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
26983 changes will not affect it.
26984
26985 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
26986 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
26987 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
26988 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
26989
26990 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
26991 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
26992 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
26993 less time, and so on.
26994
26995 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
26996 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
26997
26998 @item
26999 A patch for the bug.
27000
27001 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
27002 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
27003 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
27004 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
27005
27006 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
27007 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
27008 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
27009 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
27010
27011 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
27012 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
27013 help us to understand.
27014
27015 @item
27016 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
27017
27018 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
27019 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
27020 @end itemize
27021
27022 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
27023 @c and consists of the two following files:
27024 @c rluser.texinfo
27025 @c inc-hist.texinfo
27026 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
27027 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
27028 @include rluser.texi
27029 @include inc-hist.texinfo
27030
27031
27032 @node Formatting Documentation
27033 @appendix Formatting Documentation
27034
27035 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
27036 @cindex reference card
27037 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
27038 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
27039 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
27040 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
27041 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
27042 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
27043
27044 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
27045 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
27046
27047 @smallexample
27048 make refcard.dvi
27049 @end smallexample
27050
27051 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
27052 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
27053 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
27054 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
27055 your @sc{dvi} output program.
27056
27057 @cindex documentation
27058
27059 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
27060 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
27061 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
27062 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
27063 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
27064 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
27065
27066 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
27067 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
27068 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
27069 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
27070 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
27071 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
27072 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
27073 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
27074
27075 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
27076 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
27077 @code{makeinfo}.
27078
27079 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
27080 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
27081 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
27082
27083 @smallexample
27084 cd gdb
27085 make gdb.info
27086 @end smallexample
27087
27088 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
27089 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
27090 Texinfo definitions file.
27091
27092 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
27093 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
27094 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
27095 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
27096 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
27097 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
27098 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
27099
27100 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
27101 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
27102 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
27103 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
27104 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
27105 directory.
27106
27107 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
27108 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
27109 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
27110 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
27111
27112 @smallexample
27113 make gdb.dvi
27114 @end smallexample
27115
27116 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
27117
27118 @node Installing GDB
27119 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
27120 @cindex installation
27121
27122 @menu
27123 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
27124 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
27125 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
27126 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
27127 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
27128 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
27129 @end menu
27130
27131 @node Requirements
27132 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
27133 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
27134
27135 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
27136 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
27137
27138 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
27139 @table @asis
27140 @item ISO C90 compiler
27141 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
27142 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
27143
27144 @end table
27145
27146 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
27147 @table @asis
27148 @item Expat
27149 @anchor{Expat}
27150 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
27151 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
27152 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
27153 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
27154 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
27155 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
27156
27157 Expat is used for:
27158
27159 @itemize @bullet
27160 @item
27161 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
27162 @item
27163 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
27164 @item
27165 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
27166 @item
27167 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
27168 @end itemize
27169
27170 @item zlib
27171 @cindex compressed debug sections
27172 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
27173 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
27174 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
27175 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
27176 information in such binaries.
27177
27178 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
27179 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
27180 @url{http://zlib.net}.
27181
27182 @item iconv
27183 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
27184 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
27185 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
27186 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
27187
27188 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
27189 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
27190 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
27191
27192 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
27193 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
27194 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
27195 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
27196 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
27197 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
27198 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
27199 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
27200 @end table
27201
27202 @node Running Configure
27203 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
27204 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
27205 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
27206 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
27207 build the @code{gdb} program.
27208 @iftex
27209 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
27210 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
27211 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
27212 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
27213 @end iftex
27214
27215 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
27216 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
27217 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
27218
27219 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
27220 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
27221
27222 @table @code
27223 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
27224 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
27225
27226 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
27227 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
27228
27229 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
27230 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
27231
27232 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
27233 @sc{gnu} include files
27234
27235 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
27236 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
27237
27238 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
27239 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
27240
27241 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
27242 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
27243
27244 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
27245 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
27246
27247 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
27248 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
27249 @end table
27250
27251 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
27252 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
27253 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
27254
27255 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
27256 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
27257 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
27258 argument.
27259
27260 For example:
27261
27262 @smallexample
27263 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
27264 ./configure @var{host}
27265 make
27266 @end smallexample
27267
27268 @noindent
27269 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
27270 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
27271 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
27272 correct value by examining your system.)
27273
27274 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
27275 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
27276 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
27277 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
27278
27279 @need 750
27280 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
27281 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
27282 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
27283
27284 @smallexample
27285 sh configure @var{host}
27286 @end smallexample
27287
27288 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
27289 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
27290 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
27291 @file{configure}
27292 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
27293 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
27294
27295 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
27296 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
27297 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
27298 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
27299 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
27300 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
27301 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
27302 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
27303 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
27304
27305 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
27306 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
27307 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
27308 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
27309 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
27310
27311 @node Separate Objdir
27312 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
27313
27314 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
27315 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
27316 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
27317 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
27318 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
27319 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
27320 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
27321 program specified there.
27322
27323 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
27324 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
27325 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
27326 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
27327 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
27328 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
27329
27330 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
27331 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
27332
27333 @smallexample
27334 @group
27335 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
27336 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
27337 cd ../gdb-sun4
27338 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
27339 make
27340 @end group
27341 @end smallexample
27342
27343 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
27344 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
27345 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
27346 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
27347 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
27348 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
27349
27350 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
27351 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
27352 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
27353 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
27354 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
27355
27356 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
27357 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
27358 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
27359 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
27360 You specify a cross-debugging target by
27361 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
27362
27363 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
27364 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
27365 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
27366
27367 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
27368 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
27369 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
27370 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
27371 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
27372
27373 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
27374 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
27375 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
27376 with each other.
27377
27378 @node Config Names
27379 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
27380
27381 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
27382 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
27383 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
27384 of information in the following pattern:
27385
27386 @smallexample
27387 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
27388 @end smallexample
27389
27390 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
27391 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
27392 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
27393
27394 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
27395 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
27396 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
27397 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
27398 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
27399 abbreviations---for example:
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 % sh config.sub i386-linux
27403 i386-pc-linux-gnu
27404 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
27405 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
27406 % sh config.sub hp9k700
27407 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
27408 % sh config.sub sun4
27409 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
27410 % sh config.sub sun3
27411 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
27412 % sh config.sub i986v
27413 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
27414 @end smallexample
27415
27416 @noindent
27417 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
27418 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
27419
27420 @node Configure Options
27421 @section @file{configure} Options
27422
27423 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
27424 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
27425 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
27426 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
27427
27428 @smallexample
27429 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
27430 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
27431 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
27432 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
27433 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
27434 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
27435 @var{host}
27436 @end smallexample
27437
27438 @noindent
27439 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
27440 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
27441 @samp{--}.
27442
27443 @table @code
27444 @item --help
27445 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
27446
27447 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
27448 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
27449 @file{@var{dir}}.
27450
27451 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
27452 Configure the source to install programs under directory
27453 @file{@var{dir}}.
27454
27455 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
27456 @need 2000
27457 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
27458 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
27459 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
27460 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
27461 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
27462 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
27463 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
27464 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
27465 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
27466 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
27467 @var{dirname}.
27468
27469 @item --norecursion
27470 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
27471 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
27472
27473 @item --target=@var{target}
27474 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
27475 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
27476 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
27477
27478 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
27479
27480 @item @var{host} @dots{}
27481 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
27482
27483 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
27484 @end table
27485
27486 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
27487 needed for special purposes only.
27488
27489 @node System-wide configuration
27490 @section System-wide configuration and settings
27491 @cindex system-wide init file
27492
27493 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
27494 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
27495 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
27496
27497 Here is the corresponding configure option:
27498
27499 @table @code
27500 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
27501 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
27502 @var{file}.
27503 @end table
27504
27505 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
27506 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
27507
27508 @itemize @bullet
27509 @item
27510 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
27511 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
27512 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
27513 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
27514 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
27515 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
27516
27517 @item
27518 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
27519 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
27520 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
27521 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
27522 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
27523 @end itemize
27524
27525 @node Maintenance Commands
27526 @appendix Maintenance Commands
27527 @cindex maintenance commands
27528 @cindex internal commands
27529
27530 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
27531 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
27532 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
27533 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
27534 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
27535
27536 @table @code
27537 @kindex maint agent
27538 @kindex maint agent-eval
27539 @item maint agent @var{expression}
27540 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
27541 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
27542 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
27543 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
27544 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
27545 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
27546 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
27547 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
27548 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
27549 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
27550 addition and return the sum.
27551
27552 @kindex maint info breakpoints
27553 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
27554 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
27555 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
27556 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
27557 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
27558 is shown:
27559
27560 @table @code
27561 @item breakpoint
27562 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
27563
27564 @item watchpoint
27565 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
27566
27567 @item longjmp
27568 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
27569 @code{longjmp} calls.
27570
27571 @item longjmp resume
27572 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
27573
27574 @item until
27575 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
27576
27577 @item finish
27578 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
27579
27580 @item shlib events
27581 Shared library events.
27582
27583 @end table
27584
27585 @kindex set displaced-stepping
27586 @kindex show displaced-stepping
27587 @cindex displaced stepping support
27588 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
27589 @item set displaced-stepping
27590 @itemx show displaced-stepping
27591 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
27592 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
27593 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
27594 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
27595 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
27596
27597 @table @code
27598 @item set displaced-stepping on
27599 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
27600 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
27601
27602 @item set displaced-stepping off
27603 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
27604 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
27605
27606 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
27607 @item set displaced-stepping auto
27608 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
27609 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
27610 architecture supports displaced stepping.
27611 @end table
27612
27613 @kindex maint check-symtabs
27614 @item maint check-symtabs
27615 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
27616
27617 @kindex maint cplus first_component
27618 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
27619 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
27620
27621 @kindex maint cplus namespace
27622 @item maint cplus namespace
27623 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
27624
27625 @kindex maint demangle
27626 @item maint demangle @var{name}
27627 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
27628
27629 @kindex maint deprecate
27630 @kindex maint undeprecate
27631 @cindex deprecated commands
27632 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
27633 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
27634 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
27635 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
27636 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
27637 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
27638 the replacement as part of the warning.
27639
27640 @kindex maint dump-me
27641 @item maint dump-me
27642 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
27643 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
27644 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
27645 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
27646
27647 @kindex maint internal-error
27648 @kindex maint internal-warning
27649 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
27650 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
27651 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
27652 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
27653 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
27654 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
27655 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
27656 @value{GDBN} session.
27657
27658 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
27659 used as the text of the error or warning message.
27660
27661 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
27662
27663 @smallexample
27664 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
27665 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
27666 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
27667 debugging may prove unreliable.
27668 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
27669 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
27670 (@value{GDBP})
27671 @end smallexample
27672
27673 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
27674 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
27675
27676 @kindex maint set internal-error
27677 @kindex maint show internal-error
27678 @kindex maint set internal-warning
27679 @kindex maint show internal-warning
27680 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
27681 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
27682 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
27683 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
27684 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
27685 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
27686 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
27687 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
27688 described in the table below.
27689
27690 @table @samp
27691 @item quit
27692 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
27693 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
27694
27695 @item corefile
27696 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
27697 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
27698 @end table
27699
27700 @kindex maint packet
27701 @item maint packet @var{text}
27702 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
27703 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
27704 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
27705 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
27706 checksum.
27707
27708 @kindex maint print architecture
27709 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27710 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
27711 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
27712
27713 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
27714 @item maint print c-tdesc
27715 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
27716 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
27717 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
27718
27719 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
27720 @item maint print dummy-frames
27721 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
27722
27723 @smallexample
27724 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
27725 @dots{}
27726 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
27727 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
27728 58 return (a + b);
27729 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
27730 @dots{}
27731 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
27732 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
27733 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
27734 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
27735 (@value{GDBP})
27736 @end smallexample
27737
27738 Takes an optional file parameter.
27739
27740 @kindex maint print registers
27741 @kindex maint print raw-registers
27742 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
27743 @kindex maint print register-groups
27744 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27745 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27746 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27747 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27748 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
27749
27750 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
27751 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
27752 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
27753 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
27754 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
27755 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
27756
27757 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
27758 write the information.
27759
27760 @kindex maint print reggroups
27761 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27762 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
27763 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
27764 information.
27765
27766 The register groups info looks like this:
27767
27768 @smallexample
27769 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
27770 Group Type
27771 general user
27772 float user
27773 all user
27774 vector user
27775 system user
27776 save internal
27777 restore internal
27778 @end smallexample
27779
27780 @kindex flushregs
27781 @item flushregs
27782 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
27783
27784 @kindex maint print objfiles
27785 @cindex info for known object files
27786 @item maint print objfiles
27787 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
27788 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
27789 and symtabs.
27790
27791 @kindex maint print statistics
27792 @cindex bcache statistics
27793 @item maint print statistics
27794 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
27795 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
27796 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
27797 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
27798 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
27799 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
27800 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
27801 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
27802 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
27803 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
27804 lengths.
27805
27806 @kindex maint print target-stack
27807 @cindex target stack description
27808 @item maint print target-stack
27809 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
27810 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
27811 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
27812 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
27813 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
27814 address.
27815
27816 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
27817 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
27818
27819 @kindex maint print type
27820 @cindex type chain of a data type
27821 @item maint print type @var{expr}
27822 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
27823 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
27824 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
27825 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
27826 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
27827
27828 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
27829 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
27830 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
27831 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
27832 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
27833
27834 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
27835 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
27836 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
27837 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
27838 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
27839 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
27840 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
27841 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
27842 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
27843
27844 @kindex maint set profile
27845 @kindex maint show profile
27846 @cindex profiling GDB
27847 @item maint set profile
27848 @itemx maint show profile
27849 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
27850
27851 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
27852 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
27853 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
27854 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
27855 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
27856 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
27857 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
27858
27859 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
27860 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
27861
27862 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
27863 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
27864 @cindex hardware debug registers
27865 @item maint set show-debug-regs
27866 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
27867 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
27868 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
27869 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
27870 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
27871 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
27872
27873 @kindex maint space
27874 @cindex memory used by commands
27875 @item maint space
27876 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
27877 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
27878 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
27879 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
27880 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
27881
27882 @kindex maint time
27883 @cindex time of command execution
27884 @item maint time
27885 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
27886 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
27887 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
27888 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
27889 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
27890 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
27891 it's not possibly currently
27892 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
27893 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
27894
27895 @kindex maint translate-address
27896 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
27897 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
27898 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
27899 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
27900 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
27901 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
27902 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
27903
27904 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
27905 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
27906 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
27907
27908 @end table
27909
27910 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
27911 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
27912
27913 @table @code
27914 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
27915 @kindex set watchdog
27916 @cindex watchdog timer
27917 @cindex timeout for commands
27918 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
27919 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
27920 reports and error and the command is aborted.
27921
27922 @item show watchdog
27923 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
27924 @end table
27925
27926 @node Remote Protocol
27927 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
27928
27929 @menu
27930 * Overview::
27931 * Packets::
27932 * Stop Reply Packets::
27933 * General Query Packets::
27934 * Register Packet Format::
27935 * Tracepoint Packets::
27936 * Host I/O Packets::
27937 * Interrupts::
27938 * Notification Packets::
27939 * Remote Non-Stop::
27940 * Packet Acknowledgment::
27941 * Examples::
27942 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
27943 * Library List Format::
27944 * Memory Map Format::
27945 @end menu
27946
27947 @node Overview
27948 @section Overview
27949
27950 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
27951 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
27952 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
27953 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
27954
27955 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
27956 transmitted and received data, respectively.
27957
27958 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
27959 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
27960 @cindex remote serial protocol
27961 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
27962 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
27963 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
27964 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
27965 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
27966
27967 @smallexample
27968 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
27969 @end smallexample
27970 @noindent
27971
27972 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
27973 @noindent
27974 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
27975 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
27976 eight bit unsigned checksum).
27977
27978 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
27979 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
27980
27981 @smallexample
27982 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
27983 @end smallexample
27984
27985 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
27986 @noindent
27987 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
27988 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
27989 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
27990
27991 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
27992 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
27993 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
27994 retransmission):
27995
27996 @smallexample
27997 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
27998 <- @code{+}
27999 @end smallexample
28000 @noindent
28001
28002 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
28003 once a connection is established.
28004 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
28005
28006 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
28007 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
28008 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
28009 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
28010 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
28011 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
28012 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
28013
28014 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
28015 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
28016 exceptions).
28017
28018 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
28019 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
28020 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
28021 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
28022
28023 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
28024 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
28025 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
28026
28027 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
28028 @anchor{Binary Data}
28029 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
28030 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
28031 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
28032 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
28033 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
28034 binary data.
28035
28036 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
28037 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
28038 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
28039 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
28040 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
28041 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
28042 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
28043 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
28044 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
28045 (described next).
28046
28047 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
28048 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
28049 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
28050 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
28051 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
28052 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
28053 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
28054 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
28055 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
28056 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
28057 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
28058 3}} more times.
28059
28060 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
28061 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
28062 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
28063 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
28064 @samp{0*"00}.
28065
28066 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
28067 error number. That number is not well defined.
28068
28069 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
28070 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
28071 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
28072 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
28073 on that response.
28074
28075 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
28076 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
28077 optional.
28078
28079 @node Packets
28080 @section Packets
28081
28082 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
28083 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
28084 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
28085 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
28086
28087 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
28088 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
28089 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
28090 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
28091 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
28092 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
28093 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
28094 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
28095 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
28096 @var{baz}.
28097
28098 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
28099 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
28100 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
28101 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
28102 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
28103 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
28104 pick any thread.
28105
28106 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
28107 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
28108 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
28109 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
28110 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
28111 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
28112 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
28113 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
28114 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
28115 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
28116 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
28117 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
28118 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
28119
28120 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
28121 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
28122 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
28123 more information.
28124
28125 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
28126 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
28127
28128 Here are the packet descriptions.
28129
28130 @table @samp
28131
28132 @item !
28133 @cindex @samp{!} packet
28134 @anchor{extended mode}
28135 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
28136 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
28137 debugged.
28138
28139 Reply:
28140 @table @samp
28141 @item OK
28142 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
28143 @end table
28144
28145 @item ?
28146 @cindex @samp{?} packet
28147 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
28148 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
28149 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
28150
28151 Reply:
28152 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28153
28154 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
28155 @cindex @samp{A} packet
28156 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
28157 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
28158 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
28159
28160 Reply:
28161 @table @samp
28162 @item OK
28163 The arguments were set.
28164 @item E @var{NN}
28165 An error occurred.
28166 @end table
28167
28168 @item b @var{baud}
28169 @cindex @samp{b} packet
28170 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
28171 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
28172
28173 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
28174 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
28175 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
28176
28177 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
28178 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
28179 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
28180 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
28181 of view, nothing actually happened.}
28182
28183 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
28184 @cindex @samp{B} packet
28185 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
28186 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
28187
28188 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
28189 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
28190
28191 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
28192 @anchor{bc}
28193 @item bc
28194 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
28195 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
28196
28197 Reply:
28198 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28199
28200 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
28201 @anchor{bs}
28202 @item bs
28203 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
28204 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
28205
28206 Reply:
28207 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28208
28209 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
28210 @cindex @samp{c} packet
28211 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
28212 resume at current address.
28213
28214 Reply:
28215 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28216
28217 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
28218 @cindex @samp{C} packet
28219 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
28220 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
28221
28222 Reply:
28223 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28224
28225 @item d
28226 @cindex @samp{d} packet
28227 Toggle debug flag.
28228
28229 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
28230 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
28231
28232 @item D
28233 @itemx D;@var{pid}
28234 @cindex @samp{D} packet
28235 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
28236 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
28237 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
28238
28239 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
28240 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
28241 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
28242 big-endian hex string.
28243
28244 Reply:
28245 @table @samp
28246 @item OK
28247 for success
28248 @item E @var{NN}
28249 for an error
28250 @end table
28251
28252 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
28253 @cindex @samp{F} packet
28254 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
28255 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
28256 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
28257
28258 @item g
28259 @anchor{read registers packet}
28260 @cindex @samp{g} packet
28261 Read general registers.
28262
28263 Reply:
28264 @table @samp
28265 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
28266 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
28267 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
28268 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
28269 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
28270 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
28271 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
28272 @item E @var{NN}
28273 for an error.
28274 @end table
28275
28276 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
28277 @cindex @samp{G} packet
28278 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
28279 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
28280
28281 Reply:
28282 @table @samp
28283 @item OK
28284 for success
28285 @item E @var{NN}
28286 for an error
28287 @end table
28288
28289 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
28290 @cindex @samp{H} packet
28291 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
28292 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
28293 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
28294 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
28295 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28296
28297 Reply:
28298 @table @samp
28299 @item OK
28300 for success
28301 @item E @var{NN}
28302 for an error
28303 @end table
28304
28305 @c FIXME: JTC:
28306 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
28307 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
28308 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
28309 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
28310 @c described. For example:
28311 @c
28312 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
28313 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
28314 @c otherwise returns current registers.
28315 @c
28316 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
28317 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
28318 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
28319
28320 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
28321 @anchor{cycle step packet}
28322 @cindex @samp{i} packet
28323 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
28324 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
28325 step starting at that address.
28326
28327 @item I
28328 @cindex @samp{I} packet
28329 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
28330 step packet}.
28331
28332 @item k
28333 @cindex @samp{k} packet
28334 Kill request.
28335
28336 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
28337 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
28338 thread?)}.
28339
28340 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
28341 @cindex @samp{m} packet
28342 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
28343 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
28344
28345 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
28346 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
28347 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
28348 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
28349 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
28350 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
28351 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
28352 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
28353
28354 Reply:
28355 @table @samp
28356 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
28357 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
28358 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
28359 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
28360 @item E @var{NN}
28361 @var{NN} is errno
28362 @end table
28363
28364 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
28365 @cindex @samp{M} packet
28366 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
28367 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
28368 hexadecimal number.
28369
28370 Reply:
28371 @table @samp
28372 @item OK
28373 for success
28374 @item E @var{NN}
28375 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
28376 written).
28377 @end table
28378
28379 @item p @var{n}
28380 @cindex @samp{p} packet
28381 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
28382 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
28383 register value is encoded.
28384
28385 Reply:
28386 @table @samp
28387 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
28388 the register's value
28389 @item E @var{NN}
28390 for an error
28391 @item
28392 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
28393 @end table
28394
28395 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
28396 @anchor{write register packet}
28397 @cindex @samp{P} packet
28398 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
28399 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
28400 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
28401
28402 Reply:
28403 @table @samp
28404 @item OK
28405 for success
28406 @item E @var{NN}
28407 for an error
28408 @end table
28409
28410 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
28411 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
28412 @cindex @samp{q} packet
28413 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
28414 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
28415 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
28416
28417 @item r
28418 @cindex @samp{r} packet
28419 Reset the entire system.
28420
28421 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
28422
28423 @item R @var{XX}
28424 @cindex @samp{R} packet
28425 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
28426 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
28427
28428 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
28429
28430 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
28431 @cindex @samp{s} packet
28432 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
28433 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
28434
28435 Reply:
28436 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28437
28438 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
28439 @anchor{step with signal packet}
28440 @cindex @samp{S} packet
28441 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
28442 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
28443
28444 Reply:
28445 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28446
28447 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
28448 @cindex @samp{t} packet
28449 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
28450 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
28451 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
28452
28453 @item T @var{thread-id}
28454 @cindex @samp{T} packet
28455 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
28456
28457 Reply:
28458 @table @samp
28459 @item OK
28460 thread is still alive
28461 @item E @var{NN}
28462 thread is dead
28463 @end table
28464
28465 @item v
28466 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
28467 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
28468
28469 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
28470 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
28471 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
28472 The process ID is a
28473 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
28474 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
28475 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
28476
28477 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
28478 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
28479 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
28480 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
28481 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
28482 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
28483 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
28484 @c stopping or restarting threads.
28485
28486 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
28487
28488 Reply:
28489 @table @samp
28490 @item E @var{nn}
28491 for an error
28492 @item @r{Any stop packet}
28493 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
28494 @item OK
28495 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
28496 @end table
28497
28498 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
28499 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
28500 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
28501 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
28502 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
28503 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
28504 in their current state in non-stop mode.
28505 Specifying multiple
28506 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
28507 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28508
28509 Currently supported actions are:
28510
28511 @table @samp
28512 @item c
28513 Continue.
28514 @item C @var{sig}
28515 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
28516 @item s
28517 Step.
28518 @item S @var{sig}
28519 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
28520 @item t
28521 Stop.
28522 @end table
28523
28524 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
28525 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
28526 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
28527
28528 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
28529 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
28530 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
28531 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
28532 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
28533 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
28534 as an implementation detail.
28535
28536 Reply:
28537 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
28538
28539 @item vCont?
28540 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
28541 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
28542
28543 Reply:
28544 @table @samp
28545 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
28546 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
28547 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
28548 @item
28549 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
28550 @end table
28551
28552 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
28553 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
28554 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
28555 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
28556
28557 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
28558 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
28559 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
28560 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
28561 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
28562 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
28563 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
28564 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
28565 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
28566 packet is received.
28567
28568 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
28569 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
28570 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
28571 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
28572 @var{thread-id}.
28573
28574 Reply:
28575 @table @samp
28576 @item OK
28577 for success
28578 @item E @var{NN}
28579 for an error
28580 @end table
28581
28582 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
28583 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
28584 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
28585 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
28586 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
28587 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
28588 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
28589 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
28590 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
28591 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
28592 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
28593 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
28594
28595
28596 Reply:
28597 @table @samp
28598 @item OK
28599 for success
28600 @item E.memtype
28601 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
28602 @item E @var{NN}
28603 for an error
28604 @end table
28605
28606 @item vFlashDone
28607 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
28608 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
28609 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
28610 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
28611 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
28612 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
28613 request is completed.
28614
28615 @item vKill;@var{pid}
28616 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
28617 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
28618 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
28619 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
28620 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
28621
28622 Reply:
28623 @table @samp
28624 @item E @var{nn}
28625 for an error
28626 @item OK
28627 for success
28628 @end table
28629
28630 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
28631 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
28632 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
28633 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
28634 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
28635 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
28636 state.
28637
28638 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
28639
28640 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
28641
28642 Reply:
28643 @table @samp
28644 @item E @var{nn}
28645 for an error
28646 @item @r{Any stop packet}
28647 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
28648 @end table
28649
28650 @item vStopped
28651 @anchor{vStopped packet}
28652 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
28653
28654 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
28655 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
28656
28657 Reply:
28658 @table @samp
28659 @item @r{Any stop packet}
28660 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
28661 @item OK
28662 if there are no unreported stop events
28663 @end table
28664
28665 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
28666 @anchor{X packet}
28667 @cindex @samp{X} packet
28668 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
28669 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
28670 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
28671
28672 Reply:
28673 @table @samp
28674 @item OK
28675 for success
28676 @item E @var{NN}
28677 for an error
28678 @end table
28679
28680 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
28681 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
28682 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
28683 @cindex @samp{z} packet
28684 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
28685 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
28686 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
28687 @var{length} bytes.
28688
28689 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
28690 separately.
28691
28692 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
28693 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
28694 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
28695 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
28696 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
28697 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
28698
28699 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
28700 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
28701 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
28702 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
28703 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
28704 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
28705
28706 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
28707 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
28708 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
28709 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
28710 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
28711
28712 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
28713 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
28714 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
28715 target, is not defined.}
28716
28717 Reply:
28718 @table @samp
28719 @item OK
28720 success
28721 @item
28722 not supported
28723 @item E @var{NN}
28724 for an error
28725 @end table
28726
28727 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
28728 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
28729 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
28730 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
28731 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
28732 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
28733
28734 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
28735 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
28736
28737 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
28738 movement.}
28739
28740 Reply:
28741 @table @samp
28742 @item OK
28743 success
28744 @item
28745 not supported
28746 @item E @var{NN}
28747 for an error
28748 @end table
28749
28750 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
28751 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
28752 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
28753 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
28754 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
28755
28756 Reply:
28757 @table @samp
28758 @item OK
28759 success
28760 @item
28761 not supported
28762 @item E @var{NN}
28763 for an error
28764 @end table
28765
28766 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
28767 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
28768 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
28769 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
28770 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
28771
28772 Reply:
28773 @table @samp
28774 @item OK
28775 success
28776 @item
28777 not supported
28778 @item E @var{NN}
28779 for an error
28780 @end table
28781
28782 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
28783 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
28784 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
28785 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
28786 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
28787
28788 Reply:
28789 @table @samp
28790 @item OK
28791 success
28792 @item
28793 not supported
28794 @item E @var{NN}
28795 for an error
28796 @end table
28797
28798 @end table
28799
28800 @node Stop Reply Packets
28801 @section Stop Reply Packets
28802 @cindex stop reply packets
28803
28804 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
28805 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
28806 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
28807 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
28808 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
28809 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
28810 @value{GDBN} source code.
28811
28812 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
28813 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
28814 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
28815 components.
28816
28817 @table @samp
28818
28819 @item S @var{AA}
28820 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
28821 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
28822 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
28823
28824 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
28825 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
28826 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
28827 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
28828 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
28829 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
28830 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
28831 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
28832
28833 @itemize @bullet
28834 @item
28835 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
28836 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
28837 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
28838 two-digit hex number.
28839
28840 @item
28841 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
28842 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28843
28844 @item
28845 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
28846 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
28847 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
28848 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
28849
28850 @item
28851 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
28852 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
28853 future.
28854 @end itemize
28855
28856 The currently defined stop reasons are:
28857
28858 @table @samp
28859 @item watch
28860 @itemx rwatch
28861 @itemx awatch
28862 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
28863 hex.
28864
28865 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
28866 @item library
28867 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
28868 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
28869 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
28870
28871 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
28872 @item replaylog
28873 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
28874 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
28875 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
28876 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
28877 for more information.
28878
28879
28880 @end table
28881
28882 @item W @var{AA}
28883 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
28884 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
28885 applicable to certain targets.
28886
28887 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
28888 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
28889 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
28890 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
28891
28892 @item X @var{AA}
28893 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
28894 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
28895
28896 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
28897 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
28898 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
28899 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
28900
28901 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
28902 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
28903 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
28904 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
28905 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
28906
28907 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
28908 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
28909 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
28910 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
28911 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
28912 system calls.
28913
28914 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
28915 this very system call.
28916
28917 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
28918 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
28919 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
28920 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
28921 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
28922 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
28923
28924 @end table
28925
28926 @node General Query Packets
28927 @section General Query Packets
28928 @cindex remote query requests
28929
28930 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
28931 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
28932 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
28933 sending information to and from the stub.
28934
28935 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
28936 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
28937 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
28938 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
28939 conventions:
28940
28941 @itemize @bullet
28942 @item
28943 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
28944 @item
28945 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
28946 letter.
28947 @item
28948 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
28949 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
28950 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
28951 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
28952 @end itemize
28953
28954 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
28955 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
28956 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
28957 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
28958 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
28959 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
28960 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
28961 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
28962 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
28963 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
28964 packet.}.
28965
28966 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
28967 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
28968 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
28969 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
28970 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
28971
28972 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
28973
28974 @table @samp
28975
28976 @item qC
28977 @cindex current thread, remote request
28978 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
28979 Return the current thread ID.
28980
28981 Reply:
28982 @table @samp
28983 @item QC @var{thread-id}
28984 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
28985 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28986 @item @r{(anything else)}
28987 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
28988 @end table
28989
28990 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
28991 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
28992 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
28993 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
28994 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
28995 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
28996 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
28997
28998 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
28999 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
29000 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
29001 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
29002 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
29003 detect trailing zeros.
29004
29005 Reply:
29006 @table @samp
29007 @item E @var{NN}
29008 An error (such as memory fault)
29009 @item C @var{crc32}
29010 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
29011 @end table
29012
29013 @item qfThreadInfo
29014 @itemx qsThreadInfo
29015 @cindex list active threads, remote request
29016 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
29017 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
29018 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
29019 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
29020 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
29021 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
29022 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
29023 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
29024
29025 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
29026
29027 Reply:
29028 @table @samp
29029 @item m @var{thread-id}
29030 A single thread ID
29031 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
29032 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
29033 @item l
29034 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
29035 @end table
29036
29037 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
29038 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
29039 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
29040 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
29041 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
29042 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
29043 fields.
29044
29045 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
29046 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
29047 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
29048 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
29049 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
29050
29051 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
29052 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
29053
29054 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
29055 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
29056 information associated with the variable.)
29057
29058 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
29059 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
29060 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
29061 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
29062 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
29063 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
29064
29065 Reply:
29066 @table @samp
29067 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
29068 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
29069 local storage requested.
29070
29071 @item E @var{nn}
29072 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
29073
29074 @item
29075 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
29076 @end table
29077
29078 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
29079 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
29080 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
29081 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
29082 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
29083 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
29084 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
29085
29086 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
29087
29088 Reply:
29089 @table @samp
29090 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
29091 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
29092 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
29093 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
29094 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
29095 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
29096 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
29097 @end table
29098
29099 @item qOffsets
29100 @cindex section offsets, remote request
29101 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
29102 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
29103 image.
29104
29105 Reply:
29106 @table @samp
29107 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
29108 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
29109 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
29110 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
29111 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
29112 segments by the supplied offsets.
29113
29114 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
29115 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
29116 to the @code{Bss} section.}
29117
29118 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
29119 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
29120 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
29121 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
29122 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
29123 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
29124 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
29125 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
29126 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
29127 @end table
29128
29129 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
29130 @cindex thread information, remote request
29131 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
29132 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
29133 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
29134 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
29135
29136 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
29137 (see below).
29138
29139 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
29140
29141 @item QNonStop:1
29142 @item QNonStop:0
29143 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
29144 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
29145 @anchor{QNonStop}
29146 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
29147 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
29148
29149 Reply:
29150 @table @samp
29151 @item OK
29152 The request succeeded.
29153
29154 @item E @var{nn}
29155 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
29156
29157 @item
29158 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
29159 the stub.
29160 @end table
29161
29162 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29163 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29164 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
29165 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
29166
29167 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
29168 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
29169 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
29170 @anchor{QPassSignals}
29171 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
29172 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
29173 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
29174 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
29175 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
29176 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
29177 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
29178 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
29179 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
29180
29181 Reply:
29182 @table @samp
29183 @item OK
29184 The request succeeded.
29185
29186 @item E @var{nn}
29187 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
29188
29189 @item
29190 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
29191 the stub.
29192 @end table
29193
29194 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
29195 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
29196 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29197 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29198
29199 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
29200 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
29201 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
29202 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
29203 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
29204 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
29205 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
29206 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
29207 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
29208
29209 Reply:
29210 @table @samp
29211 @item OK
29212 A command response with no output.
29213 @item @var{OUTPUT}
29214 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
29215 @item E @var{NN}
29216 Indicate a badly formed request.
29217 @item
29218 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
29219 @end table
29220
29221 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
29222 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
29223 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
29224 packets.)
29225
29226 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
29227 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
29228 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
29229 @anchor{qSearch memory}
29230 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
29231 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
29232 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
29233
29234 Reply:
29235 @table @samp
29236 @item 0
29237 The pattern was not found.
29238 @item 1,address
29239 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
29240 @item E @var{NN}
29241 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
29242 @item
29243 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
29244 @end table
29245
29246 @item QStartNoAckMode
29247 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
29248 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
29249 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
29250 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
29251
29252 Reply:
29253 @table @samp
29254 @item OK
29255 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
29256 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
29257 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
29258 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
29259 @item
29260 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
29261 @end table
29262
29263 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
29264 @cindex supported packets, remote query
29265 @cindex features of the remote protocol
29266 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
29267 @anchor{qSupported}
29268 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
29269 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
29270 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
29271 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
29272 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
29273 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
29274 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
29275 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
29276 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
29277 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
29278 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
29279 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
29280 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
29281 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
29282
29283 Reply:
29284 @table @samp
29285 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
29286 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
29287 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
29288 possible forms).
29289 @item
29290 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
29291 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
29292 @end table
29293
29294 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
29295 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
29296 are:
29297
29298 @table @samp
29299 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
29300 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
29301 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
29302 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
29303 @item @var{name}+
29304 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
29305 need an associated value.
29306 @item @var{name}-
29307 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
29308 @item @var{name}?
29309 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
29310 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
29311 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
29312 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
29313 @end table
29314
29315 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
29316 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
29317 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
29318 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
29319 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
29320
29321 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
29322 are defined:
29323
29324 @table @samp
29325 @item multiprocess
29326 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
29327 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
29328 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
29329 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
29330 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
29331 @end table
29332
29333 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
29334 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
29335 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
29336 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
29337 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
29338 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
29339 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
29340 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
29341 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
29342 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
29343 all the features it supports.
29344
29345 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
29346 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
29347
29348 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
29349 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
29350 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
29351 form response.
29352
29353 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
29354 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
29355 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
29356 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
29357
29358 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
29359 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
29360 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
29361 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
29362 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
29363
29364 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
29365
29366 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
29367 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
29368 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
29369 @item Feature Name
29370 @tab Value Required
29371 @tab Default
29372 @tab Probe Allowed
29373
29374 @item @samp{PacketSize}
29375 @tab Yes
29376 @tab @samp{-}
29377 @tab No
29378
29379 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
29380 @tab No
29381 @tab @samp{-}
29382 @tab Yes
29383
29384 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
29385 @tab No
29386 @tab @samp{-}
29387 @tab Yes
29388
29389 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
29390 @tab No
29391 @tab @samp{-}
29392 @tab Yes
29393
29394 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
29395 @tab No
29396 @tab @samp{-}
29397 @tab Yes
29398
29399 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
29400 @tab No
29401 @tab @samp{-}
29402 @tab Yes
29403
29404 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
29405 @tab No
29406 @tab @samp{-}
29407 @tab Yes
29408
29409 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
29410 @tab No
29411 @tab @samp{-}
29412 @tab Yes
29413
29414 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
29415 @tab No
29416 @tab @samp{-}
29417 @tab Yes
29418
29419 @item @samp{QNonStop}
29420 @tab No
29421 @tab @samp{-}
29422 @tab Yes
29423
29424 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
29425 @tab No
29426 @tab @samp{-}
29427 @tab Yes
29428
29429 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
29430 @tab No
29431 @tab @samp{-}
29432 @tab Yes
29433
29434 @item @samp{multiprocess}
29435 @tab No
29436 @tab @samp{-}
29437 @tab No
29438
29439 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
29440 @tab No
29441 @tab @samp{-}
29442 @tab No
29443
29444 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
29445 @tab No
29446 @tab @samp{-}
29447 @tab No
29448
29449 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
29450 @tab No
29451 @tab @samp{-}
29452 @tab No
29453
29454 @end multitable
29455
29456 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
29457
29458 @table @samp
29459 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
29460 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
29461 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
29462 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
29463 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
29464 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
29465 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
29466 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
29467 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
29468 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
29469
29470 @item qXfer:auxv:read
29471 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
29472 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
29473
29474 @item qXfer:features:read
29475 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
29476 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
29477
29478 @item qXfer:libraries:read
29479 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
29480 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
29481
29482 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
29483 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
29484 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
29485
29486 @item qXfer:spu:read
29487 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
29488 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
29489
29490 @item qXfer:spu:write
29491 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
29492 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
29493
29494 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
29495 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
29496 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
29497
29498 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
29499 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
29500 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
29501
29502 @item QNonStop
29503 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
29504 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
29505
29506 @item QPassSignals
29507 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
29508 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
29509
29510 @item QStartNoAckMode
29511 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
29512 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
29513
29514 @item multiprocess
29515 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
29516 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
29517 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
29518 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
29519 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
29520 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
29521 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
29522 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
29523 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
29524 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
29525 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
29526
29527 @item qXfer:osdata:read
29528 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
29529 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
29530
29531 @item ConditionalTracepoints
29532 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
29533 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
29534
29535 @item ReverseContinue
29536 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
29537 (@pxref{bc}).
29538
29539 @item ReverseStep
29540 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
29541 (@pxref{bs}).
29542
29543 @end table
29544
29545 @item qSymbol::
29546 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
29547 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
29548 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
29549 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
29550
29551 Reply:
29552 @table @samp
29553 @item OK
29554 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
29555 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
29556 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
29557 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
29558 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
29559 below.
29560 @end table
29561
29562 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
29563 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
29564
29565 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
29566 target has previously requested.
29567
29568 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
29569 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
29570 will be empty.
29571
29572 Reply:
29573 @table @samp
29574 @item OK
29575 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
29576 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
29577 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
29578 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
29579 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
29580 @end table
29581
29582 @item QTDP
29583 @itemx QTFrame
29584 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
29585
29586 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
29587 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
29588 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
29589 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
29590 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
29591 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
29592 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
29593 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
29594 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
29595 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
29596 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
29597
29598 Reply:
29599 @table @samp
29600 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
29601 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
29602 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
29603 the thread's attributes.
29604 @end table
29605
29606 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
29607 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
29608 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
29609 packets.)
29610
29611 @item QTStart
29612 @itemx QTStop
29613 @itemx QTinit
29614 @itemx QTro
29615 @itemx qTStatus
29616 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
29617
29618 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
29619 @cindex read special object, remote request
29620 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
29621 @anchor{qXfer read}
29622 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
29623 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
29624 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
29625 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
29626 additional details about what data to access.
29627
29628 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
29629 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
29630 formats, listed below.
29631
29632 @table @samp
29633 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
29634 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
29635 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
29636 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
29637
29638 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29639 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29640
29641 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
29642 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
29643 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
29644 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
29645 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
29646
29647 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29648 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29649
29650 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
29651 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
29652 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
29653 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
29654 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
29655
29656 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
29657 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
29658 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
29659
29660 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29661 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29662
29663 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
29664 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
29665 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
29666 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
29667 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
29668
29669 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29670 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29671
29672 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
29673 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
29674 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
29675 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
29676 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
29677
29678 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29679 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
29680 (@pxref{qSupported}).
29681
29682 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
29683 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
29684 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
29685 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
29686 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
29687 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
29688 in that context to be accessed.
29689
29690 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29691 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
29692 (@pxref{qSupported}).
29693
29694 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
29695 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
29696 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
29697 @xref{Operating System Information}.
29698
29699 @end table
29700
29701 Reply:
29702 @table @samp
29703 @item m @var{data}
29704 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
29705 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
29706 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
29707 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
29708 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
29709 request.
29710
29711 @item l @var{data}
29712 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
29713 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
29714 than the @var{length} in the request.
29715
29716 @item l
29717 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
29718 There is no more data to be read.
29719
29720 @item E00
29721 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
29722
29723 @item E @var{nn}
29724 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
29725 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
29726
29727 @item
29728 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
29729 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
29730 @end table
29731
29732 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
29733 @cindex write data into object, remote request
29734 @anchor{qXfer write}
29735 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
29736 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
29737 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
29738 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
29739 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
29740 to access.
29741
29742 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
29743 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
29744 formats, listed below.
29745
29746 @table @samp
29747 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
29748 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
29749 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
29750 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
29751 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
29752
29753 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29754 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
29755 (@pxref{qSupported}).
29756
29757 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
29758 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
29759 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
29760 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
29761 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
29762 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
29763 in that context to be accessed.
29764
29765 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29766 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29767 @end table
29768
29769 Reply:
29770 @table @samp
29771 @item @var{nn}
29772 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
29773 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
29774
29775 @item E00
29776 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
29777
29778 @item E @var{nn}
29779 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
29780 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
29781
29782 @item
29783 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
29784 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
29785 @end table
29786
29787 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
29788 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
29789 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
29790 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
29791 must respond with an empty packet.
29792
29793 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
29794 @cindex query attached, remote request
29795 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
29796 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
29797 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
29798 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
29799 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
29800 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
29801 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
29802
29803 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
29804 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
29805 the @code{quit} command.
29806
29807 Reply:
29808 @table @samp
29809 @item 1
29810 The remote server attached to an existing process.
29811 @item 0
29812 The remote server created a new process.
29813 @item E @var{NN}
29814 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
29815 @end table
29816
29817 @end table
29818
29819 @node Register Packet Format
29820 @section Register Packet Format
29821
29822 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
29823 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
29824 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
29825 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
29826 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
29827 most-significant - least-significant.
29828
29829 @table @r
29830
29831 @item MIPS32
29832
29833 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
29834 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
29835 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
29836
29837 @item MIPS64
29838
29839 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
29840 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
29841 as @code{MIPS32}.
29842
29843 @end table
29844
29845 @node Tracepoint Packets
29846 @section Tracepoint Packets
29847 @cindex tracepoint packets
29848 @cindex packets, tracepoint
29849
29850 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
29851 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
29852
29853 @table @samp
29854
29855 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
29856 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
29857 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
29858 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
29859 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{X} is present,
29860 it introduces a tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal
29861 length, followed by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar
29862 to action encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is
29863 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
29864 tracepoint's actions.
29865
29866 Replies:
29867 @table @samp
29868 @item OK
29869 The packet was understood and carried out.
29870 @item
29871 The packet was not recognized.
29872 @end table
29873
29874 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
29875 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
29876 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
29877 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
29878 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
29879 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
29880 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
29881
29882 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
29883 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
29884 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
29885 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
29886 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
29887 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
29888 tracepoint actions.
29889
29890 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
29891 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
29892 following forms:
29893
29894 @table @samp
29895
29896 @item R @var{mask}
29897 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
29898 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
29899 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
29900 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
29901 not fit in a 32-bit word.
29902
29903 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
29904 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
29905 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
29906 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
29907 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
29908 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
29909 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
29910
29911 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
29912 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
29913 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
29914 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
29915 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
29916 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
29917 packet).
29918
29919 @end table
29920
29921 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
29922 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
29923 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
29924 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
29925 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
29926 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
29927 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
29928 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
29929
29930 Replies:
29931 @table @samp
29932 @item OK
29933 The packet was understood and carried out.
29934 @item
29935 The packet was not recognized.
29936 @end table
29937
29938 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
29939 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
29940 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
29941 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
29942
29943 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
29944 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
29945 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
29946 one of the following forms:
29947
29948 @table @samp
29949 @item F @var{f}
29950 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
29951 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
29952 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
29953
29954 @item T @var{t}
29955 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
29956 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
29957
29958 @end table
29959
29960 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
29961 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
29962 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
29963 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
29964
29965 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
29966 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
29967 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
29968 is a hexadecimal number.
29969
29970 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
29971 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
29972 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
29973 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
29974 numbers.
29975
29976 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
29977 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
29978 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
29979
29980 @item QTStart
29981 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
29982 hits in the trace frame buffer.
29983
29984 @item QTStop
29985 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
29986
29987 @item QTinit
29988 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
29989
29990 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
29991 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
29992 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
29993 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
29994
29995 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
29996 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
29997 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
29998 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
29999
30000 @item qTStatus
30001 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
30002
30003 Replies:
30004 @table @samp
30005 @item T0
30006 There is no trace experiment running.
30007 @item T1
30008 There is a trace experiment running.
30009 @end table
30010
30011 @end table
30012
30013
30014 @node Host I/O Packets
30015 @section Host I/O Packets
30016 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
30017 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
30018
30019 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
30020 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
30021 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
30022 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
30023 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
30024 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
30025 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
30026 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
30027 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
30028 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
30029
30030 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
30031 its arguments. They have this format:
30032
30033 @table @samp
30034
30035 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
30036 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
30037 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
30038 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
30039 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
30040 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
30041 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
30042 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
30043 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
30044
30045 @end table
30046
30047 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
30048
30049 @table @samp
30050
30051 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
30052 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
30053 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
30054 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
30055 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
30056 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
30057 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
30058 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
30059 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
30060 @var{attachment}.
30061
30062 @item
30063 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
30064
30065 @end table
30066
30067 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
30068
30069 @table @samp
30070 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
30071 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
30072 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
30073 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
30074 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
30075 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
30076 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
30077
30078 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
30079 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
30080 -1 if an error occurs.
30081
30082 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
30083 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
30084 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
30085 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
30086 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
30087 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
30088 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
30089 @var{count} was zero.
30090
30091 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
30092 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
30093 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
30094 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
30095 some characters were escaped.
30096
30097 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
30098 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
30099 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
30100 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
30101 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
30102 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
30103 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
30104 error occurred.
30105
30106 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
30107 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
30108 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
30109
30110 @end table
30111
30112 @node Interrupts
30113 @section Interrupts
30114 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
30115
30116 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
30117 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
30118 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
30119 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
30120
30121 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
30122 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
30123 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
30124 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
30125 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
30126
30127 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
30128 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
30129 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
30130 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
30131 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
30132 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
30133 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
30134 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
30135
30136 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
30137 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
30138 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
30139
30140 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
30141 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
30142 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
30143 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
30144 currently-executing threads and processes.
30145 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
30146 running program, it should send one of the stop
30147 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
30148 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
30149 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
30150 Interrupts received while the
30151 program is stopped are discarded.
30152
30153 @node Notification Packets
30154 @section Notification Packets
30155 @cindex notification packets
30156 @cindex packets, notification
30157
30158 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
30159 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
30160 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
30161 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
30162 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
30163 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
30164 is not a problem.
30165
30166 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
30167 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
30168 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
30169 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
30170 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
30171 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
30172 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
30173
30174 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
30175 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
30176
30177 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
30178 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
30179 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
30180 not they understand it.
30181
30182 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
30183 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
30184 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
30185 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
30186 recipients.
30187
30188 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
30189 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
30190 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
30191 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
30192 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
30193
30194 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
30195 defined:
30196
30197 @table @samp
30198 @item Stop: @var{reply}
30199 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
30200 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
30201 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
30202 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
30203 @value{GDBN}.
30204 @end table
30205
30206 @node Remote Non-Stop
30207 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
30208
30209 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
30210 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
30211 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
30212 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
30213
30214 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
30215 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
30216 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
30217 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
30218 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
30219 probe the target state after a mode change.
30220
30221 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
30222 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
30223 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
30224 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
30225 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
30226 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
30227 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
30228 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
30229 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
30230 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
30231 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
30232
30233 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
30234 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
30235 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
30236 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
30237 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
30238 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
30239 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
30240 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
30241 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
30242 sending any queued stop events.
30243
30244 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
30245 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
30246 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
30247 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
30248 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
30249 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
30250 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
30251
30252 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
30253 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
30254 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
30255 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
30256 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
30257 process normally.
30258
30259 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
30260 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
30261 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
30262 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
30263 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
30264 should process normally.
30265
30266 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
30267 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
30268 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
30269 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
30270 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
30271
30272 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
30273 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
30274 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
30275 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
30276 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
30277 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
30278 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
30279 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
30280 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
30281 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
30282 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
30283 @samp{OK}.
30284
30285 @node Packet Acknowledgment
30286 @section Packet Acknowledgment
30287
30288 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
30289 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
30290 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
30291 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
30292 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
30293 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
30294 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
30295
30296 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
30297 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
30298 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
30299 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
30300 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
30301
30302 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
30303 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
30304 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
30305 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
30306
30307 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
30308 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
30309 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
30310 @pxref{qSupported}.
30311 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
30312 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
30313 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
30314 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
30315 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
30316 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
30317 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
30318
30319 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
30320 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
30321 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
30322 connection.
30323 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
30324 new connection is established,
30325 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
30326 for the current connection, once disabled.
30327
30328 @node Examples
30329 @section Examples
30330
30331 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
30332 does not get any direct output:
30333
30334 @smallexample
30335 -> @code{R00}
30336 <- @code{+}
30337 @emph{target restarts}
30338 -> @code{?}
30339 <- @code{+}
30340 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
30341 -> @code{+}
30342 @end smallexample
30343
30344 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
30345
30346 @smallexample
30347 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
30348 <- @code{+}
30349 -> @code{s}
30350 <- @code{+}
30351 @emph{time passes}
30352 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
30353 -> @code{+}
30354 -> @code{g}
30355 <- @code{+}
30356 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
30357 -> @code{+}
30358 @end smallexample
30359
30360 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
30361 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
30362 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
30363
30364 @menu
30365 * File-I/O Overview::
30366 * Protocol Basics::
30367 * The F Request Packet::
30368 * The F Reply Packet::
30369 * The Ctrl-C Message::
30370 * Console I/O::
30371 * List of Supported Calls::
30372 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
30373 * Constants::
30374 * File-I/O Examples::
30375 @end menu
30376
30377 @node File-I/O Overview
30378 @subsection File-I/O Overview
30379 @cindex file-i/o overview
30380
30381 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
30382 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
30383 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
30384 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
30385 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
30386 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
30387
30388 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
30389 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
30390 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
30391 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
30392 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
30393
30394 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
30395 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
30396 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
30397 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
30398 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
30399 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
30400 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
30401
30402 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
30403 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
30404 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
30405 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
30406 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
30407
30408 @smallexample
30409 (@value{GDBP}) continue
30410 <- target requests 'system call X'
30411 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
30412 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
30413 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
30414 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
30415 @end smallexample
30416
30417 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
30418 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
30419 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
30420 system are not supported by this protocol.
30421
30422 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
30423
30424 @node Protocol Basics
30425 @subsection Protocol Basics
30426 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
30427
30428 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
30429 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
30430 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
30431 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
30432 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
30433 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
30434 to call the appropriate host system call:
30435
30436 @itemize @bullet
30437 @item
30438 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
30439
30440 @item
30441 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
30442 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
30443 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
30444 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
30445
30446 @end itemize
30447
30448 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
30449
30450 @itemize @bullet
30451 @item
30452 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
30453 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
30454 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
30455 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
30456 packet.
30457
30458 @item
30459 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
30460 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
30461
30462 @item
30463 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
30464
30465 @item
30466 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
30467
30468 @item
30469 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
30470 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
30471 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
30472 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
30473 packet.
30474
30475 @end itemize
30476
30477 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
30478 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
30479
30480 @itemize @bullet
30481 @item
30482 Return value.
30483
30484 @item
30485 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
30486
30487 @item
30488 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
30489
30490 @end itemize
30491
30492 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
30493 the latest continue or step action.
30494
30495 @node The F Request Packet
30496 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
30497 @cindex file-i/o request packet
30498 @cindex @code{F} request packet
30499
30500 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
30501
30502 @table @samp
30503 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
30504
30505 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
30506 This is just the name of the function.
30507
30508 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
30509 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
30510 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
30511 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
30512 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
30513 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
30514 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
30515
30516 @end table
30517
30518
30519
30520 @node The F Reply Packet
30521 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
30522 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
30523 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
30524
30525 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
30526
30527 @table @samp
30528
30529 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
30530
30531 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
30532
30533 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
30534 representation.
30535 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
30536
30537 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
30538 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
30539 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
30540
30541 @smallexample
30542 F0,0,C
30543 @end smallexample
30544
30545 @noindent
30546 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
30547
30548 @smallexample
30549 F-1,4,C
30550 @end smallexample
30551
30552 @noindent
30553 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
30554
30555 @end table
30556
30557
30558 @node The Ctrl-C Message
30559 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
30560 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
30561
30562 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
30563 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
30564 the target should behave as if it had
30565 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
30566 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
30567 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
30568 packet.
30569
30570 It's important for the target to know in which
30571 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
30572
30573 @itemize @bullet
30574 @item
30575 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
30576
30577 @item
30578 The system call on the host has been finished.
30579
30580 @end itemize
30581
30582 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
30583 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
30584 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
30585 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
30586 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
30587 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
30588
30589 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
30590 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
30591 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
30592 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
30593 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
30594 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
30595 or the full action has been completed.
30596
30597 @node Console I/O
30598 @subsection Console I/O
30599 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
30600
30601 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
30602 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
30603 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
30604 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
30605 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
30606 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
30607 conditions is met:
30608
30609 @itemize @bullet
30610 @item
30611 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
30612 @code{read}
30613 system call is treated as finished.
30614
30615 @item
30616 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
30617 newline.
30618
30619 @item
30620 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
30621 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
30622
30623 @end itemize
30624
30625 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
30626 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
30627 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
30628 is stopped at the user's request.
30629
30630
30631 @node List of Supported Calls
30632 @subsection List of Supported Calls
30633 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
30634
30635 @menu
30636 * open::
30637 * close::
30638 * read::
30639 * write::
30640 * lseek::
30641 * rename::
30642 * unlink::
30643 * stat/fstat::
30644 * gettimeofday::
30645 * isatty::
30646 * system::
30647 @end menu
30648
30649 @node open
30650 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
30651 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
30652
30653 @table @asis
30654 @item Synopsis:
30655 @smallexample
30656 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
30657 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
30658 @end smallexample
30659
30660 @item Request:
30661 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
30662
30663 @noindent
30664 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
30665
30666 @table @code
30667 @item O_CREAT
30668 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
30669 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
30670 are concerned.
30671
30672 @item O_EXCL
30673 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
30674 an error and open() fails.
30675
30676 @item O_TRUNC
30677 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
30678 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
30679 truncated to zero length.
30680
30681 @item O_APPEND
30682 The file is opened in append mode.
30683
30684 @item O_RDONLY
30685 The file is opened for reading only.
30686
30687 @item O_WRONLY
30688 The file is opened for writing only.
30689
30690 @item O_RDWR
30691 The file is opened for reading and writing.
30692 @end table
30693
30694 @noindent
30695 Other bits are silently ignored.
30696
30697
30698 @noindent
30699 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
30700
30701 @table @code
30702 @item S_IRUSR
30703 User has read permission.
30704
30705 @item S_IWUSR
30706 User has write permission.
30707
30708 @item S_IRGRP
30709 Group has read permission.
30710
30711 @item S_IWGRP
30712 Group has write permission.
30713
30714 @item S_IROTH
30715 Others have read permission.
30716
30717 @item S_IWOTH
30718 Others have write permission.
30719 @end table
30720
30721 @noindent
30722 Other bits are silently ignored.
30723
30724
30725 @item Return value:
30726 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
30727 occurred.
30728
30729 @item Errors:
30730
30731 @table @code
30732 @item EEXIST
30733 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
30734
30735 @item EISDIR
30736 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
30737
30738 @item EACCES
30739 The requested access is not allowed.
30740
30741 @item ENAMETOOLONG
30742 @var{pathname} was too long.
30743
30744 @item ENOENT
30745 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
30746
30747 @item ENODEV
30748 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
30749
30750 @item EROFS
30751 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
30752 write access was requested.
30753
30754 @item EFAULT
30755 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
30756
30757 @item ENOSPC
30758 No space on device to create the file.
30759
30760 @item EMFILE
30761 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
30762
30763 @item ENFILE
30764 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
30765 has been reached.
30766
30767 @item EINTR
30768 The call was interrupted by the user.
30769 @end table
30770
30771 @end table
30772
30773 @node close
30774 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
30775 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
30776
30777 @table @asis
30778 @item Synopsis:
30779 @smallexample
30780 int close(int fd);
30781 @end smallexample
30782
30783 @item Request:
30784 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
30785
30786 @item Return value:
30787 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
30788
30789 @item Errors:
30790
30791 @table @code
30792 @item EBADF
30793 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
30794
30795 @item EINTR
30796 The call was interrupted by the user.
30797 @end table
30798
30799 @end table
30800
30801 @node read
30802 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
30803 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
30804
30805 @table @asis
30806 @item Synopsis:
30807 @smallexample
30808 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
30809 @end smallexample
30810
30811 @item Request:
30812 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
30813
30814 @item Return value:
30815 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
30816 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
30817 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
30818
30819 @item Errors:
30820
30821 @table @code
30822 @item EBADF
30823 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
30824 reading.
30825
30826 @item EFAULT
30827 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30828
30829 @item EINTR
30830 The call was interrupted by the user.
30831 @end table
30832
30833 @end table
30834
30835 @node write
30836 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
30837 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
30838
30839 @table @asis
30840 @item Synopsis:
30841 @smallexample
30842 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
30843 @end smallexample
30844
30845 @item Request:
30846 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
30847
30848 @item Return value:
30849 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
30850 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
30851 is returned.
30852
30853 @item Errors:
30854
30855 @table @code
30856 @item EBADF
30857 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
30858 writing.
30859
30860 @item EFAULT
30861 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30862
30863 @item EFBIG
30864 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
30865 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
30866
30867 @item ENOSPC
30868 No space on device to write the data.
30869
30870 @item EINTR
30871 The call was interrupted by the user.
30872 @end table
30873
30874 @end table
30875
30876 @node lseek
30877 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
30878 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
30879
30880 @table @asis
30881 @item Synopsis:
30882 @smallexample
30883 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
30884 @end smallexample
30885
30886 @item Request:
30887 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
30888
30889 @var{flag} is one of:
30890
30891 @table @code
30892 @item SEEK_SET
30893 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
30894
30895 @item SEEK_CUR
30896 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
30897 bytes.
30898
30899 @item SEEK_END
30900 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
30901 bytes.
30902 @end table
30903
30904 @item Return value:
30905 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
30906 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
30907 value of -1 is returned.
30908
30909 @item Errors:
30910
30911 @table @code
30912 @item EBADF
30913 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
30914
30915 @item ESPIPE
30916 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
30917
30918 @item EINVAL
30919 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
30920
30921 @item EINTR
30922 The call was interrupted by the user.
30923 @end table
30924
30925 @end table
30926
30927 @node rename
30928 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
30929 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
30930
30931 @table @asis
30932 @item Synopsis:
30933 @smallexample
30934 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
30935 @end smallexample
30936
30937 @item Request:
30938 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
30939
30940 @item Return value:
30941 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
30942
30943 @item Errors:
30944
30945 @table @code
30946 @item EISDIR
30947 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
30948 directory.
30949
30950 @item EEXIST
30951 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
30952
30953 @item EBUSY
30954 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
30955 process.
30956
30957 @item EINVAL
30958 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
30959 of itself.
30960
30961 @item ENOTDIR
30962 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
30963 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
30964 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
30965
30966 @item EFAULT
30967 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
30968
30969 @item EACCES
30970 No access to the file or the path of the file.
30971
30972 @item ENAMETOOLONG
30973
30974 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
30975
30976 @item ENOENT
30977 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
30978
30979 @item EROFS
30980 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
30981
30982 @item ENOSPC
30983 The device containing the file has no room for the new
30984 directory entry.
30985
30986 @item EINTR
30987 The call was interrupted by the user.
30988 @end table
30989
30990 @end table
30991
30992 @node unlink
30993 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
30994 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
30995
30996 @table @asis
30997 @item Synopsis:
30998 @smallexample
30999 int unlink(const char *pathname);
31000 @end smallexample
31001
31002 @item Request:
31003 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
31004
31005 @item Return value:
31006 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
31007
31008 @item Errors:
31009
31010 @table @code
31011 @item EACCES
31012 No access to the file or the path of the file.
31013
31014 @item EPERM
31015 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
31016
31017 @item EBUSY
31018 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
31019 being used by another process.
31020
31021 @item EFAULT
31022 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31023
31024 @item ENAMETOOLONG
31025 @var{pathname} was too long.
31026
31027 @item ENOENT
31028 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
31029
31030 @item ENOTDIR
31031 A component of the path is not a directory.
31032
31033 @item EROFS
31034 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
31035
31036 @item EINTR
31037 The call was interrupted by the user.
31038 @end table
31039
31040 @end table
31041
31042 @node stat/fstat
31043 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
31044 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
31045 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
31046
31047 @table @asis
31048 @item Synopsis:
31049 @smallexample
31050 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
31051 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
31052 @end smallexample
31053
31054 @item Request:
31055 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
31056 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
31057
31058 @item Return value:
31059 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
31060
31061 @item Errors:
31062
31063 @table @code
31064 @item EBADF
31065 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
31066
31067 @item ENOENT
31068 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
31069 path is an empty string.
31070
31071 @item ENOTDIR
31072 A component of the path is not a directory.
31073
31074 @item EFAULT
31075 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31076
31077 @item EACCES
31078 No access to the file or the path of the file.
31079
31080 @item ENAMETOOLONG
31081 @var{pathname} was too long.
31082
31083 @item EINTR
31084 The call was interrupted by the user.
31085 @end table
31086
31087 @end table
31088
31089 @node gettimeofday
31090 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
31091 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
31092
31093 @table @asis
31094 @item Synopsis:
31095 @smallexample
31096 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
31097 @end smallexample
31098
31099 @item Request:
31100 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
31101
31102 @item Return value:
31103 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
31104
31105 @item Errors:
31106
31107 @table @code
31108 @item EINVAL
31109 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
31110
31111 @item EFAULT
31112 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
31113 @end table
31114
31115 @end table
31116
31117 @node isatty
31118 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
31119 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
31120
31121 @table @asis
31122 @item Synopsis:
31123 @smallexample
31124 int isatty(int fd);
31125 @end smallexample
31126
31127 @item Request:
31128 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
31129
31130 @item Return value:
31131 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
31132
31133 @item Errors:
31134
31135 @table @code
31136 @item EINTR
31137 The call was interrupted by the user.
31138 @end table
31139
31140 @end table
31141
31142 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
31143 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
31144 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
31145 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
31146 needed.
31147
31148
31149 @node system
31150 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
31151 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
31152
31153 @table @asis
31154 @item Synopsis:
31155 @smallexample
31156 int system(const char *command);
31157 @end smallexample
31158
31159 @item Request:
31160 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
31161
31162 @item Return value:
31163 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
31164 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
31165 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
31166 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
31167 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
31168 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
31169 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
31170
31171 @item Errors:
31172
31173 @table @code
31174 @item EINTR
31175 The call was interrupted by the user.
31176 @end table
31177
31178 @end table
31179
31180 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
31181 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
31182 the host is simplified before it's returned
31183 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
31184 is discarded, and the return value consists
31185 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
31186
31187 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
31188 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
31189 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
31190
31191 @table @code
31192 @item set remote system-call-allowed
31193 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
31194 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
31195 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
31196
31197 @item show remote system-call-allowed
31198 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
31199 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
31200 protocol.
31201 @end table
31202
31203 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
31204 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
31205 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
31206
31207 @menu
31208 * Integral Datatypes::
31209 * Pointer Values::
31210 * Memory Transfer::
31211 * struct stat::
31212 * struct timeval::
31213 @end menu
31214
31215 @node Integral Datatypes
31216 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
31217 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
31218
31219 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
31220 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
31221 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
31222
31223 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
31224 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
31225
31226 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
31227
31228 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
31229 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
31230
31231 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
31232
31233 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
31234 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
31235 byte order.
31236
31237 @node Pointer Values
31238 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
31239 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
31240
31241 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
31242 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
31243 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
31244 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
31245
31246 @smallexample
31247 @code{1aaf/12}
31248 @end smallexample
31249
31250 @noindent
31251 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
31252 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
31253 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
31254 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
31255
31256 @smallexample
31257 @code{123456/d}
31258 @end smallexample
31259
31260 @node Memory Transfer
31261 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
31262 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
31263
31264 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
31265 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
31266 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
31267 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
31268 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
31269 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
31270 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
31271
31272
31273 @node struct stat
31274 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
31275 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
31276
31277 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
31278 is defined as follows:
31279
31280 @smallexample
31281 struct stat @{
31282 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
31283 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
31284 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
31285 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
31286 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
31287 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
31288 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
31289 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
31290 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
31291 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
31292 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
31293 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
31294 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
31295 @};
31296 @end smallexample
31297
31298 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
31299 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
31300 structure is of size 64 bytes.
31301
31302 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
31303 range of values.
31304
31305 @table @code
31306
31307 @item st_dev
31308 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
31309
31310 @item st_ino
31311 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
31312
31313 @item st_mode
31314 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
31315 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
31316
31317 @item st_uid
31318 @itemx st_gid
31319 @itemx st_rdev
31320 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
31321
31322 @item st_atime
31323 @itemx st_mtime
31324 @itemx st_ctime
31325 These values have a host and file system dependent
31326 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
31327 support exact timing values.
31328 @end table
31329
31330 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
31331 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
31332 continuing.
31333
31334 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
31335 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
31336 get truncated on the target.
31337
31338 @node struct timeval
31339 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
31340 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
31341
31342 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
31343 is defined as follows:
31344
31345 @smallexample
31346 struct timeval @{
31347 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
31348 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
31349 @};
31350 @end smallexample
31351
31352 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
31353 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
31354 structure is of size 8 bytes.
31355
31356 @node Constants
31357 @subsection Constants
31358 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
31359
31360 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
31361 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
31362 values before and after the call as needed.
31363
31364 @menu
31365 * Open Flags::
31366 * mode_t Values::
31367 * Errno Values::
31368 * Lseek Flags::
31369 * Limits::
31370 @end menu
31371
31372 @node Open Flags
31373 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
31374 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
31375
31376 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
31377
31378 @smallexample
31379 O_RDONLY 0x0
31380 O_WRONLY 0x1
31381 O_RDWR 0x2
31382 O_APPEND 0x8
31383 O_CREAT 0x200
31384 O_TRUNC 0x400
31385 O_EXCL 0x800
31386 @end smallexample
31387
31388 @node mode_t Values
31389 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
31390 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
31391
31392 All values are given in octal representation.
31393
31394 @smallexample
31395 S_IFREG 0100000
31396 S_IFDIR 040000
31397 S_IRUSR 0400
31398 S_IWUSR 0200
31399 S_IXUSR 0100
31400 S_IRGRP 040
31401 S_IWGRP 020
31402 S_IXGRP 010
31403 S_IROTH 04
31404 S_IWOTH 02
31405 S_IXOTH 01
31406 @end smallexample
31407
31408 @node Errno Values
31409 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
31410 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
31411
31412 All values are given in decimal representation.
31413
31414 @smallexample
31415 EPERM 1
31416 ENOENT 2
31417 EINTR 4
31418 EBADF 9
31419 EACCES 13
31420 EFAULT 14
31421 EBUSY 16
31422 EEXIST 17
31423 ENODEV 19
31424 ENOTDIR 20
31425 EISDIR 21
31426 EINVAL 22
31427 ENFILE 23
31428 EMFILE 24
31429 EFBIG 27
31430 ENOSPC 28
31431 ESPIPE 29
31432 EROFS 30
31433 ENAMETOOLONG 91
31434 EUNKNOWN 9999
31435 @end smallexample
31436
31437 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
31438 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
31439
31440 @node Lseek Flags
31441 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
31442 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 SEEK_SET 0
31446 SEEK_CUR 1
31447 SEEK_END 2
31448 @end smallexample
31449
31450 @node Limits
31451 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
31452 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
31453
31454 All values are given in decimal representation.
31455
31456 @smallexample
31457 INT_MIN -2147483648
31458 INT_MAX 2147483647
31459 UINT_MAX 4294967295
31460 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
31461 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
31462 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 @node File-I/O Examples
31466 @subsection File-I/O Examples
31467 @cindex file-i/o examples
31468
31469 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
31470 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
31471
31472 @smallexample
31473 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
31474 @emph{request memory read from target}
31475 -> @code{m1234,6}
31476 <- XXXXXX
31477 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
31478 -> @code{F6}
31479 @end smallexample
31480
31481 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
31482 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
31483
31484 @smallexample
31485 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31486 @emph{request memory write to target}
31487 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
31488 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
31489 -> @code{F6}
31490 @end smallexample
31491
31492 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
31493 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
31494
31495 @smallexample
31496 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31497 -> @code{F-1,9}
31498 @end smallexample
31499
31500 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
31501 host is called:
31502
31503 @smallexample
31504 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31505 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
31506 <- @code{T02}
31507 @end smallexample
31508
31509 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
31510 host is called:
31511
31512 @smallexample
31513 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
31514 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
31515 <- @code{T02}
31516 @end smallexample
31517
31518 @node Library List Format
31519 @section Library List Format
31520 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
31521
31522 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
31523 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
31524 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
31525 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
31526 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
31527 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
31528 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
31529 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
31530 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
31531 are loaded.
31532
31533 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
31534 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
31535 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
31536 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
31537
31538 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
31539 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
31540 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
31541 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
31542 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
31543 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
31544
31545 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
31546 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
31547
31548 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
31549 offset, looks like this:
31550
31551 @smallexample
31552 <library-list>
31553 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
31554 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
31555 </library>
31556 </library-list>
31557 @end smallexample
31558
31559 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
31560 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
31561
31562 @smallexample
31563 <library-list>
31564 <library name="sharedlib.o">
31565 <section address="0x10000000"/>
31566 <section address="0x20000000"/>
31567 <section address="0x30000000"/>
31568 </library>
31569 </library-list>
31570 @end smallexample
31571
31572 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
31573
31574 @smallexample
31575 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
31576 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
31577 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
31578 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
31579 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
31580 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
31581 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
31582 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
31583 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
31584 @end smallexample
31585
31586 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
31587 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
31588 section for each library.
31589
31590 @node Memory Map Format
31591 @section Memory Map Format
31592 @cindex memory map format
31593
31594 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
31595 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
31596 memory map.
31597
31598 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
31599 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
31600 lists memory regions.
31601
31602 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
31603 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
31604
31605 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
31606
31607 @smallexample
31608 <?xml version="1.0"?>
31609 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
31610 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
31611 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
31612 <memory-map>
31613 region...
31614 </memory-map>
31615 @end smallexample
31616
31617 Each region can be either:
31618
31619 @itemize
31620
31621 @item
31622 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
31623 bytes from there:
31624
31625 @smallexample
31626 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
31627 @end smallexample
31628
31629
31630 @item
31631 A region of read-only memory:
31632
31633 @smallexample
31634 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
31635 @end smallexample
31636
31637
31638 @item
31639 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
31640 bytes in length:
31641
31642 @smallexample
31643 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
31644 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
31645 </memory>
31646 @end smallexample
31647
31648 @end itemize
31649
31650 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
31651 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
31652 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
31653
31654 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
31655
31656 @smallexample
31657 <!-- ................................................... -->
31658 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
31659 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
31660 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
31661 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
31662 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
31663 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
31664 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
31665 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
31666 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
31667 and its type, or device. -->
31668 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
31669 start CDATA #REQUIRED
31670 length CDATA #REQUIRED
31671 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
31672 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
31673 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
31674 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
31675 @end smallexample
31676
31677 @include agentexpr.texi
31678
31679 @node Target Descriptions
31680 @appendix Target Descriptions
31681 @cindex target descriptions
31682
31683 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
31684 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
31685 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
31686
31687 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
31688 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
31689 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
31690 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
31691 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
31692 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
31693 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
31694
31695 @itemize @bullet
31696 @item
31697 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
31698 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
31699 @item
31700 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
31701 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
31702 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
31703 @item
31704 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
31705 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
31706 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
31707 @end itemize
31708
31709 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
31710 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
31711 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
31712 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
31713 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
31714
31715 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
31716 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
31717
31718 @menu
31719 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
31720 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
31721 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
31722 descriptions.
31723 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
31724 @end menu
31725
31726 @node Retrieving Descriptions
31727 @section Retrieving Descriptions
31728
31729 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
31730 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
31731 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
31732 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
31733 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
31734 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
31735 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
31736 Format}.
31737
31738 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
31739 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
31740 specify a file are:
31741
31742 @table @code
31743 @cindex set tdesc filename
31744 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
31745 Read the target description from @var{path}.
31746
31747 @cindex unset tdesc filename
31748 @item unset tdesc filename
31749 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
31750 will use the description supplied by the current target.
31751
31752 @cindex show tdesc filename
31753 @item show tdesc filename
31754 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
31755 @end table
31756
31757
31758 @node Target Description Format
31759 @section Target Description Format
31760 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
31761
31762 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
31763 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
31764 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
31765 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
31766 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
31767 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
31768 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
31769
31770 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
31771 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
31772 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
31773 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
31774 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
31775
31776 Here is a simple target description:
31777
31778 @smallexample
31779 <target version="1.0">
31780 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
31781 </target>
31782 @end smallexample
31783
31784 @noindent
31785 This minimal description only says that the target uses
31786 the x86-64 architecture.
31787
31788 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
31789 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
31790 are explained further below.
31791
31792 @smallexample
31793 <?xml version="1.0"?>
31794 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
31795 <target version="1.0">
31796 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
31797 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
31798 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
31799 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
31800 </target>
31801 @end smallexample
31802
31803 @noindent
31804 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
31805 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
31806 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
31807 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
31808 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
31809 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
31810 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
31811 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
31812 the version mismatch.
31813
31814 @subsection Inclusion
31815 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
31816 @cindex XInclude
31817 @ifnotinfo
31818 @cindex <xi:include>
31819 @end ifnotinfo
31820
31821 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
31822 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
31823 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
31824 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
31825 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
31826
31827 @smallexample
31828 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
31829 @end smallexample
31830
31831 @noindent
31832 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
31833 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
31834 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
31835 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
31836 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
31837 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
31838 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
31839 original description.
31840
31841 @subsection Architecture
31842 @cindex <architecture>
31843
31844 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
31845
31846 @smallexample
31847 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
31848 @end smallexample
31849
31850 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
31851 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
31852
31853 @subsection OS ABI
31854 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
31855
31856 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
31857 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
31858
31859 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
31860
31861 @smallexample
31862 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
31863 @end smallexample
31864
31865 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
31866 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
31867
31868 @subsection Compatible Architecture
31869 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
31870
31871 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
31872 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
31873
31874 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
31875
31876 @smallexample
31877 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
31878 @end smallexample
31879
31880 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
31881 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
31882
31883 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
31884 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
31885 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
31886 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
31887 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
31888 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
31889 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
31890
31891 @smallexample
31892 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
31893 <compatible>spu</compatible>
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 @subsection Features
31897 @cindex <feature>
31898
31899 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
31900 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
31901 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
31902 has this form:
31903
31904 @smallexample
31905 <feature name="@var{name}">
31906 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
31907 @var{reg}@dots{}
31908 </feature>
31909 @end smallexample
31910
31911 @noindent
31912 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
31913 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
31914 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
31915 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
31916
31917 @subsection Types
31918
31919 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
31920 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
31921 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
31922 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
31923 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
31924
31925 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
31926 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
31927 Types must be defined before they are used.
31928
31929 @cindex <vector>
31930 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
31931 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
31932 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
31933 @var{count}:
31934
31935 @smallexample
31936 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
31937 @end smallexample
31938
31939 @cindex <union>
31940 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
31941 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
31942 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
31943 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
31944
31945 @smallexample
31946 <union id="@var{id}">
31947 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
31948 @dots{}
31949 </union>
31950 @end smallexample
31951
31952 @subsection Registers
31953 @cindex <reg>
31954
31955 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
31956
31957 @smallexample
31958 <reg name="@var{name}"
31959 bitsize="@var{size}"
31960 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
31961 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
31962 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
31963 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
31964 @end smallexample
31965
31966 @noindent
31967 The components are as follows:
31968
31969 @table @var
31970
31971 @item name
31972 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
31973
31974 @item bitsize
31975 The register's size, in bits.
31976
31977 @item regnum
31978 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
31979 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
31980 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
31981 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
31982 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
31983 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
31984 in order of increasing register number.
31985
31986 @item save-restore
31987 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
31988 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
31989 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
31990 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
31991 ABI.
31992
31993 @item type
31994 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
31995 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
31996 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
31997 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
31998 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
31999 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
32000
32001 @item group
32002 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
32003 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
32004 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
32005 in @code{info registers}.
32006
32007 @end table
32008
32009 @node Predefined Target Types
32010 @section Predefined Target Types
32011 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
32012
32013 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
32014 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
32015 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
32016 types. The currently supported types are:
32017
32018 @table @code
32019
32020 @item int8
32021 @itemx int16
32022 @itemx int32
32023 @itemx int64
32024 @itemx int128
32025 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
32026
32027 @item uint8
32028 @itemx uint16
32029 @itemx uint32
32030 @itemx uint64
32031 @itemx uint128
32032 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
32033
32034 @item code_ptr
32035 @itemx data_ptr
32036 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
32037 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
32038 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
32039 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
32040 may be marked as data pointers.
32041
32042 @item ieee_single
32043 Single precision IEEE floating point.
32044
32045 @item ieee_double
32046 Double precision IEEE floating point.
32047
32048 @item arm_fpa_ext
32049 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
32050
32051 @end table
32052
32053 @node Standard Target Features
32054 @section Standard Target Features
32055 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
32056
32057 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
32058 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
32059 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
32060 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
32061 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
32062 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
32063 can recognize them.
32064
32065 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
32066 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
32067 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
32068 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
32069 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
32070 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
32071 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
32072 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
32073
32074 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
32075 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
32076 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
32077
32078 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
32079 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
32080 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
32081 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
32082
32083 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
32084 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
32085 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
32086
32087 @menu
32088 * ARM Features::
32089 * MIPS Features::
32090 * M68K Features::
32091 * PowerPC Features::
32092 @end menu
32093
32094
32095 @node ARM Features
32096 @subsection ARM Features
32097 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
32098
32099 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
32100 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
32101 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
32102
32103 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
32104 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
32105
32106 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
32107 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
32108 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
32109 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
32110
32111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
32112 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
32113 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
32114 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
32115 halves of the double-precision registers.
32116
32117 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
32118 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
32119 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
32120 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
32121 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
32122 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
32123
32124 @node MIPS Features
32125 @subsection MIPS Features
32126 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
32127
32128 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
32129 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
32130 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
32131 on the target.
32132
32133 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
32134 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
32135 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
32136
32137 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
32138 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
32139 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
32140 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
32141
32142 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
32143 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
32144 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
32145
32146 @node M68K Features
32147 @subsection M68K Features
32148 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
32149
32150 @table @code
32151 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
32152 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
32153 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
32154 One of those features must be always present.
32155 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
32156 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
32157 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
32158 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
32159
32160 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
32161 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
32162 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
32163 @samp{fpiaddr}.
32164 @end table
32165
32166 @node PowerPC Features
32167 @subsection PowerPC Features
32168 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
32169
32170 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
32171 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
32172 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
32173 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
32174
32175 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
32176 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
32177
32178 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
32179 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
32180 and @samp{vrsave}.
32181
32182 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
32183 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
32184 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
32185 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
32186 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
32187 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
32188
32189 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
32190 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
32191 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
32192 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
32193 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
32194 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
32195 user.
32196
32197 @node Operating System Information
32198 @appendix Operating System Information
32199 @cindex operating system information
32200
32201 @menu
32202 * Process list::
32203 @end menu
32204
32205 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
32206 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
32207 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
32208 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
32209 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
32210 on a different aspect of target.
32211
32212 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
32213 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
32214 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
32215 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
32216
32217 @node Process list
32218 @appendixsection Process list
32219 @cindex operating system information, process list
32220
32221 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
32222 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
32223 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
32224 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
32225
32226 An example document is:
32227
32228 @smallexample
32229 <?xml version="1.0"?>
32230 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
32231 <osdata type="processes">
32232 <item>
32233 <column name="pid">1</column>
32234 <column name="user">root</column>
32235 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
32236 </item>
32237 </osdata>
32238 @end smallexample
32239
32240 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
32241 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
32242 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
32243 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
32244 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
32245
32246 @include gpl.texi
32247
32248 @raisesections
32249 @include fdl.texi
32250 @lowersections
32251
32252 @node Index
32253 @unnumbered Index
32254
32255 @printindex cp
32256
32257 @tex
32258 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
32259 % meantime:
32260 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
32261 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
32262 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
32263 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
32264 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
32265 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
32266 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
32267 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
32268 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
32269 \page\colophon
32270 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
32271 @end tex
32272
32273 @bye